ASA Airframe Vol 1 Structures PDF
ASA Airframe Vol 1 Structures PDF
ASA Airframe Vol 1 Structures PDF
1
Basic Fixed-Wing Aerodynamics 5
The Beginning::, of Flight 5
Two Types of Lift 5
Aerostatic Lift 5
Aerodynamic L(ft 7
Properties of the Atmosphere 7
Standard Atmospheric Conditions 7
Bemoulli 's Principle 8
Axes of an Aircraft 9
Forces Acting on an Aircraft in Flight 9
Thrust 9
Lift 9
Weight lO
Drag 10
Development of the Aerodynamic Forces I1
Ailj'oil Sections 11
Aerodynamic L{ft 13
Induced Drag 16
Parasite Drag 17
flight at High-Lift Conditions 17
Basic Fixed-Wing Aerodynamics (Continued)
Stability and Control 25
Static Stability 25
D_wwmic Stability 26
Lmzr<itudinal Stability 27
Longitudinal Control: Rotathm About the Lateral Axis 27
Lateral Stability 29
Loteral Control: Rotation About the Longitudinal Axis 29
Turning Flight 30
DireCTional Stabili(r 31
The Effect of Sweepback 31
Dutch Roll 32
Directional Control: Rotation About the Vertical Axis 32
Sllldy Questions: Basic Fixed-Wing Aerodynamic"> 32
Chapter 1 3
BASIC AERODYNAMICS
1
Basic Fixed-Wing Aerodynamics
The Beginnings of Flight
People have dreamed ortakmg to the ai r s ince the earliest observers watched
the graceful flight or b1rds. lt was onl y natural the rir-.t thoughts of flig ht
assumed a need for napping wings. In Greek mythology. Daedalus and hi~
son Icarus e~capcd rrom Crete by making wings of feat hers held together
w ith wax. Icarus was so e namored of llight, he flew too close to the sun. The
wax melted. and he plunged into the sea and drowned.
T he earliest experimental flying machines emulated the bird. using n ap-
ping wings for propulsion. These machi nes, or ''ornithopters:· were unsuc- ornlthnptcr. A hl.!,l\ icr- than-a1r flvmg
cessful. The first s uccessful heavier-than-air flymg machines were buill and machim.: that proc.lu c<!~ li It by !lapping
llown by the Chinese centuries before Christ. kites held in the air by the Its wmgs. No pr,l(:tJcal nrnirhopter hJ'
been builL
"arne aerodynamic forces th at sustain modern airplanes a nd helicopter!:>.
Aerostatic Lift
While the Chinese were flying kites and raising objects with the kites' aero-
dynamic lift. most experiments in Europe were of an aerostatic nature. Tn
November of 1783, the Montgollier brother:.-. launched a manned hot-air
balloon from Paris, France. Between the two world wars of the twentieth
century. huge hghter-than-air flying machmcs earned a loft thousands of per-
sons and transported tons of cargo, and in 1929 the German Graf Zeppeli11
made a round-the-world flight of more than 21 ,000 miles.
During the 1920s and 1930s, the U.S. Navy experimented with several Zeppelin. The name of lurgl.! ng1d lighter-
huge lighter- than-arr flying machines, usmg two of them. the USS Akron than-all ~hi p" hLJJII hy the Zeppelm
Company in German) pnm to and dunng
and the USS Macon. as flying a ircraft can·iers. Interest in lighter-than-air
World \\ ar I
crafl was dealt a serious blow on May 6. 1937, when the German airship
Hindenlmrg burned as she docked at the U.S. Naval Air S tation in Lakeh urst.
New Je rsey. Strained diplomatic relations between the ru ling part1et. in
st Low pressure
Relative
wind
z
Vertical
axis
Figure 1·5. 1\n ai1plww injTigllf tsji-ee to rmure abma it:s longitutitnal. lateral. und
l'erticul axe1·. These three axes are mwual/y popendicuJar, anti all pass th rou~:h tile
rlil'(·raft '.'> cemer uf~-:mviry.
Thrust
The propeller or jet stream of an airplane, and the forward vc:dor or the lift
produced by a helicopter's rotor. provide thrust, or a force that causes for-
ward movement Thrust for a glider and for an airplane under reduced power,
is produced by the forward component of lift and weight caused by the
aircraft's downward flight path. See Figure L-7.
When the thrust line i. above the <.:enter of gravity, an increase m thrust
rotates the airplane nose-down abo ut its lateral axis. A decrease in thrust lets
the airplane rotate nose-upward.
Lift
YWeight
Lift is the total upward fo rce produced by the aerodynamic reaction of the
air flowing over the airfni l-<:hapeci surfaces of the aircraft. T he lift force i-.
F'igu rc 1-7. IVhen an tJi rplane i.1 in a
perpendicular to the relative wiJ1d, and may be tilted by varying the amounts power-off glide, tfw thrust is produced bv
of lift produced by each wing panel. Lowering the left aileron while raising lire .forward comtmllellf of the ltft and
the right aileron changes the shape of the wing airfoiL increasing the lift on weighr ~·ecton
Weight
The weight of an airplane IS the total pull of gravity. Weight acts through the
center of gravity directly toward the center of the earth. Weight is the great-
est part of the downward force on airplanes, but there are also other down-
Figure l-8. Lift acts in a direct/On rJwtts ward forces.
perperl(/iculur 1o the luterulu.\ is l.lfftllllu}
An Rirplane's downward Lailload c hanges with its airspeed. and may be
be tilred hy rolfirrg the mrplane obout it.\
lrmgirtulinalcuis. Wilen the lift i~ rifted
adjus ted so all the downward force are exactly equal to the upward forces.
from itJ tme l'f!rticul. it pmduces both a The combination of the downward forces moves the center of gravity to the
rerttca/and n lwri:.cmtul cmllfUIIIt!l/l. same location as the center of lift, and the airplane balances about iL'I center
of grav ity. See Figure 1-9.
For the airplane to remain at the 'lame ahitude, the totaJ upward force
mu~t equal the total downward force. When the airplane is turning, centrifu-
gal force causes a horizontal movement away from the cente r of the turn.
This centrifugal force adds vectorially to the aircraft's weight to produce a
resultant we1ght that is greater than the lift. l f the lift is not increac;;ed as the
airplane turns. the upward force will not equal the downward force. a nd the
auplane will descend in the turn.
Drag
induced drag. Aerodynam ic drag An airpla ne's drag is the sum of the force~ that hold it back against the
produced by an au·foil \\hen 11 '" prnduc111g forward force of thrust. There are two bas1c drag forces: mduced drag. which
II ft. I ntlw:cd tlrag i., affected hy the ,,,me;:
is produced by the same factors that produce aerodynamic h.ft. and parasite
facto r-, that affect 111ducctllift.
drag, which is caused by all factors not producing 1i ft.
Induced drag. which is affected by the ~mgle of attack. increases as the
parasite drag. A l om1 ot aerodynamic
drag cau~ed by friction between the air and
airspeed decreases. Parasite drag increases as the mrspeecl increases. The
the surlacc on:r whtch It '" tlnwmg. total drag is the sum of the induced <md parasite <.!rags. Total drag is least at
the point w here induced and parasite drags are equal.
angle of attack (CJ.) , The acute angle
lonncd between the chortlline or <Ill •mfotl
anu the dircdJOn ol Lhe air that \trike'>
the airfoil Horizontal
-" Uft
==*==
\\ luch the uc:rud) nam1c force-, .tl·ung on
the colllrol ~urface' are balanced and the
aircraft 1' ahlc to 11y straight and level \qth
YWeight
no control1nput
In stratght and level tnmmed flight, the lift In turntng flight. centitugal force adds to the
exactly balances the we1ght wetght, and 1f the htt IS not increased, the
downward component of weight will be
Fil,'llre 1-9. Force:; at'ltiiK on llll airplane in greater than the upward component. and the
strni~ht amlh•t•el {li~l!r om! trtmin~ j7ighr airplane will descend.
lO AVI.-\ liON M \t'<rt:.NANC'E TF.CH'>~ ICIAN St.RJLS Volume t: AIRFRA~1E STRL ~TURC.~
Development of the Aerodynamic Forces
Five factors affect aerodynamic lift and induced drag:
• Shape of the airl'oil section
• Area of the airfoil
• Atr density
• Speed of the air relative to the ai rfoiJ~,urface
• Angle beLween the airfoil and the relative wmd (the angle ol attack)
Notice that two of these factors relate to the airfoil. two to the air, and r elath e wind. The uirccllon the \~ tn<.l
\ trik e~ an :urf 01 l
o ne to the relationship between the two. The direction oflhe lift produced by
the wing is always perpendicular to the direction of the relative wind.
Airfoil Sections
Aerodynamic lift depends on the shape of the airfoil section and on the air-
foil -.urfacc area. Figure 1-10 show~ a typical sub~onic airfoil :.ection and
:-.ome of the more important terms related to its shape.
The mean camber (H) is a line drawn midway between Lhe upper and m ea n camber. A Ime that i ~ dra\\ n
nm lwav between the upper anu ]O\\Cf
IO\vcr cambers, and its curvature is one of the most important factors in
camhcr ot an air foil \cctmn T hL Jlll'all
dctcm1ining the aerody namic charactcri~tic" or the airfoil. The maximum camher dl·tcmltncs the aeroJynarmc
camber (}-) of a typical low-speed airfotl ts about 4% of the length of the charaL!cn-.tJC!> ol the ai1toil.
chord line. and is located about 40% of the chord length behind the leading
edge. The maximum thid.ness (E) is about 127r of the chord length and b
located about 30% or the chord length behind the leading edge.
c G
"""(- - D
-
M
K
r L
J
A Chord line G Upper camber
B Lead•ng edge rad•us H Mean camber
C Leading edge J Trailing edge
D Location of max1mum 1hickness K Lower camber
E Maximum thickness L Chord
F Maximum camber M Location of max1mum camber
€'~te'>d.
ed,•..
•ll'lf)g
f Lift
Resultant
force
~ Cl)or(J ~·
( Angleof 'ne
...._,._ _
~ attack (cx >
Relative wind ~----
Center of pressure
Figure 1-1 1. The ceme1 ufpre:. vure (if n11 ai1j'oi/ i.~ thut point un the chord ltne at which
1he aerodynomicforn'.\ are considered to he cancentratnl.
~
Early cambered airfoil =Symmetncal airfoil Supercritical rurfoil symmetrical airfoil. An airfoil that ha.., the
same ...hape on both s1dcs of its center line.
~-------------~
Clark-Y airfoil Double wedge supersonic GAW - 1 airfoil
airfoil
c
Modern asymmetncal a1rf01l Circular arc supersoniC airfOil
c
GAW-2 airfoil asymmetrical a irfoil. An a1rt01 l -.eu10n
that 1~ not the <;arne on both s1de-. ot t.he
Figure 1-12. Airfoil 1\pe.\ chord line.
Aerodynamic Lift
T o fi nd the amount of aerodynamic li ft produced by an airfoil. use the for- dens ity ratio (cr). The ratio of the density
mula in Figure 1- 13. When the air density IS expressed as a density ratio (<J) of the air at a given alt1tude to the dens•t)
of the a1r at sea level under '>tandanl
between standard air density at sea level and the de nsity of the existing air,
conditio n ~ .
and the velocity of the air is expressed in knots. the dynamic pressure (q) of
the ai r in pounds per square foot is fou nd w ith the formula in Figure 1-1 4. dynam ic pr~.s1>-ure (q ). The pre~~urc a
Notice that the lift is affected by the square of the a irspeed. Doubling the movmg l'lutd would have 1f It were
airspeed inc reases the lift four limes. slopped. Dynamic pres~ure i.., mca'>urcd in
pou nds per square foo t.
q =0.00339 cr V 2
q =dynamic pressure in pounds per square foot
0.00339 = a constant that allows knots to be used as the velocity knot. A measu re of speed equal to one
cr=density ratio as found in Figure 1- 15 nautical mile per hour.
Chapter 1 13
Figure 1-15 is an excerpt from the International Civil Aeronautical Organi-
Lation (JCAO) Standard Atmosphere Chart. As the altitude increa,es. the
density of the air decrease~. but the temperature and the speed of sou nd de-
crease only lO an altitude of 36.089 feet. and then stabilize. Th1s ahiLUde IS
the beginning of the ..,tratosphere.
coefficient of d ra~. t\ d 1 men~ionlcss The information requirt!d about the airfoil j.., 1t.., ...hape and its areJ. Figure
numtx-r U\CU i n the tnt mula to r tlctcrmin- l- I 6 !o.hO\V!> a typ1cal ~et of duu actcrisuc curve::. fot a 'pecific shape of .1ir
ing induced drag a-. it n.:kllt:\ to the .tng le foil. Such curves are antilable for evt::ry airfoil -;cctton.
of auack.
The coefficient of lift (C1 ). the coefficient of drag <C 0 } . and the lift over
drag (UD) curves cu·e the mn-;L important charactcnstics. The~c curves let
coefficient of' lift. A d 1m cns1on lcss
number r~ l atl ng LO the :lngl e ol attack u:;;ccl you find the appropriate coeiTicients. or dm1cns10nlcss number:-.. for the air-
mthe l'o rmula fm ucrudynamit: ltlt. foil at each angle or attack.
Notice that the CL curve increases st~adily from 0 at 0° angle or attack
LIU ratio. A mea,urc ol dllclcncy or an until, at an angle of attack of 20°, it suddenly drop" off. This is the critical
airfoi l It 1s the r.tllo nl the Jifl to the total angle of attnck at which the mr ceases to t'low smoothly over the top of the
drag. at .1 spccificd .tng le 0 1 a!lac k. wing. and the wing stalls.
The C0 cun e is relatively llat from 0° up to about 3° and then turns
stall. A llight contlition in which an angle sha1 ply upv.ard and continues to increase with the angle of attack. You can
of all<ack i'> rcachcd at which thL ail cca~c..,
find the value:-. for the UD curve by dividing the C 1 by the C0 for rhc par-
to flow o;mooth ly oH:r the upper \UrL.H:e of
an aitfoil. The a1r becomes turbulent and ticulaJ angle of attack. For example, at an angle of attack of 6°. the CL '"
li ft is lo-.t. approximate!) 0.5 and the C 0 is 0.04. Divide CL by Cn to find that the LID
ratio for 6° is 12.5. Thi:-. is the high point of the UD curve. or the UD,..,1A\·
See F1gurc 1- 16.
1-1. AviATIO'I M "" 1h'IAt-;CI! Tt!CII'ICIA" S ERIES Volume 1: AIRI-R .\~11' STRt Cll'RhS
1-"-'
I+ m
I
1-+HI+t + Ittl- 1-H·
1-H:tH! It
I-I
•t+t ~..... +-! tt
.2000
l ~tt
~I
1+- r t
1-t
.1800 1-t- I+
:t- tr; t
t tl l.t +jt
+
.1400 • +
........ ::e.
1·+-t+--
,tt mll"'r· ff
+ 1-r- ~ 1
•+4- Ht-tH I I+# [+
.
.1200
-Itt+ +f+ Itt- ~ t If~
II + +
1-
~
i+- -
~
IW I t++- ~~
.1000 l$t t h: It W
+
0800 ,.,.
~.,. • I t-\-
tf f-t-
·t!
.0600 + :J
+
0 + .- 1-H=t!
~
~
... .0400
m:t
0 It !"
-u
0
~ .0200
~0
() 0
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Known values
Angle of attack "" 16'
True airspeed = 60 knots
Density altitude =- 1 ,000 feet
Wing area :::: 170 square feet
Find
Lift produced in pounds
Procedure
1. Find the coefficient of lift:
In Figure 1·16.1ocate 16° along the angle of attack scale at the bottom o f
the chart. Follow th is line upward until it Intersects the CL curve_ From this
point, follow a line to the right until it intersects the CL index. Th1s occurs
at 1.3.
2. Find the dynamic pressure:
Use the ICAO Standard Atmosphere Chart in Figure 1·15 to find the density
ratio at 1.000 feet. Follow the horizontal line for 1 ,000 feet to the right to
the density ratio column. o =0.9711
Use the formula in Figure 1-14 to find the dynamic pressure:
q = 0.00339 0 V2
:: 0.00339 X 0.9711 X 602
= 11.85 pounds per square foot
3. Find the aerodynamic lift
Use the formula In Figura 1·1 3.
L = CLqS
= 1,3 X 11 .85 :X 170
= 2,618.8 pounds
Induced Drag
Notice that the C 0 curve in Fig ure 1- 16 increa..c;es greatly with Lhe angle of
allack , but the angle of attack needed Lo prod uce a given am ount of lif t de-
l:rt!ascs as rhe airspeed i nc rea~es. The induced drag, therefore, decreases with
an increase m mrspccd, as shown in the typtcaJ drag curve m F1gure 1-1 Yon
Page 18.
Figure J-18. Fnmmla fo r {indirrx the indrrccd d1·ag. in jtotrlldj, , produced h1• w1 airfnil
l6 AVIAllO:\ MAJNTENA NCE T FCttNICI·\N S ERII-.\ Volume 1: All{ I·~ \I\IL STRUL"J URt-S
Parasite Drag
Parasite drag is caused by the friction of the air flowjng over the su1facc of
an aircraft. and it increases with the airspeed. Figure L- 19 show~ the way
induced drag and pam~ite drag change with airspeed. At low airspeed, such
a high angle or attack is required that the induced drag is extremely high, but
the air rriction, or parasite drag. is low. As the angle of attack decreases and
the airspeed increases, the induced drag decreases rapidly and the parasite
drag increases. At the angle of attack that produces the maximum UD ratio.
induced and parasite drag are the same. The total drag, which is the sum of
induced and parasite drags, drops until the drags become equal and then
rises. As airspeed increases, the total drag increases j ust a liule more slowly com p ressibility cffc{'l. The ~uddcn
than the parasite drag until the airspeed reaches the transonic range. At this mcrea.,e in t h~: total drag of an ,urfm l an
tran ~onic flight cau ~ed by foam anon of
speed, the formation of shock waves on the surface. caused by compressibil-
'hock wave~ on the ;.urface.
ity, produces a rapid increac;e in the total drag. (See "Basic High-Speed
Aerodynamics.. beginning on Page 37.)
There are special fom1s of para~ite drag. Profile drag 1s parasite drag pro file drag. Aerodynamic drag prod uced
produced by the skin friction as the air flows over it, and is present on an by sl-..111 fnction. Profile drag is a fom1 of
airfoi I even when it is not producing lift. Form drag i.s the parasite drag paras ite drag .
caused by the form of the ohject passing through the air, and it is less a factor
for streamlined bodies than for bodies that have other than streamlined shapes. form drag. Parasne drag caused by the
tom1 of the object pao.,~ing through the air.
Interference drag is the part of the parasite drag caused by air llowing over
one portion of the airframe interfering with the smooth flow of air over an-
interference d rag. Parasite drag cau!>ed by
other portion. Interference drag is minimi.led by the instaJJation of fairings
ai r nm\Jng over one portion o lthe
or fillets where the two s utfaccs or components join at an angle. ai d ramc imcrt enng With the smooth now
of mr ovca anot her portion
Flight at High-Lift Conditions
Airplanes need a high forward speed Lo produce enough lift to become air- rai ring. A part of a SliUC!Urc .... ho-;c
pn mary purpo~e i~ to produce,, o;mooth
borne. Much research has gone into developing an aircraft that can maintain
surtace or a smooth j unction \vhere two
it~ lift at a low forward speed. This practical problem has. of course, been
-.urfaccs .JOlll
solved with the helicopter.
The coefficient of lift of an airfoil increases o.;moothJy with the angle of fiiJct. i\ rairing used to give shnpc hut nol
attack until the critical angle of attack is reached. At this point, the air ceases !>trc ngth to an object A fill.:t produces a
to flow smoothly over the upper ~urface of the airfoil. and lift is lost. This \lllOoth junction where two :-urtacc!. meet.
condition is called a stall. See Figure 1-= 16 on Page 15.
An airplane ~tails when it reaches its critical angle of attack, which can
occur at almost any airspeed. If the airplane is heavily loaded. it requir~s
such a high angle of attack for normal flight that there is very little margin
le l't for the changes in angle of aLtack that occur while flying in turbulence.
Unintentional stalls and spins have plagued airplane operators since the s pin. A II Ight maneuver in v. h i ~.:h an
beg inning of flight. These can occur if an a irplane i~ making a slow, high airplane Lh!sccnd" in a w rkscrcw ta!>h ion.
angle-of-attack approach for landing, and the pilot kicks the rudde r to align One wing j., -.tailed ,md Lhe other i-..
produc mg lilt
the airplane with the runway. Doth wings are operating at a h1gh angle of
altack, and when the rudder moves suddenl y, the airplane yaw~. The angle
of attack of the wing moving forward is increased until this wing 'Lalls.
t+t+-t :r
l! I1
5000
~~t
Lamrnar
sub·layer
Boundary layer i~ o.;tucl icd by attaching hundreds or shorttu fts of wool yarn
to Lhe sut1'ace of a wing and photographing them in !light. At low angles of
attack, most of the lLII't" lie flat ugain~t 1he surface and ~traight acros~ the
wing. But as the angle ol rsttnck is mcreased. some of the tut'ts behind the
thickest part of the wing begin to Wil\e hack and forth and up and down.
Some of them even wave around and point forward. The. . e tufts show the
turbulence m the boundary layer Sec Figure 1-21.
sla t. I\ .;cc.:ondal)' cont rol on an a1rc.:rah Since a turbulent boundary layer causes a definite increase m drag and
that a ll ow~ 11 to fly .n .1 h1gh ,mgk of usually leads to a1rtlov.. separation. much study has been made to lind ways of
attack \\ ithout -.tail ing. r\ slat j, a 'ect10n
minimizing it. Slots and slats force high-~::ncrg} air from hdo\1\· the \1\ ing into
of the leading edge of the\\ mg moumctl
on curved track~ that move mto and out of
the upper-surface boundmy layer at high angles of anack. This allmvs for a
the v. mg on roller-.. higher angle of attack before the airllow separates. Slotted :md Lriple-sloued
flaps are used to duct high-energy air over the upper o.;urfacc of the flaps when
they are extended. which prevent~ the air separating from their !:.urrace.
slot. A tixcd, no// lc-li h.e or en1ng near the A more extenstve method or boundary layer control involves ~ucking
leadi ng edge ot an airplane w mg <lhc.:ad of the boundary layer from the smface so that the ~mooth 3Jr above it can now
the aileron.,\ slot a~.:h as a duct to lnrce
nearer the surface. The wing <>urface has a serie~ or -.mall '>lot~.; m its upper
<~ ir JO\\ n nn the upp4!1' s urfa~.:e of the \\ 1ng
\\hen the airpl.lllL' j, llymg ll a high .tngh: skm. and the:-.e slot:-. open into a series of channels inside the wmg that are
ol attad .:. The -.lot allow' the m plano: to connected to a suction pump. The turbulent air m the boundary layer is re-
Jl)' <II ,l high angle O( ~lllal:J.; bdOfl it sta ll,, moved and the :-.mooth air is pulled down to the surface.
and the .,Jot is located ahead of the aileron.
'o the aileron will n:main effect ive
thnlllghout the stal l.
20 A\1 ,\JtO' \1·\I...,Tf'~ ·\N( J.; TITH~IC'I\!1; SERms V olum e 1: AIRFR'I\Jr SJIWCJt.RES
Vortex Generators
Vot1ex generator& are small low-aspect-ratio airfoils such as those seen m ,·orte:\ generator. Smulli(m aspcd ratio
Figure 1-22. They arc installed in pairs on the upper surface of a wing, on atrfn ib i n ~tallcd in pa irs on the uppct
~ urfacl' of a \Vtng . ou both ~itlc\ of the
both sides of the vertical fin JUst ahead of the rudder. and on the underside of
'cntcallm j ust ahead of the rudder. and on
the vertical stabilizer. They pull high-energy air down to the 'iurface, which lh~ llll<.ICro;iUC of the \'CI'llt:al <;tabiJizer., o f
energizes the boundary layer and prevents airOow separation unti l the sur- -,omc airplane-.. T heu functw n i" to pull
face reaches a higher angle or attad.. htg h c ne rg~ atr dm\ n to the \ Urf acc 10
Vortex generators are installed on the wing of an airplane ahead of the energtLc the ho undar~ layer und prevent
aileron in one row about one-U1ird of the way back Crom the leading edge. atrtlm\ ..eparation until the o;utiace reaches
a htghL·r ,111glc of auack.
This i'i the point where the air begins to reach sonic.: velocity when the air-
plane is cruising in the transonic night range. Another row is installed about
one-thud of the way forward of the trailmg edge. where the air returns to
'iUb'ionic speed. These generator<; arc mounted in complementary pairs at
..,uch an angle that th~ vortex from one md.., the vm1ex of its companion.
The pressure bet-ween the generator.. in a pair b higher than the pre..,wre
on the outside. and the au· spill~ over and forms a tight swirl. or vortex. vortc:\, pl. vortices. A whtrltng motion in
High-energy air is caught in the vortex and pulled down to the surface, where " lltll d.
it energizes the sluggish boundary layer. delays the onset or shock.-induced
separation. and aid~ in mamtaining aileron effectivene~s at high ~pccds.
- >-Lift
Airfoil
Top view
Upper edge of
boundary layer~
~ lipvortex
I
{_ _____ _ ~ -------
Airfoil
Rear view
Figure 1-22. Vorte.\ generuton pull high-energy mr down to the swjace w energt:.e the
boundurv [u,·er und tnlun• drag.
Slot-
Aileron
Figure 1·24. A fi.1ed sfor in thr leading edge oftlu• 11 in~ ahead of the aileron forn'.\' high-
energy air dmt·n Ol'(:'rthe mlermr and pre1•em:. this {JOIIio11 of the win!( from wa/fhrg hefore
tiU' inlward pnrtlmr of !he ll'iiiR stalls.
Wing-T ip Vortices
uspect rutio. fhe r::ttto of the lcn!!th. or An airplane in tlight has a low pn:ssurc above the wing and a high pressure
~p<lll , o f llll atrplane wing to ih wtdth, or below, and some of the high-pressure air fJnws from the bortom to the top
~: hord . !·or .1 nonrecrangular wt ng. the
aroun<.l the wing tip and produces a .strong swirl of air called a \Ortex. En-
.LSpect rauo '" found by dividing th1. square
ot the span h} the wing by tl~ area.
ergy is lo-.t in the vortices, and step~ have been taken to minimize them. One
:\o,pccl Ratm = ..pan~ + an~a effective step is the use of a high aspect ratio. Figu r~ 1-26 shows the plan
forms of three wings with the same area but different aspect rat1os. The low-
aspeet-t atio wing i.s the least crrective, because a large percentage of it..
surface h. m the tip loss area.
External fuel tanks mounted on wing t1ps and t1p plates on the ends of
the wing~o; prevent air spilli ng over the tip and causing vortices. Wmglcts
mimmi1l! lossc::. due to vortex generation. Winglets, small upturned vertical
surfaces mounted on the w111g tips, reduce drag by reducing the spanwise
flow or a1r. therefore reduci ng vortices. See F igure l-27.
Wing-tip
vortices ~~
Wing with low-aspect ratio has large Wing with medium-aspect ratio has Wrng wtth high-aspect ratio has the least tip
percentage of 1ts area in ttp loss area, less tip loss area and weaker vortices. toss area and weakest vortices.
and produces strong wing-tip vorttces.
Figure 1-26. An ir1r'reuse in the U.\fll!ct ratio of u Willi? decreases the an1oum ofl'lwrgy tlwl i.\ lost in will~-tip l'orlice:;.
Static Stability
The tendency of an aircraft to try to return to straight and level t1ight after it sta tic slabili ty. The characten:.uc ol an
has been disturbed from this condition .fs called static stability. aircraft that cau~e~ iLto remrn to :-.traighr
anti level fli ght after it hu., bet:n di ~ turbed
If the nose of an airplane that has positive longitudinal sLaLJC stabi lily is
fro m that comli1ion
forced up or down, and the controls are released, cstablishc.d forl:CS bring the
nose back to level flight. Tf the airplane has neutral static stability. the nose
will stay displaced but will neither get funher from its cliswrbed condition
nor try to return to level flight. An airplane wi Lh ncgat1ve sta[IC stabi Iity wi II.
deviate further frorn a condition of level night and make no efl'ort to return.
6 J
A ball has neutral static stability when on
6 the nose will rise, but will go beyond level flight into a nose- up attitude.
From this position. static stability will cause the nose to drop, but again il
will pass through level flight to a nose-down position, allhough not as low as
the original disp.lacemcnl. The oscillations caused by these restorative forces
a nat plane. When moved from its position
of equilibrium, it will not try to move farther will decrease, and the airplane will return to its level-flight attitude. These
away, neither will II try to return to its original osciJlations are plotted in Figure 1-29.
position.
An airplane with positive static stability and neutral dynamic stability
will continue to oscilJate with the same displacement. One with positive
Tendency to continue static and negative dynarn.ic stability will have divergent oscillations, and
in displacement direction
.,. ... the intensity of the oscillations will increase with time.
I
Damped oscillation Undamped oscillation
Figure 1-JJ. 1'111'.1· mrplane 11:.cs n cvm·entumollwri:.alllaf Mahifi:;er and efe1'ators for
longitrulmal \tabifit\' and r.·mrrml.
Figure 1-32. This airplane ttses a stabilwor for longiru£1inal stability a!ld comrof.
~
~------------------------------------------------------------~ ~
Fi~urc 1-33. Till\ cwplwlc' tHe.} nm fixed am/two morahfe s ttljau'.' arranged iullrcform
of a V jor lon;:ttudinalllahilif,\ mrd control
Lateral Stability
Most airplane wing'> tilt upv.·ard from Lhe fuselage, and this upv,·anJ angle, Lift of descending Lift of ascending
called dihedraL gi' c~ the uirplane lateral stability. rr the au-plan~.! shown in wlng Increases w ing decreases
Figure 1-34 is flying along with the pilot's hand~ and feet off of the controls.
and a wind gust cau'>cs the right wing to drop, the air striking the de~cending
right wing wil l increase its angle of attack, and the air striking the rising left
wing will decrea'>c its angle of attack. Since li ft is determined by the angle
Wind gust causes
01' attad.. the \.lllCVt:n hrt will bring the airplane baCllO JcveJilighl. right wing to drop
Angle of anack of Angle of attack of
Lateral Control (Rotation About the Longitudinal Axis) descending wing ascending wing
Increases decreases
Ral;mced aerodynamic forces cause a propt:rly designed and trimmed air-
plane to fly straight and level with hand:-. and feet off of the controls. The hft Figure 1-3~. nrhedral produce~ /mend
produced by the wings is equal. swhility. Wlwn the ri,J?!It wi11g dmJJ.I' irr
f1iKIIf, ir.1 angle t?f' wwr/... mcrnt \'(',\, and the
a11~/e of utltwk r~!'the left Wlllg decrt'ases.
fm·n ·usmg 1/n angle oj arwd. illcrt.·a.H'.\
fflt fiji 1111c/ t/11' ll'illg \ fi'IIIITI 10 fc1·t'f flHt irt.
_ ;: -'
drag w temporarily start !he nose moving
in the wrong direction. wing and start the bank. it also increase!) the induced drag thaL pulls the nose
to the left. As soon as the wing rises, the lift tilts. and its horizontal compo-
nent pulls the nose around Lo the right as it should.
-- -- ---
D~
/
/ The movement of the nose in the wrong direction at the beginning of a
;
turn is calJed adverse yaw. It is minimized by the use of differential aileron
traveL The aileron moving upward trdvels a greater distance than lhe aileron
j; moving downward. The extra upward travel creates just abou! enough para-
site drag to counteract the induced drag caused by the lowered aiJeron. An-
Aerodynamic balance
other way to minimize adverse yaw is to use Prise ailerons, as shown in
Figure 1-36. A Frise aiil'ron minimize.\· Figure 1-36. The hinge of the aileron is set back from Lhe leading edge so
adverse yow by exte1uling tl1e nose of the that when the aileron is deflec ted upward, its nose extends below the bottom
ttp-uilero/1 belol1 the lower swface of tile wing surface and produces parasite drag.
wing to produce t1dditional parasite drag. At the beginning of a tum, the rudder is used to rotate the airplane
This counteracts the increased induced aboul its yaw axis to stan the nose 1noving in the correct direction. As soon
drag caused by the dow11-ailerot~ on the
opplHite wing.
as the bank is established, the adverse yaw force ctisappears and the rudder
is neutralized.
Many large jet transport a irplanes have two ailerons on each wing and
ud vcrsc yu" . A L:ondi.lion of tlight at the Dight spoilers to assist in roll controL The outboard ailerons are locked in
beginning of a tum in which the nose of an
airplane momentarily yaws away from the
their faired , or streamline, position when the trailing edge flaps are up. The
direction in which the turn is to he made. inboard ailerons and the flight spoilers provide enough roll control for high-
speed .flight, but when the t1aps are lowered, the inboard and outboard ai le-
differential ailer ons. An ai leron system m
rons work together w provide the additional roll control needed for low-
which the aileron movmg upv-.•ard deflects speed night.
more than the one movi ng dow n. The Flight spoilers are hinged surfac.es located ahead of the flaps. They are
additional upv,oard movement produces used in conjunction with the ailerons to assist in roll control. When the ai le-
enough pm·asite drag to counteract the rons are deflected, the flight spoilers on the wing with the up-aileron auto-
induced drag caused by Lhe lowered
matically extend to decrease the lift on the wing that is moving down and to
aileron. Dirrerential ail erons are used to
minimize adverse yaw. produce additional parasite drag to overcome any adverse yaw. When a large
amount of aileron is used, Lhe spoilers account for about 70% of the roll rate.
1. Lift produced by a body displacing a greater weight of air than its own weight is called
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ lift. Page 5
2. Lift produced by the reaction caused when a mass of air i~ denected downward is called
______ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ lift. Page 5
4. The layer of our atmosphere that is typified by the temperature of the a ir remaining constant as the pres-
sure continues lo drop is called the . Page 7
5. The type of altitude measurement used to determine the amount of lift produced by an a irfo il or the
performance of an ain;raft engine i~ altitude. Page 8
9. lf the propeller ~haft b above the center or grav1ty of an airplane. additwn or pow·cr will cau~e the nose to
pitch (upward 0 1 downward). Pagt! 9
I0. The total lift requtrcd by an airplane in a turn must be increm.cd to compensate for the added
- - - - - - - - - - - - - rnrce caused by the turn. Page 10
I I. There an~ two dmvnward forces that act on an airplane m level flight. These Ltre cau~cd by the weight and
by the . Pa~e /0
12. The center of pressure remains in e~sentiall y the ~a me location a<> the angle of attack changes on a/an
- - - - - - - - - - - - (asymmetrical or symmeli ical) airfoil. Page 12
I..J.. The angle of attack at which the air no longer flowo;, ">moothly over the top or the wing and the wing stall~.
is called the angle of attack. Page 14
Continued
15. The point on the chord line of an airfOil at which all of the aerodynamic forces may be considered to be
concentrated is called the . Page 12
16. Find the numher of pounds of lifl produced by a w ing with the a1rfoil shown in Figure 1-16. and an area of
200 square feet. when the angle of attack is 6° and the true airspeed is 150 knot-; while !lying at l 0.000
feet Lift is pound-;. Page 16
17. If the airspeed is doubled, with no other variable condition changing, the lift produced by an a irfoil will
mcrcasc Limes. Page 13
19 Interference drag. profile drag. and form drag are all types of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (induced or
parasite) drag. Page 17
13. The angle of attack at which the induced and parasite drags are the ~arne produces. the
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (maximum or minimum) UD ratio. Page 18
2-l. The total drag protluced by an airplane in flight is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (least or greatest) at the polllt at
\Vhich the induced and parasite drag arc the same. Page I R
28. The ranJom-llowing layer of air immediately adjacent to the surface of a wing is called lhe
_____________ layer. Page 19
29. Vortex generators mounted on the wing~ or an <Jirplane impro\'e night charactcnstic.·), at
- - - - - - - - - - - - ( h i g h or low J airspeed. Poge 22
30. Vortex generators mounted on the empennage of an airplane Improve llight characteristics tH
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (high or low) .;;peed. Page 22
31. The two most important characteri~tics or a v. ing planrorm are its - - - - - - - - - - - - - and
its . Page 22
32. An airplane wing that operates most efficiently at a high angle or auack hJs a
(high or lm~) aspect ratio. Page 22
33. The stall begins on a rectangular wing at the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (root or tip). Page 23
35. Lateral 'itabi Iity i-; stability about an ai rplanc' s __________ axi-.. Page 29
37. An airplane ts rotated about its lateral axis by the use of i t s - - - - - - - - - . Page 27
38. The aerodynamic load on the tall or a longitudinally stable airplane acts _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(upward or downward). Page 27
41. An airplane ha.., po~itive longitudinal static stability when its center of gravity is
- - - - - - - - - - (ahea<.l ur ur behind) the <.:enter of lift. Page '27 Continued
42. An airplane is rotated about its longitudinal axis by the w,e of its _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 30
43. The aileron moving upward to begin a tum travel.., a _________ (greater or lesser) distance
than the aileron moving downward. Page 30
44. The temlency of the nose uf an airplane to '>taJ t to travel in the direction opposite to that desired at the
beginning of CJ turn i~ called yaw. Page 30
45. A large airplane with two ailerons on each wing use~ both ailerons in - - - - - - - - - - - - -
(low- or high-) speed Dighl. Page 30
46. When an airplane uses spoilers to aid the ailerons in roll control. the spoiler will extend on the wing w1th
the (up or down) aileron. Page 30
47. An airplane is rotated about its vertical axis by tbc use of its _ _ __ __ _ __ _ . Pagt! 30
48. The leading edge of the verttcal fin on most single-engine. propel ler-driven airplanes is offset to the
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (right or left). Page 31
49. A simultaneous oscillation about an airplane's longitudinal and vertical axes is called Dutc h roll. It is
minimized on many ai 1planes by the use of a . Page 32
50. A horizontal tai I ~urface that combines the functions of a stabilizer and an elevator is called a/an
_________________ . Page28
5 I. A movable tail surface that combines the functions of a rudder and an eleva lor is called a/an
________________________ .Page29
52. On a large aircraft that has two sets of ailerons on each w ing, only the _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ __
(inboard or o utboard) ailerons are used \.\men the trailing edge flaps arc up. Page 30
53. The rudder on an airplane _ (is or is not) used ro cause the airplane to turn.
Page 30
Incompressible
(Subsonic)
- - - - --
---
- - - - ----
---- - -- - -
- --
----
- -- -----------
--- - ---- - - - - - - - - -
-- ----~~-- - - - - - - --
~~Jf N/////#/7~
Converging Diverging
Increasing velocity Decreasing velocity
Decreasing pressure Increasing pressure
Constant density Constant density
Figure 1-39. As airflows tl1rouRh a conver~ing duct m :rpeed1· he{oll' the speed ofsound,
tis vefocllv rncreases a/U/ its pressure decreases. As itleares the restriction am/ enten rhe
di1•erging portion of the duo, tis l'efocity decreases and il.\' pressure increases.
Compressible
(Supersonic)
Converging Diverging
Decreas1ng velocity Increasing velocity
Increasing pressure Decreasing pressure
Increasing density Decreasing density
Forward-Swept Wing
The advantage gained by "'weepback could also be attained by sweeping the
wing forward. This ha~ the <tdditional advantage that the forward-swept wing
stalls at the root first, eliminating the loss of lateral control experienced by a
swept-back wing as it approaches a stall.
BuL fmward-swept wings lnck torsional rigidity. In other words. the wing
tends to tw ist when high night load<; arc applied. When a swept-back wing
tw ists in flight, the wing tips wash out. Their angle of incidence, and thu:.-. the
Figure 1·44. By .~ll'et.-ping rhe ll'ing back,
thl! flight airspr<·d ('(//) lu• rllf'/"(1{{,\'l'd 1i fL they produce. decreases. This decreases the load imposed on the wing.
<lfJpreciaiJ/y before llw compmwnl of the But when a forward-swept w ing twists in flight, ils tips wash in. Their angle
airjTuwing dil'ectly acro.I'Y tire uomg of incidence increases and the loads imposed on the wing '-=an increase until
reaches the speed nj surmd. they destroy it.
figure 1-45. The Grwnnwn X-29 Advanced Technology Demonstrator er:ploits the
admma~es of the fonvard-swepr uing hecause ofthe exTensh•e use of composiTes in irs
aeroefastic Tailoring of the wrng to coullferact undesirable bending srres.\es.
Supersonic Airflow
When air flows over a surface at a supersonic speed, pressure waves form.
There are three types of pressure waves, normal and oblique shock waves,
and expansion waves.
Expansion
Oblique
shock wave
Expansion Waves
expansion Wllve . Tht:: <:hunge in pres:-,ure When air llow~ at a supersonic speed over a double-wedge airfoil like that
and ve locity of a supcr<>oni c now of air a~ in Figure 1-47. rhc air will turn to follow the smi'ace and an expansion
it passes 0\>.:1' a surface \\ hich urop~ av,;ny
wave fonn s.
from the now A~ the sw·facc drop~ away.
When supersonic air tlows through an expansion wave:
the nir tric~ to fo llow it. In dl<~n gi ng 1L<.
dlrcct1011. tl1e mr speed<; up to a htgher • The airstream accele rates and the air behind the expansion wave has a
~ upe rson ic VCIOC tty UI1U ItS ~tUll C pre~:,u rc
higher supersonic velocity.
decreases. Then: j.., no c hange in the LOla!
energy as the air pa!>scs through <111 • The c.lirection of flow changes to follow the surface.
ex pan:> ion \I ave. a nd so the re 1s no sound
• The static pressure of the airstream behi nd the wave decreases.
ns the re is 1\<11cn n1r passes through a
shm:k wave . • The density of the air behind the wave decreases.
• There is no loss of e nergy in the airstream.
42 A v rATlON Y1 AI'-T£i.'\';\NCE TECHNICIAN SERJES Volume 1: AIRr Rt\'41::. S·r RUCJ LRES
STUDY QUESTIONS: BASIC HIGH-SPEED AERODYNAMICS
Answers are on Page 58. Page m1mhers rcier to chapter text.
54. The speed of sound in the air is affectctl rmJy by the _ _ _ __ _ _ __ of the air. Page 38
55. The ratio of the <.,peed of an airplane to the speed of -.ound i.., called - - -- - - - - -- - - -
Page 38
56. When ~ubsonic air tlow~ into a convergmg duct, its velocity
_ _ _ _ ______ (im:reases. decreases. or remains the same), its pressure
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___ (increases, decreases. or remains the same), and its density
_ _ _ _ _ _ ___ (increases, decreases. or remains the same).
Page 37
57. When subsonic air 11ows into a diverging duct, its velocity
- - - - - - - ---(increases, decreases, or remains the same), ill. pressure
__________ (increases, decreases. or remains 1hc same). and its density
_________ (rncreases, decreases. or remains the same).
Page 37
58. When supersonic air flows into a converging duct, its veJocity
_ _ _ _ _ _____ (increases, decreases. or remains the same), its pressure
- - - - - - - - - - ( increases, decreases, or remains the same), and its density
_________ (increases, decrelliies. or remains the same).
Page 38
59. When supersonic air O.ows into a diverging duct, its velocity
(increases. decreases. or remains the same), its pressure
_ _ _ _ _ _____ (increases, decreases, or remains the same), and ils density
- - -------(increases, decreases, or remains the same).
Page 38
60. The velocity of air that has passed through a normal shock wave i s - - -- - - -- - - - - -
(subsonic or supersonic). Page 41
61. When air passes through a shock wave, its velocity is - - - - - - - - - - (increased or decreased).
Page .JJ
Continued
62. When air passes through an expansion wave. its velocity is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (increased or
decreased). Page 42
63. Only the component or the air flowing across the wing-- - - - - - - -- - -- (parallel or
perpendicular) Lo the 1cading edge is involved in lhe production of lift. Page 40
64. When a forward-swept wing rtexe-. under Dighlloads. the Uft produced at the wing tips
_ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ (mcreases or decreases). Page 40
Aerodynamic Principles
Rotor-wing a~rodynarnics are more complex than fixed-wing aerodynamics
for such rca ons as the speed variation nlong the length of the rotating rotor
blade, the dissymmetry of lift cau ~cd by forward Jl ighL and the problem
caused by the helicopter flying in its own down wash.
The airfoil sections used on helicopter rotors are usually synu11eu·ical, Like
the one in Figure 1--1-8. The location of the center of pressure of a symmetri-
E ___=====-=---
cal airfoi l remains relatively constant as the angle of attack changes. This is
important because as the blade rotates its angle of attack constantly changes. Fi~ure l-48. Heli<:opter rotors tYptcally ttse
,·ymmefrical a11j'o i/s hl'<·r1use the cemer of
and if Lhe center of prc~sure moved. it would cause undesirable stresses
pre~~ure remwn1 (If n re/(!fil'el) constant
and vibration. fucution m the nngle l1 anack clwngt•s.
The area used for computing the l i fL of a helicopter rotor system is ruore
complex than that for a fixed-wing aircraft. The spinning rotor creates a lift-
producing disc, and there are three values that arc used in computing the
total amoun t of lift: the blade area, the disc area. and the solidity ratio.
• The blade area is the area in square feet of the actual rotor blade itself.
• The disc area is the area swept by the blade as it rotmes. disc ar ea. !'he tnr:il .1rea swept by the
hlade:-. ot i.l hcln;optl'r mam rotor
Disc area= 0.7854 · Blade span 2
• The solidity ratio is the portion uf lht:! circular disc that is occupied by the
blades. and is the ratio of the total blade area to the total disc area.
Solidity ratio = Blade area+ Disc area
The solidity ratio for a typical rotor is between 4% and 7%.
Dissymmetry of Lift
l11e tendency of the fir~t autogiros to roll over when they were pulled through
the air by their propeller.:; was caused by dissymmetry of Lift. which in tum
was caused by the difference in airspeed between the advancing and re-
u·eating h lades. Lift increases as the airspeed of the rotor increa~es, and tht.:
greater ~peed of the advancing blade gives the advancing hair of the disc
more lift than the retreating haiL The most effective way of overcommg
dissymmetry of lift is to mount the rotor blades on a hinge so they arc free
to flap up and down.
The udvancmg blade with its g reater airspt:!ed has more lifl. so it !laps
upward. and as tt does. its angle or attack decreases and its lift decreases.
The retreating blade wilh its lower airspeed has less lift, so it flaps down-
ward. This increases its angle or attack and thu~ its lift. Rotor-flapping thus
prevents dissymmetry of lift.
Torque
torque. A fort:t: that produce' or tric.., to Newton's third law or motion state~ that for evt:!ry action Lhere is an equal
prodtll'C rotation. and opposite reaction. The engine mounted in the fuselage of a helicopter
drives the rotor. and the torque, or twisting movement, the engine imparb to
the rotor ha~ an equal but opposi te reactive force that tries to rotate the fu'le-
lage. There are a number of v. ays the torque actmg on the fuselage can be
compensated. The engine can drive two rotor-;, one above the other, on con-
centric shafts wilh the rotors turn ing in opposite directions_ The torque caused
by the upper rolor is balanced by the opposite Lorque caused by the lower
rotor. Other helicopters have two rotors mounted at an angle above the cabin
and mtermeshing with each other ~o that the torque from one rotor counter-
acts the torque of the other. Still other helicopters have two rotors, with one
mounted on the forward end of the fuselage and the other at the aft end. By
far the most popular configuration of helicopters uses a single main rotor.
46 A vi\ liON M .-\r,"'l'E\ANC L TH'HNICIAN SEI<II ~ Volume 1: Alll~RA \IE STKL!"I L RE~
a nd its torque is counteracted by a small vertically-mounted rotor on the tail
end of the fuselage. By changing Lhe pitch of the tail-rotor blades with the
foot pedals, Lhe pilot can vary the amount of tail-rotor thrust to control the
yaw of the fuselage about its vertical axis.
Effective hft
afea
I
t Direction of flight
Effective lift
area
I
----"+
~ 1'..
\\
\
Resultanllif1
1\ \ ·.
\
I
\
'
.
Plane of
rotation
Drag
Autorotatlve force
Figm·e 1-50. H'll( 11 wrflow.\ 11pll'ard tltmugh u rotOJ , tlu 1 c.\lll/t/111 lift lw.\ u Ullllflollt' lll
thlll a d\ .Jonn trd 111 I he Jl/mlt' r~f rma11n11 (111(/ Cti/IW'\ the rmor /fl \fJI/1.
-lR
A retreating blade staJI causes rotor roughnes~. en-atic slick. force::., and a
<;tick shake whose frequency is dctcnmned by the number of rotor blade::..
See Figure 1-5 L
Velocity due to
forward flight
-Velocity due
to rotation
Velocity due
to rotation
Retreating blade
Velocity due to stall area
forward flight
Figure 1-51. When u helu·optPr i~ flmm at a hi~h ·'Jlet•d, 1/rt airvu:ed of tlu• 1ip ~lthe
relreating hhu/p i.1 hm and 1/.\ angle of anuck i~ high. Thr tip of the ret rear in~ blade stall.s.
a\ r.1· m(hcated by the 11haded urea.
Ground Effect
ll requires less power for an airplane to lly very near the surrace than it does
higher up. and because of the same aerodynamic principles. a helicopter can
hover near the grouno with lc::.s power than it can a few feet higher. This
increased efficiency near the ground 1s caused by the phenomenon called
ground effect.
When a helicopter i::-. hovering at a height well above the ground, the
tlownwash is not affected by the presence of the ground, and there is a veiti-
cal velocity of the air moving through the rotor disc. This vertical compo-
nent, Vv. and the rotational velocity o( the rotor, VR· produce an angle of
attack like that in Figure 1-52 (on the next page). But v.hcn Lhe helicopter is
hovering at an altit udc or less than one-half the rotor diameter. Lhe air strikes
the ground and tlowc.; outward. This decreases it~ vert1cal veloci ty, and the
angle of aLtack of the blades increases. Jncreasing the angle or allack for the
same rotor speed increases the lift. and hecau~e the lift always ac ts perpen-
dicular to the rclati ve wind. the Lift vector ti Its toward the vertical.
Axis of
rotation
Resultant lift
Ground
)/////////////////////////////////////////J////////////////////////////////////////////1
Translational Lift
translational lift. The atltlitional lilt When a helicopter take::. off, the pilot 1ifls it from the ground into a hover and
produced by a helicopter ro1or as 1he lhen Lilts the rotor disc forward with the cyclic control. The tilted lift has a
helicopter changes from hovering to horizontal component which pulls the helicopter forward. The forward mo-
lo rwanl !light.
tion increases the mass of air flowing through the rotor disc, and this increases
the efficiency of the rotor system and the lift it produces. The increased lifL
caused by the beginning of forward Ilighl i~ called Lranslmional lift.
/
I
/
-
-
iLow flap
results
High pitch applied
Fi1,rurc 1-53. Tlw rotor of a he(icopter acts a.~ a ~ymscope and is affec!ed ll\' gymscopic
precession. if the blade pitch is rncreased on the left side of the rotor. tire diH' will rilr
forward.
Thrust •
0
Cyclic control stick Cyclic control stick
Figure 1-56. Mul'illf.{ 1he cyclic control chanf?l!l the pitch oj the main mwr hladP.\ at a
point inthe1r rotatwn TJus lilt:; the roror disc and cremes o hori::.ontal compo11e11t oj lilt
that moves the helicopra 111 rile direuion rhe tft~c 1s tlill'd.
Chapter 1 53
right angles to the fuselage. On the opposite s ide of the helicopter, the pitch
of the retreating blade is increased. These pitch changes cause the front of
the rolor disc to lower and the rear of the disc to raise. See F igure 1-53 on
Page 51.
Horizontal Stabilizer
Some helicopters have either a fixed or movable horizontal stabilizer near
the tail, like the one in Figure l-57, to hold the fuselage level in forward
night. When the cyclic pitch control is moved forward, the rotor tilts for-
ward and the fuselage Lries to follow it. Fixed bmizontal stabilizers are set so
that they provide the 1·equired downward force at cruise speed to keep the
Figure 1-57. A lwri-:.omal stalJifiz;er 011 a fuselage level and minimize the drag. Movable horizontal stabilizers are
helicopter pru1•ides a du~·mmrd aerody- controlled by the pilot to allow the tail to rise on takeoff so the maximum
namic fm-re lo hold the wil dowll ill
amount of thrust can be used to increase the airspeed.
fonrardjlighr.
Antitorque Pedals
The rotor on most single-rotor helicopters rotates Lo the left as viewed from
above. The torq ue reaction to this rotation causes the fuselage to rotate lo the
right. Thjs torque force is compensated by thrust [rom the tail rotor that keeps
the fuse1age fTom rotating. The pilot controls tail rotor thrust by changing the
pitch of the tail rotor blades with the antitorque pedals. See Figure l-58.
Direction
of torque Tail rotor thrust
to compensate
for torque
Figure 1-58. Torque o.fthe engine drivinf? the main rotor rries to rotate thefJJselage to the
rift Ill. This rmatimr is preveiUe<i by thrust from the tail rotor.
Stabilization Systems
A helicopter is statically stable, but dynamically unstable. When it is dis-
lUrbed from a condition of level flight. a force is set up that trie~ to restore it.
But this restorative force, instead of decreasing with time, increases and Rotor blade
(cross-section)
causes the helicopter to develop divergent oscillation_
Pitch
Several types of ~tabi l i7.ation systems have been deve loped to prevent change
this. Three commonly used system~ are the stabilizer bar, the offset llapping linkage
hinge. and the e lectronic stability augmentation system_
I
I
I
'--.. I
I -
Motion sensor
Feedback loop
65. The rotor blade on the side of a helicopter that is moving in the same direction the helicopter is moving i~
called the blade. Paf{e 46
66. The rotor blade on the side of a helicopter that is moving in the opposite direction to that of the helicopter
called the blade. Page 46
67 . Helicopter rotor blades arc mounted on flapping hinges to overcome the effect of
- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - . P a g e 46
6~t The retreating blade of a helicopter will stall when the helicopter airspeed is too _ _ _ _ __ __
(high or low). Page +8
69. The swll of a helicopter rotor blade caused by the high angle of attack on the retreatmg blade begin~ at the
_ _ __ _ _ __ _ (hub or tip) of the blade. Page 48
71. ln order to ti It the rotor di 'iC of a helicopter rorward, the pitch of the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(advancing or re treating) blade is increased. Page 5 I
72. The coriolis effect causes the rotor blades to move - - - - - - - - - - - - (bacJ... and forth or up
and down) Page 52
73. The corioli:-. effect is most noticeable on _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (two or three) -blade rotor systems. Poge 52
74. When a helicopter hovers normally. the air flowo.. _ _ _ __ _ _ __ (upward or downward) through
the rotor. Page 52
75. Drift caused by thrust of the tail rotor is compensated on some helicopter~ by lilting the main rotor a few
degrees to the (right or left). Page 55
76. The pitch of the rotor blades is changed at a particular point in their rotation by tJ1e _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(collective or cyclic) pitch control. Page 53
Continued
77. The pitch of all the rowr blades is changed at the same time by the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (collective or
cyclic) pitch contro L Page 53
78. A helicopter usually has positive static stability and _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (posiLive or negative)
dynamic srabiHty. PuJ!,e 55
Continued
Monocoque Structure
The name monocoque means single shell, and in a true monocoque structure,
all the strength of the structure is carried in the outside skin. Figure 2-l shows
a simplified view of a monocoque strucfure. The bulkhead and formers give
the structure its shape, but the thin metal skin riveted to them carries all the
flight loads.
Semimonocoque Structure
Pure monocoque structure has the serious drawback that any dent or deforma-
tion will decrease its ability to carry the flight loads. To overcome this
limitation, semimonocoque structure as seen in Figure 2-2 is widely used. In Figure 2-1. A true monocoque structure
this type of structure, bulkheads and formers still provide the shape, and the has bulkheads and formers to give the
structure its shape, but all of the flight
loads are carried in the thin sheet
metal skin.
Figure 2-2. A semimonocoque structure carries the flight loads in its outer skin, but this
thin skin is hacked up with stringers that extend across the formers.
Compressive stress
Figure 2-6. This shaft is subjected to a torsional stress, which is made up of a compressive
and a tensile stress.
Bending
Bending is also made up of tension and compression. The wing of the airplane
in Figure 2-7 is under a bending stress. When the airplane is on the ground,
the top skin of the wing is under a tensile stress and the bottom skin is under
a compressive stress. In flight these forces are the opposite. The top skin
is under a compressive stress and the bottom skin is under a tensile stress.
Figure 2-7. In flight, the top of the wing of this airplane is under a compressive stress and
the bottom is under a tensile stress. These two stresses make up the bending stress.
Structure .-
Figure 2-8. A shear stress tries to slide the clevis bolt apart as a load is applied to the cable.
l. A stressed skin structure that is made in the form of a single shell with all of its strength in its outer skin is
called a structure. Page 65
2. A structure that has most of its strength in its outer skin, but supports this skin with stringers across the
formers is called a structure. Page 65
4. A force that is set up within an object that tries to prevent an outside force changing its shape is called alan
__________________ .Page67
6. A material will return to its original size and shape after a stress is removed if it has not been stressed
beyond its . Page 67
Nonferrous Metals
Aluminum alloys are the most widely used nonferrous metal in aircraft con-
struction. In this section, these alloys are discussed along with magnesium
and its alloys, and titanium.
Aluminum Alloys
Aluminum is a lightweight metal, but it does not have sufficient strength to
be used as a structural material. Pure aluminum alloyed with other metals is
much stronger. Aluminum alloys are susceptible to corrosion, but their high
strength and light weight make them a metal of choice.
Heat-Treatable Alloys
Aluminum alloys are divided into two basic categories, those that can be
hardened by heat and those that cannot. Both can be softened by annealing.
The most widely used heat-treatable alloys are 2024, 6061, and 7075 for sheet
metal, and 2017, 2117, and 2024 for 1ivets.
Figure 2-10. Typical temperatures for heat rrearmelll of various aluminum alloys
F - The metal is left as fabricated. There has been no control over its temper.
T -The metal may be heat treated.
T3- solution heat treatment, followed by strain hardening. A second digit, if used,
indicates the amount of strain hardening.
T4- solution heat treatment, followed by natural aging at room temperature.
T6- solution heat treatment, followed by artificial aging (precipitation heat treated).
T?- solution heat treatment, followed by stabilization.
T8 - solution heat treatment, followed by strain hardening and then artificial aging.
T9- solution heat treatment, followed by artificial aging and then strain hardening.
H- The metal cannot be heat treated, but can be hardened by cold working.
H1 -strain hardened by cold working.
H12- strain hardened to its 1/4-hard condition.
H14- strain hardened to its 1/2-hard condition.
H18- strain hardened to its full hard condition.
H19- strain hardened to its extra hard condition .
H2- strain hardened by cold working and then partially annealed.
H3- strain hardened and stabilized.
H36- strain hardened and stabilized to its 3/4-hard condition.
0 -The metal has been annealed.
Nonheat-Treatable Alloys
Certain alloys, such as 3003 and 5052, cannot be hardened by heat treatment,
but are hardened by cold-working. When these alloys are formed into sheets
in the rolling mill, their strength and hardness are increased. The amount of
this increase is indicated by their temper designation, as in Figure 2-11.
Nonheat-treatable alloys can be softened by annealing. When a sheet of
5052 aluminum alloy is formed by hammering or spinning, it gets hard and
is likely to crack.lffurtherworking must be done, the metal may be annealed
by heating it in an oven to a temperature slightly higher than is used for
hardening and allowing it to cool very slowly.
Cladding
Aluminum alloy sheets to be used as the outside skin of an aircraft can be cla d aluminum. A ~heet of alumin um
protected from corrosion and given an attractive finish by rolling a layer of alloy that has a coating of pure aluminum
roll ed on one or both of its surfaces for
pure aluminum on both of their surfaces. This resulting material is called
corrosion protectio n.
clad aluminum and is available under such registered trade names as Alclad
and Pureclad. The pure aluminum coating is about 2 V2 to 5% of the thick-
A lclad . A reg istered trade name for clad
ness of the alloy sheet, and it decreases the strength of the sheet somewhat, aluminum all oy.
as indicated in Figure 2-14 on Page 75.
Pure aluminum cladding does not corrode, but an airtight oxide film Pureclad. A registered trade name for clad
forms on its surface and prevents any oxygen or moisture from reaching al uminum all oy .
the metal. The alloy sheet is protected as long as the cladding is not scratched
through.
Oxide-Film Protection
A hard, airtight oxide film may be deposited on the surfaceofaluminumalloy anod izing. The electrolytic process in
sheets by either an electrolytic or a chemical action. The electrolytically which a hard . ainight. ox ide film is
deposited on aluminum alloy for
deposited film is called an anodized film. The chemically deposited film is
COITOsion protecti on.
called a conversion coating, sometimes called Alodizing after one of the
popular chemicals used to form the film, A Iodine. These oxide films not only A Iodine. The registered trade name for a
protect the metal, but provide a slightly rough surface that makes it possible popular convers ion coating chem ical used
to produce a hard . airtight. oxide film on
for a paint film to adhere.
aluminum alloy for corro~i o n protectio n.
Magnesium Alloys
Magnes ium alloys arc lighter in weight than aluminum alloys and are used as
structural material s when weight is a deciding factor. These alloys do have
serious drawbacks, however. They are more reactive than aluminum alloys
and are thus more susceptible to corrosion, and they are more brittle and thus
more likely to crack. When a part is properly designed and the metal 1s
protected against corrosion, it is useful as an aircraft structural material.
Ferrous Metals
ferrous metal. Any me tal that contains Metals that contain iron are called ferrou s metals, and most ferrous metals
iron and has magnetic characteristics. used in aircraft construction are some form of steel, which is iron with a
specific amount of carbon and other alloying elements added.
1100-0 13,000 I
1100 0 23 I
H18 44 1100-H18 24,000
I
2014 0 45
T6 135 2014·0
2014-T6
27,000 I
2024 0 47 70,000
T3 120
2024-0 27,000
3003 0 28 2024-0 Alclad 26,000
H16 47
2024-T3 70,000
5052 0 47 2024-T3 Alclad 65,000
H36 73
6061 0 30 3003-0 16,000
T4 65 3003-H16 26,000
T6 95
7075 0 60 5052-0 28,000
T6 150 5052-H36 40,000
7075-0 33,000
7075-0 Alclad 32,000
7075-T6 83,000
7075·T6 Alclad 76,000
--- -
Figure 2-14. Minimum ultimate tensile
strength of various aluminum alloys
8. When a piece of aluminum alloy is heated in a furnace, then quenched in cold water, it is said to have
been heat-treated. Page 71
9. If there is a delay between the time the aluminum alloy is removed from the oven and it is quenched,
the grains will grow to a size that makes the metal susceptible to corrosion.
Page 71
10. After a piece of aluminum alloy has been solution heat-treated, it gains strength over a period of days.
This process is called . Page 71
11. After a piece of aluminum alloy has been solution heat-treated, it can be returned to the oven and held
at an elevated temperature for a period of time to increase its strength. This process is called
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ heat-treating. Page 71
13. Aluminum alloy may be annealed by heating it in an oven and then cooling it _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(slowly or rapidly). Page 72
15. An al uminum alloy that has been solution heat-treated and then strain hardened has the temper
designation . Page 72
16. An al uminum alloy that has been solution heat-treated and then artificially aged has the temper
designation . Page 72
17. An al uminum alloy that has been strain hardened by cold-working to its half-hard condition has the
temper designation . Page 72
18. An aluminum alloy that has been annealed has the temper designation _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 72
20. lf a nonheat-treatable aluminum alloy becomes too hard while it is being worked, some of the hardness
can be removed by . Page 72
22. Alum inum alloy sheet that is protected from corrosion by rolling a coating of pure aluminum on its
smface is called aluminum. Page 73
23. Clad aluminum al loy is _ _ __________ (stronger or weaker) than a sheet of unclad
metal of the same alloy and thickness. Page 73
24. A hard oxide film that is deposit~d on an aluminum alloy by an electrolytic process is called alan
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ film. Page 73
25. A corrosion-protective oxide film may be deposited on aluminum alloy by a c hemical called a/an
_ _ _ _ __ _ __ _ coating. Page 73
27. Titanium _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ (does or does not) retain its strength when it is exposed to a high
temperature. Page 74
29. Steel is iron with _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ and other alloying elements added in controlled amounts.
Page 74
30. The main alloying elements for corrosion-resistant steel are _ __ _ _ _ _ _ and
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ .Page74
31. The load in pounds per square inch that causes a material to break is called the
_ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ tensile strength of the material. Page 74
32. The tensile strength of a piece of steel may be determined by measuring its
___________ _ _ __ _ ___ .Page74
33. A piece of steel with a Rockwell-C hardness of 40 has a tensile strength of approximately
_____________________ pounds per square inch. Page 74
34. The strength of aluminum alloy _______ _ _ _ (does or does not) relate directly to its hardness .
Page 75
35. A piece of 2024 aluminum alloy with a Brinell hardness of 120 has a tensile strength of approx imately
____ _ __ _ _ _ pounds per square inch. Page 75
36. A riveted joint should be designed so it will fail in _______________ (bearing or shear). Page 75
37. A riveted joint connecting two sheets of 0.032-inch 2024-T3 aluminum alloy with 3/32-inch 2117T
rivets will fai l in (bearing or shear). Page 76
Solid Rivets
When aircraft manufacturers started building all -metal aircraft in the 1930s,
different manufacturers had different favored rivet head designs. Brazier
heads, modified brazier heads, button heads, mushroom heads, flat heads, and
78 °-countersunk heads were used. As aircraft construction standardized, four
rivet head designs almost completely replaced all of these others. Rivets
exposed to the airflow over the structure are usually either universal head
MS20470, or 100°-countersunk head MS20426 rivets. For rivets used in
internal structure, the round head MS20430, and the flat head MS20442 are Head Mark Alloy Code
generally used. Plain 0 1100 A
Recessed dot @ 2117T AD
Raised dot @ 2017T D
Raised double 8 2024T DO
dash
MS20470 MS20426 MS20430 MS20442
universal 100°-COuntersunk round head rivet flat head rivet
Raised cross ElB 5056H 8
head rivet head rivet Three raised ~ 7075 T73
dashes
Figure 2-1 8. Modern solid rivet design Raised circle @ 7050 T73 E
Recessed @ Titanium
large and
The material of which an aluminum alloy rivet is made is indicated by a mark small dots
on the manufactured head. Figure 2-19 shows the marks and indicates the Recessed 8 Corrosion F
dash resistant
metal or alloy of which the rivet is made. steel
A basic rule for rivet material selection is that you should use a rivet of Recessed @ Carbon
the same material as the sheet metal you are joining, but this rule is not triangle steel
genera II y adhered to. Most aircraft structure is made of 2024 alloy, but 2024
rivets must be heat-treated and used shortly after they are removed from the Figure 2-19. Head identification marks for
quench. Because of this requirement, most aircraft are designed to use 2117 solid aluminum alloy rivets
alloy rivets that can be driven just as they are received from the manufacturer.
When a higher strength rivet is req-uired, use 2017 or 2024 alloy rivets. icebox rivet. A solid rivet made o f 201 7 or
These arc called "icebox" rivets, and they must be heat-treated before they are 2024 alumi num alloy. These rivets are too
driven to prevent their cracking. Rivets of both of these alloys are heated to hard to drive in the cond ition they are
received fro m the factory. and must be
a specified temperature in an oven and are then quenched in water. They are heat-treated to soften them. They arc
soft when they arc first removed from the water and may be driven immedi- heated in a fu rnace and then quenched in
ately without cracki ng. But if they remain at normal room temperature for cold water. Immed iate ly after quenching
more than about ten minutes, they harden e nough that they will crack. To they arc soft. but with in a few hours at
prevent this hardening, they may be stored in a freezer at a temperature well room te mperature they become quite hard.
T he harden ing can be delayed for several
below zero. They will remain soft enough to drive for several weeks if they d ays by storing them in a sub-frcc7ing
are stored at a temperature of near -50°F, but they shou ld be driven within 5 icebox and hold ing them at this low
to I 0 minutes after they are removed from the freezer. temperature until they arc to be used.
Rivet Dimensions
The diameter of a solid rivet is the diameter of its shank, as seen in Figure
2-20. In rivet specifications, the diameter is given in 1/ 32 -inch increments as
the first dash number following the material code for the rivet.
Length The length of solid rivets is measured from the portion of the head that
is flush with the surface of the metal sheet to the end of its shank. This length
is measured in 1/winch increments and is given in ri vet specifications as the
Shank
diameter
- Shank
diameter
second dash number.
Rivet Identification
A solid aluminum alloy rivet is identified by a number that indicates its head
Figure 2-20. Measurement of an aircraft
shape, alloy, diameter, and length. The letters MS or AN identify the speci-
solid rivet fications under which the rivet is manufactured. The number indicates the
shape of the head, the code that follows this number identifies the alloy, the
first dash number is the diameter in 1/ 32-inch increments, and the second
dash number is the length in 1/winch increments. This identification is shown
in the example in Figure 2-21.
Figure 2-21. Meaning of rivet :Figure 2-22. Examples of aluminum alloy rivet designation
specification numbers
Special Fasteners
There are many locations on an aircraft where it is not possible to reach both
sides of the structure, and special blind rivets must be install ed. In this section
several types of blind rivets and other special fasteners that are used in place
of solid rivets or bolts are discussed.
To install a Rivnut, drill the hole and cut the keyway with a special keyway
cutter. Screw the Rivnut onto the threaded mandrel of a heading tool, such as
the one in Figure 2-28. Insert the Rivnut into the hole with the key in the key-
way and squeeze the movable handle. This upsets the Rivnut's shank, letting
you turn the mandrel crank to remove the tool from the installed Rivnut.
Figure 2-28. A Rivnut heading tool
High-Strength Pin Rivets
Modern aircraft construction techniques require as much automation as pos-
sible, and in locations where a high-strength fastener is required that is not
likely to be removed in normal maintenance, a pin rivet suc h as the Hi-Shear
~
rivet in Figure 2-29 may have been used. This fastener may be installed rap-
idly and has the same shear strength as an equi valent size structural steel bolt.
Pin ri vets are installed by inserting the body of the rivet with the correct
grip length through a hole that has been reamed to the correct size. The shank I
of these rivets does not expand to completely fill the hole as does the shank
of a conventional solid rivet.
The correct grip length allows no more than 1/ 16 inch of the straight por-
tion of the shank to extend through the material, and the end of the unswaged
metal collar should be slightly hig her than the shearing edge of the pin. It is
permissible to use a 0.032-inch steel washer between the collar and the ma-
terial if necessary to position the collar. Figure 2-29. High-strength steel pin rivets
To drive a pin rivet, hold a heavy bucking bar against the flat head and a may he installed in an aircraft structure in
Hi-Shear rivet set such as the one in Figure 2-30 against the collar. Impacts locations that would normally use steel
bolts loaded in shear.
from the rivet gun swage the collar into the groove in the pin, and the sheating
edge on the pin trims the top edge of the collar until it forms a smooth cone,
as seen in Figure 2-3 1.
rivet set. A tool used to drive aircraft solid
To remove a pin rivet, use a small, sharp chisel to split the collar and rivets . It is a piece of hardened steel with a
pry it off the pin. After removing the collar, tap the pin from the hole with recess the shape or the rivet head in one
a hammer. encl. The other end f its into the rivet gun.
Pin is too long. Remove collar, Pin is too short. Remove collar
install washer, or use shorter pin. and use longer pin.
38. A solid aluminum alloy rivet with a dimple on its head is made of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ alloy.
Page 79
39. A solid aluminum alloy rivet with no mark on its head is made of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ alloy. Page 79
40. A solid aluminum alloy rivet with a raised dot on its head is made of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ alloy.
Page 79
41. A solid aluminum alloy rivet with two raised dashes on its head is made of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
alloy. Page 79
42. A solid aluminum alloy rivet with a raised cross on its head is made of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ alloy.
Page 79
44. Icebox rivets must be heat-treated before they are driven. These rivets are made of either of two alloys;
these are and . Page 79
45. The proper ri vet to use for joining sheets of magnesium alloy is a ri vet made of _ _ _ _ _ _ __
alloy. Page 80
46. Identify the head style, alloy, diameter, and length or each of these solid rivets:
a. MS20426AD-4-4 Head , Alloy _ _ _ _ __ _
Diameter , Length _ _ _ _ _ __
b. MS20470DD-6-8 Head , Alloy _ _ _ _ _ __
Diameter _ __ _____ , Length _ _ _ __ __
Page 80
48. Friction-lock Cherry rivets (are or are not) approved to replace solid rivets
on a size-for-size basis. Page 8 /
49. Mechanical-lock Cherry ri vets (are or are not) approved to replace solid rivets
on a size-for-size basis. Page 82
50. The stem or a mechanical-lock Cherry rivet is held in the hollow shank by a
_ _ _ _ __ __ _ _ __ that is swaged into a groove in the stem before the stem breaks off.
Page 82
5 1. A special fastener that provides a threaded hole in a piece of thin sheet metal is the
_ _ _ _ _ __ __ __ .Page83
52. High-strength pin rivets are desigi1ed to be used for _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (shear or tensile) loads.
Page 83
Layout Tools
Aircraft drawings are discussed in the General textbook of this Aviation
Maintenance Technician Series. In a detail drawing, all of the dimensions are
given that are required to manufacture a part. This information, which
includes all of the needed dimensions, angles, and radii, should not be scaled
from the drawing because the paper stretches or shrinks, but should be laid out
directly on the metal or on a template using the dimensions shown on the
drawing.
Combination Set
The combination set in Figure 2-32 is a useful layout tool. When you place
the stock, or square, head against the side of a piece of material, the blade
extends across it at an exact 90° or 45° angle. Use the protractor head when
you need an angle of other than 90° or 45°.
Use the center head to locate and mark the center of around object. Notice
that the head is in the form of two arms at right angles to each other, and the
blade intersects this angle. To locate the center of a circle, lay the blade across
it with the arms of the head tight against the outside edge and draw a line along
the edge of the blade. Move the tool around about 90° and draw another line
crossing the one just drawn. The intersection of these lines is in the center of
the circle.
Stock head
Figure 2-32. The combination set is one of the most widely used tools for sheet
metal layout.
Figure 2-33. When using a steel scale to determine the distance between two marks, do not
use the end of the scale, but measure from one of its inch marks.
One handy type of steel scale is the hook rule, seen in Figure 2-34. The
inside edge of the hook is aligned exactly with the end of the scale. Place it
over the edge of the object to be measured. You can make measurements
quickly and easily from the edge to the marks on the scale. A hook rule is the
most convenient way to get measurements from the edge when there is a
radius involved.
Figure 2-34. A hook rule is used for making measurements to the edge of a piece of
material. It is especially helpful if the material has a radius or a bevel on its edge.
Dividers
Dividers are used for transferring distances from a steel scale to the metal
being laid out and for dividing a line into equal spaces, for example, when
laying out a row of rivets. See Figure 2-35. Figure 2-35. Dividers are used to transfer
distances from a steel scale to the metal
being laid out.
Punches
Mark the exact location for drilled holes by holding the point of a prick punch
at the location marked on the metal and tapping it lightly with a small hammer.
The sharp point of the punch makes it easy to mark an exact location, but it does
not indent the metal at the correct angle to start a drill.
twist drill. A metal cutting tool turned in a After marking the locations of all drilled holes with a prick punch, enlarge
drill press or hand-he ld drill motor. A tw ist the marks with a center punch. This punch is heavier than a prick punch, and
drill has a straight shank and spiraled its point is ground with a 60° angle, which is correct for making a twist drill
flut es. T he cutting edge is g round on the
start cutting. Center punches are available in sizes ranging from about three
end of the spiraled flu tes.
inches to five inches long. Be sure to use the punch that makes the appropriate
starting indentation for the size drill you will be using.
Often when making a new piece of skin for an aircraft repair, you must
use the original skin as a pattern. To do this, use a transfer punch to mark the
center of the rivet holes. The end of the punch is the diameter of the rivet hole
and has a sharp point in the center of its flat end. The metal sheets are held
tightly together and the transfer punch is placed through a rivet hole and
tapped-lightly with a small hammer. The sharp point makes a small indenta-
tion like that produced by a prick punch, but at the location of the exact center
ofthe rivet hole in the pattern.
Pin punches are used, not so much for layout, but for removing rivets after
their heads have been drilled through, and for aligning sheets of metal by
placing the punch through rivet holes in each of the sheets. These punches are
available in sizes for most standard aircraft rivets, and all have straight shanks.
Cutting Tools
In both manufacturing and repair of sheet metal aircraft, some of the most
important tools are those that cut the metal. It is extremely important to cut
the metal at exactly the correct location, and to keep the edges free of cracks
and burrs. This section discusses the cutting tools used in a shop first, and then
the tools you as a technician will have in your personal tool chest.
Squaring Shear
The squaring shear in Figure 2-37 (Page 90) is one of the most useful tools
in a sheet metal shop. These foot-operated shears normally accept a four-foot-
wide sheet of thin sheet metal. The line on which the metal is to be cut is
placed directly above the cutting edge of the bed of the shear, and it is held
securely while the foot treadl e is pressed down. Some squaring shears have
a clamp near the cutting edge that allows you to clamp the metal so your
fingers are not near the cutting edge when cutting small pieces of metal.
Large power-operated shears using energy stored in a n ywheel to drive
the cutting edge are used in steel fabrication shops to cut across sheets of
heavy steel.
Throatless Shears
Throatless shears can cut across any size sheet of metal and can cut metal
heavier than the foot-operated squaring shears. Their operation is much like
a pair of heavy-duty, short-blade scissors. See Figure 2-38 on the next page.
Scroll Shears
Scroll shears are used to cut irregular lines on the inside of a sheet without
cutting through to the edge. The upper cutting blade is stationary, while the
lower blade is moved up and down with the handle. See Figure 2-39.
Job selector
~--dial
Speed indicator
Butt welder
Grinder wheel
Transmission - ""*::'::?11
clutch
Hacksaws
The most widely used metal-cutting saw is the hacksaw that holds a narrow,
flexible steel blade under tension in an adjustable frame.
Hacksaw blades are about 1/ 2-inch wide and are available in both 10- and
12-inch lengths. Blades are available with the number of teeth ranging from
14 to 32 per inch and may be made o f either carbon steel or molybdenum steel.
Files
file. A hand-held cutting tool used to After cutting the metal to almost the correct size and shape, finish it by
remove a small amount of metal with cutting the edges with a file. A file is so familiar to most of us that we often
each stroke.
do not realize its importance or give it the care it deserves.
The teeth that cross the file at an angle are cutting tools and must receive
the same care as any other cutting tool. The cut, or coarseness, of the teeth is
designated by a series of numbers or by the name of the cut. The names,
ranging from coarsest to smoothest, are: rough cut, coarse cut, bastard cut,
second cut, smooth cut, and dead smooth cut. The designation of the cut is the
same for all sizes of files, but the teeth on a small file are closer together than
the teeth of the same-named cut on a larger file.
Files with a single set of teeth crossing the body at an angle of 65° to
85° are called single-cut files, and those with two sets of teeth, one crossing
at an angle of 45° and the other crossing at an angle of 70° to 80°, are called
double-cut files.
vixen file. A metal-cutting hand file that Vixen files are special cutting tools whose teeth are curved across the
has curved teeth across its faces. V ixen body of the file. These files are designed to remove a rather large amount of
files are used to remove large amounts of
metal with each stroke and are used only on soft metal.
soft metal.
If you give files a reasonable amount of care they will give good ser-
tang. A tapered shank sticking out f rom
vice. Always match them to the work: use the right type and size of file, and
the blade of a knife or a file. T he handle of choose the degree of coarseness to give the type of cut required. Never use a
a knife or fi le is mounted on the tang. file without slipping a handle over the tang to protect your hands.
Chisels
A chisel is a simple cutting tool made of a piece of hardened and tempered tool
steel. The blade of the chisel is ground with a cutting edge, and is used to shear
metal by driving it into the metal with a hammer.
There are a number of types of chisels in use. The most common is the flat
chisel, the cutting edge of which is ground to an angle of approximately 70°,
and into a convex shape. This convex shape concentrates the forces of the
hammer blows in the center of the cutting edge. See Figure 2-43. Single-cut file Double-cut file Vixen file
Cape chisels have a narrow blade and are used to remove the head of a
rivet after it has been drilled through. See Figure 2-44. Figure 2-42. Hand files
Cutting edge of a flat chisel is ground to Figure 2-44. A cape chisel may be used to
an angle of approximately 70°. remove the head of a rivet after it has been
drilled through.
Lip or
cutting edge
Heel angle
(12-W)
80 0.0135 22 0.1570
79 0.0145 21 0.1590
78 0.0160 20 0.1610
1/64 0.0156 19 0.1660
77 0.0180 18 0.1695
76 0.0200 11/64 0.1719
75 0.0210 17 0.1730
74 0.0225 16 0.1770
73 0.0240 15 0.1800
72 0.0250 14 0.1820
71 0.0260 13 0.1850
70 0.0280 3/16 0.1875
69 0.0290 12 0.1890
68 0.0310 11 0.1910
1/32 0.0313 10 0.1935
67 0.0320 9 0.1960
66 0.0330 8 0.1990
65 0.0350 7 0.2010
64 0.0360 13/64 0.2031
63 0.0370 6 0.2040
62 0.0380 5 0.2055
61 0.0390 4 0.2090
60 0.0400 3 0.2130
59 0.0410 7/32 0.2187
58 0.0420 2 0.2210
57 0.0430 1 0.2280
56 0.0465 A 0.2340
3/64 0.0469 15/64 0.2344
55 0.0520 B 0.2380
54 0.0550 c 0.2420
53 0.0595 D 0.2460
1/16 0.0625 E 1/4 0.2500
52 0.0635 F 0.2570
51 0.0670 G 0.2610
50 0.0700 17/64 0.2656
49 0.0730 H 0.2660
48 0.0760 I 0.2720
5/64 0.0781 J 0.2770
47 0.0785 K 0.2810
46 0.0810 9/32 0.2812
45 0.0820 L 0.2900
44 0 .0860 M 0.2950
43 0.0890 19/64 0.2969
42 0.0935 N 0.3020
3/32 0.0937 5/16 0.3125
41 0.0960 0 0.3160
40 0.0980 p 0.3230
39 0.0995 21/64 0.3281
38 0.1015 a 0.3320
37 0.1040 R 0.3390
36 0.1065 11/32 0.3438
7/64 0.1094 s 0.3480
35 0.1100 T 0.3580
34 0.1110 23/64 0.3594
33 0.1130 u 0.3680
32 0.1160 3/8 0.3750
31 0.1200 v 0.3770
1/8 0.1250 w 0.3860
30 0.1285 25/64 0.3906
29 0.1360 X 0.3970
28 0.1405 y 0.4040
9/64 0.1406 13/32 0.4062
27 0.1440 z 0.4130
26 0.1470 27/64 0.4219
25 0.1495 7/16 0.4375
24 0.1520 29/64 0.4331
23 0.1540 15/32 0.4688
5/32 0.1562 31/64 0.4844
1/2 0.5000
Figure 2-48. Twist drill si:es
Figure 2-49. Attachmenrs for drilling Extension drill that uses a long, rigid shaft and conventional twist drill .
holes in hard-to-reach locations.
When using small diameter, extra-long drill, place piece of aluminum tubing
around drill to prevent it whipping.
Cornice Brake
The cornice, or leaf, brake is one or the most familiar brakes in a maintenance cornice brake. A large shop tool used to
shop. The metal to be bent is clamped between the bed of the brake and the make straight bends across a sheet of
metal. Cornice brakes arc often called
top nose bar, with the sight line marked on the metal directly below the edge
leaf brakes .
of the nose bar. (This is discussed in detail in the section on metal layout
and forming beginning on Page 105.) The bending leaf is lifted, bending the
metal against the radius on the top nose bar.
Figure 2-51. A cornice brake is used for making straight bends across sheets of metal.
Box Brake
.
A cornice brake can only bend the two opposite sides of a box, but a box, or
finger, brake can bend up all four sides. A box brake is much like a cornice
brake except the top nose bar is divided into sections called fingers. The brake
is adjusted for the correct metal thickness and bend radius, and two opposite
sides of the box are bent up. The metal is turned 90° and the fingers are
adjusted so the two formed sides of the box fit between two fingers, and the
final two sides of the box are bent.
Radius roller
Drive roller
Figure 2-52. Slip roll formers are used for making large radius bends in sheet metal.
Sandbag
You can form compound curves in a piece of sheet metal by bumping it with
a soft-face mallet and a sandbag. The sandbag is made of canvas or leather and
filled with clean dry sand. A depression is made in the bag and the metal is
bumped into the depression. Always start at the outside edges of the bend and
work toward the center. Continually check the work with a template to be sure
the metal takes the desired shape.
Riveting Tools
Production riveting on an assembly is done with a high-tech riveting machine
that drills the hole, countersinks it, drops the rivet in place, squeezes it to the
proper compression, and automatically moves over to the location for the next
rivet. The riveting done in maintenance shops is not so automated and is done
with a rivet gun or a hand-held compression, or squeeze, riveter.
Sliding valve
Piston Set sleeve
Throttle
Regulator adjustment
screw
Air path
Fast-hitting, pistol
grip rivet gun Fast-hitting, push button rivet gun
Cup in this rivet set This set is correct for Flush rivet set extends well beyond the
is too small. this rivet. head of rivet and is slightly crowned.
Figure 2-57. The radius of the cup in a river set is slightly grearer than the radius of the
river head. This a/loll'S the blows from the rivet gun to he concentrated on the rivet head.
Bucking Bars
The rivet gun drives the rivet set against the manufactured head of a rivet, but
it is the bucking bar that actually fonns the shop, or bucked, head of the rivet.
Bucking bars are made of hardened and polished steel and are available in
many shapes and sizes. When choosing a bucking bar, match the weight of
the bar with the size of the rivet.
3/32 2 to 3
1/8 3 to4
5/32 3-1/2 to 4-1/2
3/16 4to5
1/4 5 to 6-1/2
Figure 2-58. 1)•pical bucking bars Figure 2-59. Relationship between river
size and proper bucking bar weight
Body
,_,...,--- Spring
Locks
Spreader Rivet Diameter Cleco Fastener
(inch) Color
Figure 2-61. Cleco sheer meta/fastener Figure 2-62. Color-coding identifies the
size of a Cleco fastener.
Hole Finder
When replacing a piece of aircraft skin, you must drill the holes in the skin so
they line up exactly with the holes in the structure beneath it. To do this, use
a hole finder, o r strap duplicator. This tool is made of two straps of metal spot-
welded together at one end. The open end of one strap has a drill bushing that
fits the prope r drill for the rivet, and the open end of the other strap has a
pin that fits into the rivet hole. T his pin is exactl y in line with the hole in the
drill bushi ng. To use this tool, slip the hole finder over the new skin. The pin
drops into the ri vet hole in the structu re below the skin. T he drill bushi ng
is now exactly over the hole and you can drill the skin through the bushing.
Spot welds
Figure 2-63. A hole finder may be slipped over/he edge of a new piece of aircraft skin ro
position rhe drill directly over the hole in the original strucw re.
Chip Chaser
When holes are dri lled through partially assembled sheets of metal, chips are
left between the sheets that can prevent the sheets from fitting tightly together.
You must remove these chips with a chi p c haser. T hese can be purchased, but
you can make a good one with a worn-out hacksaw blade. Grind off the teeth
and grind a notch into its edge at one end. Put a handle on the other end oft he
blade, and you have a very handy and e ffective tool. Slip the blade between
the sheets and maneuver it until the chips are in the notch, then pull them out.
54. Two things that determine the correct speed for a bandsaw blade are the type of metal being cut and
its . Page 91
55. When choosing the number of teeth for a hacksaw blade, choose one that will allow at least
_ _ _ _ __ ___ (how many) teeth to be on the material being cut. Page 92
58. A number 30 twist drill is _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ (larger or smaller) than a number 50 drill. Page 95
59. Straight bends across a sheet of metal can be made with a _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ brake. Page 97
60. Straight bends with a large radius are made in a piece of sheet metal with a
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _ __ _ _ _ __ .Page98
61. Compound curves in a piece of sheet metal may be made with a soft-face mallet and a
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ __ .Page98
62. A large-diameter hard rivet should be driven with as _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (many or few) blows from
the rivet gun as possible. Page 99
63. The radius of the cup in a rivet set should be _ _ _ _ _ __ _ __ (greater or smaller) than the
radius of the rivet head it fits. Page 101
-
64. The proper bucking bar used to drive a 1/s-inch rivet should weigh between _ _ _ __ _ _ and
_ __ __ _ pounds. Page 101
65. The Cleco fastener to use in a hole for a 3/3z-inch rivet is colored _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ __ _
Page 103
Send Radius
When you bend a piece of metal , the material on the inside of the bend is bend radius. The radius of the inside of
subjected to a compressive stress and that on the outside is subjected to a a bend.
tensile stress. There is a neutral plane, or neutral axis, within the metal that
is not subjected to either a tensile or compressive stress. This plane lies at
44.5% of the thickness of the metal from the inside radius of the bend, but for neutral axis (neutr al pla ne). A li ne
practical purposes, the neutral plane can be considered to be in the midd le of through a piece of material that is bent.
the metal thickness. The material in the outside of the bend is
stretched and that on the inside of the bend
Figure 2-64 shows the min imum bend radius, measured on the ins ide of
is shrunk. The materi al along the neutral
the bend, that can be used with the various aluminum alloys without weak- plane is neither shrunk nor stretched.
ening the metal.
106 AVI ATION M AINTENA 1CE TECHNICIAN S ERIES Volume 1: AI RFRAME STRUCTURES
Bend Allowance
Be nd allowance is the actual amount of material used in the be nd. Find it by
using a chart such as the one in Figure 2-67. In this chart, the top number in
each group at the intersection of the metal thickness and bend radius is the
bend all owance for a 90° bend. The bottom numbe r is the bend allowance for Figure 2-67. Bend allowance chart
each degree of bend. showing the amount of material used in a
90 ° bend and in each degree of bend
0.020 .062 .113 .161 .210 .259 .309 .358 .406 .455 .505 .55 4 .603 .702 .799
.000693 .001251 .001792 .002333 .002874 .003433 .003977 .004515 .005056 .005614 .006155 .006695 .007795 .00887 7
0.025 .066 .116 .165 .214 .263 .313 .362 .410 .459 .509 .558 .607 .705 .803
.000736 .001294 .001835 .002376 .00291 7 .003476 .00401 7 .004558 .005098 .005657 .0061 98 .006739 .007838 .008920
0.028 .068 .11 9 .167 .216 .265 .315 .364 .412 .461 .511 .560 .609 .708 .805
.000759 .001318 .001859 .002400 .002941 .003499 .004040 .004581 .005122 .005680 .006221 .006762 .007862 .008944
0.032 .071 .121 .170 .218 .267 .317 .366 .415 .463 .514 .562 .611 .710 .807
.000787 .001345 .001886 .002427 .002968 .003526 .004067 .004608 .005149 .005708 .006249 .006789 .007889 .008971
0.038 .075 .126 .174 .223 .272 .322 .371 .419 .468 .518 .567 .616 .715 .812
.000837 .001396 .001937 .002478 .003019 .003577 .004118 .004659 .005200 .005758 .006299 .006840 .007940 .009021
0.040 .077 .127 .176 .224 .273 .323 .372 .421 .469 .520 .568 .617 .716 .813
.000853 .001411 .001952 .002493 .003034 .003593 .004134 .004675 .005215 .005774 .006315 .006856 .007955 .009037
0.051 .134 .183 .232 .280 .331 .379 .428 .477 .527 .576 .624 .723 .821
.001413 .002034 .002575 .003116 .003675 .004215 .004756 .005297 .005855 .006397 .006934 .008037 .009119
0.064 .144 .192 .241 .290 .340 .389 .437 .486 .536 .585 .634 .732 .830
.001595 .002136 .002676 .003218 .003776 .004317 .004858 .005399 .005957 .006498 .007039 .008138 .009220
0.07 2 .198 .247 .296 .346 .394 .443 .492 .542 .591 .639 .738 .836
.002202 .002743 .003284 .003842 .004283 .004924 .005465 .006023 .006564 .007105 .008205 .009287
0.078 .202 .251 .300 .350 .399 .447 .496 .546 .595 .644 .743 .840
.002249 .002790 .003331 .003889 .004430 .004963 .005512 .006070 .006611 .007 152 .008252 .009333
0.081 .204 .253 .302 .352 .401 .449 .498 .548 .598 .646 .745 .842
.002272 .002813 .003354 .003912 .004453 .004969 .005535 .006094 .006635 .007176 .008275 .009357
0.091 .212 .260 .309 .359 .408 .456 .505 .555 .604 .653 .752 .849
.002350 .002891 .003432 .003990 .004531 .005072 .005613 .0061 72 .006713 .007254 .008353 .009435
0.094 .214 .262 .311 .361 .410 .459 .507 .558 .606 .655 .754 .851
.002374 .002914 .003455 .004014 .004555 .005096 .005637 .006195 .006736 .007277 .008376 .009458
.
0.102 .268 .317 .367 .416 .464 .513 .563 .612 .661 .760 .857
.002977 .003518 .004076 .004617 .005158 .005699 .006257 .006798 .007339 .008439 .009521
0.109 .273 .321 .372 .420 .469 .518 .568 .617 .665 .764 .862
.003031 .003572 .004131 .004672 .005213 .005754 .006312 .006853 .007394 .008493 .009575
·-
0.125 .284 .333 .383 .432 .480 .529 .579 .628 .677 .776 .873
.003156 .003697 .004256 .004797 .005338 .005878 .006437 .006978 .007519 .008618 .009700
0.156 .355 .405 .453 .502 .551 .601 .650 .698 .797 .895
.003939 .004497 .005038 .005579 .006120 .006679 .007220 .007761 .008860 .009942
0.188 .417 .476 .525 .573 .624 .672 .721 .820 .917
.004747 .005288 .005829 .006370 .006928 .007469 .008010 .009109 .010191
t
Flat 1
Metal thickness = 0.040
Bend radius = 0.250 t t
Flat 3 [
MLL 11_ I MLL3
r- + +- f- l._
~ I I ~
j. Flat2 -----;~l
M L L2 ----~
mold line. A line used in the development Mold Line Length 1 = 1 inch
MLL 2 = 2 inches
of a flat pattern for a formed piece of sheet MLL 3 = 1 inch
metal. The mold line is an extension of the
flat side of a part beyond the radius. The Figure 2-68. Sheet-metal channel used for explanation of layout
mold line dimensions of a part is the
di mension made to the intersection of
mold lines and is the dimension the part
To lay out this channel, follow these steps:
would have if its corners had no radius.
1. Choose the correct bend radius.
2. Find the setback.
3. Find the length of each of the flats.
4. Find the bend allowance.
5. Lay out the flat pattern.
6. Draw the sight lines on the flat pattern.
/
'v .
r- 0.71
:1 0.42
~
1.42
3.68
:I 0.42
~ 0.71~
)>
Sight line
Bend tangent line
QJ
.<::;:
Radius bar Figure 2-70. Draw a sigh! line inside of the bend allowance area that is one be11d radius
from the bend tangent line that will be under the radius bar.
Folding a Box
You can form a box the same way as the channel just described, but you must
Figure 2-71. Sight down over the edge of also drill relief holes at the intersection of the inside bend tangent lines, and
the radius bar and adjust the metal in the
brake until the sight line is directly below
bend it in a box brake. The relief holes, whose diameter is approximately
the tip of the radius bar. Clamp the brake twice the bend radius, relieve stresses in the metal as it is bent and prevent
and make the bend. the metal tearing. Two opposite sides of the box are bent first, and then the
fingers-of the brake adjusted so the folded-up sides will ride up in the cracks
between the fingers when the leaf is raised to bend the other two sides.
See Figure 2-72.
r elief hole. A hole drilled at the point at
which two bend lines meet in a piece of
sheet metal. This hole spreads the stresses
caused by the bends and prevents the metal
cracking.
Doubler: same
material and gage ~ Inside bend ~
as original section tangent lines I
I
Relief holes
Figure 2-73. A formed reinforcing doubler is used when splicing a new section of a
fuselage ring in place. This doubler has compound cun,es.
Figure 2-74. A forming block and backup block used for forming compound curves in a
piece of aluminum alloy.
Cut the sheet metal blank from the same alloy and thickness as is used in the
fuselage ring, and drill holes to fit over the alignment pins. Make the blank
slightly larger than needed, as it can be trimmed to the exact dimensions when
the forming is complete, but do not make it excessively large because one side
has to stretch while the other side must shrink. Remove all burrs from the
edges of the material, especially in the side that must stretch because a nick
or burr could cause the material to crack.
Place the metal between the forming block and backup block and clamp
Figure 2-75. Back the metal up wilh a them tightly in a large vise with the concave curve up. Use a soft-face mallet
piece of tapered hardwood to control and begin working the metal down from near the ends, working toward the
!he amount of bending done by each
center. Hold a tapered wedge of hardwood behind the metal as is shown in
blow of the mallei.
Figure 2-75 and strike the metal as near the edge of the radius as you can. Fold
arbor press. A press with either a
the metal down against the forming block by bending it just a little with each
mec hanica ll y or hydraulicall y operated blow of the mallet. As you fold it down, the metal will buckle, but keep these
ram used in a maintenance shop for a buckles small and they can be worked out by shrinking the metal. Make the
variety of pressing functi ons. bend using as few blows as possible to keep from work-hardening the
material, while at the same time use enough blows to keep the buckles down
joggle. A small offset near the edge of a to a s ize that can be worked out completely.
piece of sheet metal. It all ows one sheet of
metal to overlap another sheet while
maintaining a flush surface.
over so the convex side is up and clamp it tightly in the vise. Begin working I
this side in the center of the bend and work toward the ends. The metal on this
side must be stretched. Use the hardwood wedge behind the metal and form
the curve with as few blows as possible, but with enough blows that the metal
is stretched gradually so it does not crack and split.
Side view
It is often necessary to curve an extruded angle so it will conform to the
shape of the structure. Gentle curves can be formed by shrin king or stretching
one of the sides. To form aconvexcurve, stretch the side by hammering it with
a soft-face mallet while holding it flat against a piece of steel. This thins and r-~ ___________ _______ ___ ____ jTop view
stretches the side and bends the angle. See Figure 2-76. Bulb
Form a concave curve in an extruded angle by shrinking one of the sides.
Figure 2-76. A convex curve can be
Place the angle over a piece of hardwood that has had a V -shaped notch cut formed in an extruded angle by stretching
in it. Hammer on the standing side of the angle. The standing side of the angle one side of the angle.
must be shrunk to form the curve, and special care must be taken to prevent
the material from buckling. It takes practice and skill to know exactly how
hard to strike the material to form it without either excessively strain-
hardening it or causing it to buckle. See Figure 2-77.
66. The minimum bend radius for a piece of 0.040 2024T4 aluminum alloy is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
inch. Page 105
67. The bend radius specified for a piece of aircraft sheet metal is the radius of the
_ _ _ _ __ _____ (inside or outside) of the bend. Page 105
68. The metal on the inside of a bend is under a _ _ ________ (compressive or tensile) stress.
Page 105
69. When making a bend in a piece of sheet metal, the metal will be the strongest if the bend is made
_ _ _ __ __ _ _ _ _ _ (with or across) the grain of the metal. Page 105
70. The minimum bend radius that should be used on a piece of 0.051-inch 7075-T6 sheet metal is
_ _ __ ____ inch. Page 105
71. The setback required for making a 45° bend is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___ (more or less) than the
setback for a 90° angle. Page 106
72. The correct setback for a 135° bend in a piece of 0.040 sheet metal with a 'Is-inch bend radius is
_ _ _ __ _ inch.Page106
73. The bend allowance for a 90° bend in a piece of 0.051 aluminum alloy bent around a 'Is-inch radius is
_ _ _ __ _____ inch.Page 107
74. The bend allowance for a 45° bend in a piece of 0.040 aluminum alloy bent around a 'Is-inch radius is
_ _ _ _ _ __ __ inch. Page 107
75. A channel using a '14-inch bend radius will require _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (more or less) material
than one using a 'Is-inch bend radius. Page 109
76. Relief holes drilled in the corner of a pattern for a box should be drilled at the intersection of the
_ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ __ lines. Page 111
77. A sight line is drawn inside the bend allowance portion of a flat pattern a distance of one
_ _ _ _ __ ____ from the bend tangent line that is clamped under the radius bar. Page 110
114 A VI AT!ON M ArNTE:--; ANCE TECHNICIAN S ERIES Volume 1: A1 RFR AME STRUCT URES
78. When forming a concave curve in a piece of sheet metal using a forming block, the forming should begin
at the (center or ends) of the curve. Page 112
79. When forming a convex curve in a piece of sheet metal using a forming block, the forming should begin at
the (center or ends) of the curve. Page 113
80. Flanging the edges of a lightening hole in a stamped sheet metal wing rib gives the rib added
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (strength or stiffness). Page 113
Rivet Selection
When selecting rivets for a seam in an aircraft skin or for joining other pieces
of aircraft sheet metal, take several things into consideration:
• If possible the rivetshouldnotrequire heat treatment before it is driven. This
means that if the requi red size is not excessive, AD (2117T) alloy rivets
should be used rather than D (20 I 7T) or DO (2024T) rivets.
• If magnesium sheets are to be joined, B (5056T) rivets should be used.
• Countersunk head rivets should be used in locations where smooth air-
flow is important. This essentially means at least on the forward half of the
upper surface of the wing.
• Uni versal head rivets may be used for any location in which a protruding
head ri vet is required.
• The rivet size and material must be chosen so that the shear strength of
the rivet is slightly less than the bearing strength of the sheets of material
being joined. This allows the joint to-fail by the rivets shearing rather than
the metal tearing.
• Ri vet size is chosen so the diameter of the rivet is approximately three times
the thickness of the thickest sheet being j oined.
Rivet Layout
When laying out the rows of rivets, the rivets should be close enough together
to get maximum strength in the joint, but should not be so close that the holes
weaken the material. T he rivets must be placed far enough away from the edge
of the metal that it does not tear. See Figure 2-80 on the next page.
__L_f--~
••··· ···••
••••• · ·····
•••• • Edge distance 0.25 Typical
- Rivet spacing 0.42 Typical
- - -- - - - - 6.00 - - - -- - - - - -
Figure 2-80. Rivet layout for a two-row splice designed to carry 50% of the metal strength.
Transverse Pitch
gage (rivet). The distance between rows of
ri vets in a multirow seam. Gage is also Transverse pitch, also called rivet gage, is the distance between rows of rivets
cal led transverse pitch. in a multirow seam. Transverse pitch should be 75% of the rivet pitch.
Layout Practice
Consider this problem. We want to rivet together two pieces of0.040 2024T3
material that are 6 inches wide so that the strength of the riveted joint will carry
at least 50% of the strength of the metal. Protruding head rivets are to be used.
Take these steps:
• Find the strength needed by the joint.
• Select the rivet.
• Lay out the rivet pattern.
This joint is required to carry 50% of this strength, so it must carry 8,400
pounds.
16,800 · 0.50 = 8,400 pounds
0.016 ~ 4.9
0.020 6.9 4.9 3.9
0.025 8 .6 ~ 3.9
0 .032 11.1 6.2 ~ 3.3
0.036 12.5 7.0 4.5 ~ 2.4
0.040
0.051
13.8 7.7
9.8
5 .0
6.4
3.5
4.5
~
2.5
3.3
3.3
0.064 12.3 8.1 5.6 3.1 3.3
0.081 10.2 7.1 3.9 3.3
0.091 11.4 7 .9 4.4 3.3
0. 102 12.8 8 .9 4.9 3.4
0.128 11.2 6.2 3.4
Notes:
1. For stringers in the upper surface of a wing, or in a fuselage, 80% of the
number of rivets shown may be used.
2. For intermediate frames, 60% of the number of rivets shown may be used.
3. For single-lap sheet joints, 75% of the number shown may be used.
4. Combinations of sheet thickness and rivet size above the line in each column
will fail in bearing (the sheet will tear). Combinations below the line will fail in
shear (the rivet will shear).
Figure 2-81. Chart for determining correct number of rivets for a repair
l j-- 7f Countersinking
The determination to countersink or dimple depends upon the thickness of
Desired: top skin thicker than head of rivet the top sheet of metaL The metal must be thicker than the head of the rivet.
See Figure 2-83.
Use a 100° countersink cutter with a 1/ 8-inch pilot, such as the one in
Figure 2-84. Use a piece of scrap metal of the same thickness as is being riveted
Acceptable: top skin as thick as head of rivet and drill several number 30 holes in it. Use these holes to set the depth of the
countersink tool. Adjust the countersink stop until it cuts a depression that
s;) cz ': M
: z J!.\.1 allows the rivet head to be flush with the surface of the metal.
(\.__~)
Dimpling
Not acceptable: top skin thinner than head
of rivet. If the metal to be joined is too thin to be countersunk, you can dimple it. This
is a process in which you press the edges of the rivet hole into a cone shape
Figure 2-83. Countersinking that allows the rivet head to be flu sh with the surface of the metal. There are
two methods of dimpling a piece of metal: radius dimpling and coin dimpling.
Radius Dimpling
Radius dimpling is done by pressing a male die through the rivet hole and into
a female die. The male die is struck a blow with a hammer that forms the metal
into the recess that allows the rivet head to be flush with the metal. The edges
of a radius-dimpled hole curve smoothly into the hole without any sharp
edges. See Figure 2-85.
Pilot
u
Compression Riveting
When both sides of the material to be riveted are accessible to a rivet squeezer l '\
such as those seen in Figure 2-60 on Page I 02, use compression riveting.
Set up the riveter for the chosen rivet and the thickness of material by When both sheets are too thin for counter-
installing the correct cupped set in the stationary jaw and a flat set in the sinking, both are coin- or radius-dimpled.
movable jaw. Install washers between the jaws and the dollies, or sets, to
adjust the distance they will be separated when the jaws are fully closed. This Figure 2-87. Hole preparation for
flush riveting
distance is equal to the total thickness of the materials beingjoined plus one
half of the rivet shank diameter. This will allow the rivet to be upset with the
proper size shop head. Squeeze a few rivets in a piece of scrap material of the
correct thickness to check the adjustment of the sets. To use this type of
riveter, just install the rivet in the hole, place the rivet head in the cupped dolly
in the stationary jaw, and pull the trigger. Air pressure on a piston inside the
squeezer forces the movable jaw toward the stationary jaw and squeezes the
rivet, forming the shop head. See Figure 2-88 on the next page.
Flat dolly
4. Select the conect bucking bar and position it against the rivet shank.
5. Drive the rivet.
6. Evaluate the rivet.
Moving jaw
I
~ --_I
See Figure 2-89.
Select the Bucking Bar and Position It Against the Rivet Shank
Choose a bucking bar that is the proper weight for the rivet being driven and
hold it absolutely flat against the end of the rivet shank. Figure 2-59 on Page
I 0 I lists the correct weight of bucking bar for the rivet size.
Correctly-driven universal head rivet. Correctly-driven 100°-countersunk rivet. Open head. Set not held straight on head,
or hole drilled at angle. "D" rivet remove;
"AD" rivet drive more.
1
of-- - - 8-1 -. --~(
High head. Too long a shank, or not driven
Skin marked by rivet set. Set not centered Thin head. Rivet too short or hit too hard.
on head. Remove rivet and burnish skin. Remove rivet. enough. "D" rivet remove; "AD" rivet
drive more.
~-----LI:F
~···~-------~~ Cut formed head. Bucking bar did not cover
Rivet swelled between sheets. Parts not Rivet head clinched. Bucking bar held at
angle when rivet was driven. Remove rivet. entire end of rivet. Remove rivet.
properly held together, or chips between
sheets. Remove rivet, correct condition.
'--------fUr--------'
Formed head high on one side. Bucking Holes out of line. Red rill hole and
bar held at angle when riveting. Remove install larger rivet.
rivet if head too thin on one side.
Cracked head. Hard rivet or hit too long.
Remove rivet.
Drill the rivet hole and countersink the outside skin. Insert the rivet from
the inside. The shop head is formed in the countersunk depression. Use either
a squeeze riveter or a gun. After driving the rivet, mill off the excess portion
of the shop's head flush with the skin with an air-driven microshaver.
See Figure 2-93.
Team Riveting
-
Manufacturing and repairing an airplane often requires two people to drive
rivets. The operator of the rivet gun is usually on the outside and the rivet
bucker is on the inside. When the two cannot communicate directly, a code
of taps may be used.
When the bucker is in position and ready for the rivet to be driven, he or
she taps on the shank of the rivet one time. The riveter feels this tap through
the rivet gun and knows to drive the rivet. If the rivet is driven correctly the
Figure 2-93. An air-driven microshaver
81. The solid aluminum alloy rivet recommended for magnesium skin is made of alloy
_ _ _ __ _ __ _ _ .Page 115
82. The rivet to use for joining two sheets of metal should have a diameter at least _ _ _ _ _ _ __
times the thickness of the thickest sheet being joined. Page 115
83. The distance between the center of the rivet holes in a single row of rivets is called the rivet
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ .Page116
84. When a single row of MS 20470AD-4 rivets is laid out, the center of the holes should be no closer than
_______ inch and no farther apart than inches. Page I 16
85. When laying out a two-row riveted seam, the rivet pitch is '12 inch, and the transverse pitch, or gage, should
be inch. Page 116
86. When making a rivet seam using MS20470AD-3 rivets, make sure that the center of the rivet holes is no
closer to the edge of the sheet than inch. Page 116
87. A riveted joint should be designed so it will fail in _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (bearing or shear). Page 117
88. When a rivet pattern is laid out on a piece of aluminum alloy, the marks can be made easy to see if the
metal is first sprayed with a light coat of . Page 118
89. The correct size drill to use for a 'Is-inch rivet is a number _ _ _ _ _ . Page 119
90. Pilot holes for 1/s-inch rivets should be made with a number _ _____ drill. Page 119
91. The determination to countersink or dimple a skin in preparation for flush riveting is determined by the
_______ _ _ _ ofthe skin. Page 120
94. The inside radius of a rivet set should be slightly _ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ (larger or smaller) than
the radius of the head of the rivet. Page 122
95. The shank of a rivet should stick out of the sheet by _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ times the rivet shank
diameter. Page 122
96. A properly formed shop head on a ri vet should have a diameter of _ _ _ _ _ _ times the diameter
of the rivet shank. Page 124
97. A properly formed shop head on a rivet should have a thickness of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ of the rivet
shank diameter. Page 124
98. The shop head of a rivet driven by the NACA flush rivet procedure is shaved flu sh with the skin with a
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 125
99. When riveting by the team method when it is impossible to see the person holding the ri vet gun, the
bucker indicates a good rivet by tapping on the rivet time/times. Page 125
Classification of Damage
Damage can be classified into three categories: negligible, repairable, and
damage that requires replacement of the component.
Negligible damage is that which does not affect the airworthiness of the
aircraft. Typical examples of negligible damage are smooth dents in the
outside skin that are free of cracks and sharp corners, and that are not caused
by stress wrinkles.
Repairable damage normally consists of the damage that can be repaired
by the replacement of skins and repairs that are described in the structural
repair manual.
Damage that requires replacement of a component is damage that involves
extensive corrosion, or parts that are damaged beyond the limits specified in
the structural repair manual.
:r
0
o o o o o o
:::::fu::::
2.0
0 0 0 0
~- Edge distance
0.25 Typical
Figu re 2-94. Typical patch for a crack in a piece of stressed skin. This patch is designed to
carr}' 100% of the strength of the skin across the patch.
130 A VlAT ION MAINTENANCE T ECHNICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFR AME STRCCTURES
damage and o ut on the othe r side, but to make the patch symmetri cal, symmetrical. The same on either side of
place 2 more ri vets in the fifth row. the center line.
Symmetry is impo rtant, not just to make the patch look good, but to
avoid abrupt changes in the cross-sectional area and prevent stress risers
that coul d cause structural failure.
14. Draw lines through the end ri vets in each row and mark the location of a
ri vet at the intersection of these lines and the verti ca l center line. These
two rivets do no t c arry any stress across the patch, but they prevent the
edges of the patc h curling up.
15. Draw lines fo r the outside of the patch 0.25 inch from the cente r line of
all the outside ri vets. Cut the patch along the outside Iines, round a ll of the
corners, and deburr the edges of the patch.
16. Mark the cente r of each ri vet hole wi th a prick punch, and then make a
drill-startin g indentation at each mark with a cente r punch.
17. Drill all of the rivet holes with a #40 drill, and deburr the edges of
the holes.
18. Mark the locati o n of a rivet hole on the damaged skin 0 .25 inc h from the
edge of the c leaned-out damage along the horizontal center line. M ake a
center punc h mark at this locatio n and drill a #40 hole.
19. Put the patch over the damaged area and hold it in place with a s il ver-
colored C leco fastener. A lig n the cente r line on the patch with the center
line o n the sk in and drill a #40 hole throug h the patch along the center line
o n the opposite side of the damage. Secure thi s with a C leco faste ner.
20. W ith the patch in place, drill the rest of the ri vet holes. Figure 2-95. Slighrly crimp rhe edges of
rhe patch by using a small hardwood srick
21 . Re move the patch, deburr a ll the ho les, a nd slig htl y crimp the edges of wirh a saw cur across if at one end. There
the patch as shown in Figure 2-95. Spray the skin where the patch is to should be just enough cri111p to prevent the
be in stall ed, and the in side of the patch with a lig ht coat of z1nc edges of the shee1 rising up.
chro mate primer.
22. Ri vet the patch in place.
Flush Patch
Whe n you must patch an a ircraft skin in a location whe re a sm ooth surface is
needed, a flush patch s uch as the o ne in Fig ure 2-96 is installed. The damage
in thi s exampl e is in a piece of 0.025-inch 2024-T3 aluminum a ll oy skin, and
it is cleaned out to a 1. 5-inch-di amete r hole . The repair must be flush, so
MS20426AD ri vets w ill be used . See F igure 2-96 on the next page.
i
l j
Figure 2-96. Flush patch for stressed skin structure carrying 100% of the skin strength.
Prepare the patch material of the same alloy and thickness as the original skin,
and follow these steps :
1. Draw a horizontal and vertical center line across the damage, and clean
it out to a circular hole.
2. Determine the number of rivets needed. Use the chart in Figure 2-81 on
Page 1 18. For 0.025-inch skin and :Y32 -inch rivets, 8.6 rivets per inch are
needed on both sides of the cleaned-out damage. The cleaned-out area is
1.5 inches in diameter, which requires 12.9, or 13 rivets on each side.
3. Plan the layout of the rivets. A total of26 rivets is needed to carry 100%
of the skin strength, and the layout can use the same minimums used in
the previous repair:
Edge distance - 0.25 inch
Pitch- 0.375 inch
Gage - 0.281 inch
4. Prepare the patch material using the same alloy and thickness as the
damaged skin. Spray it with a mist coat of zinc chromate primer, and draw
a horizontal and a vertical center line and a 1.5-inch-diameter circle
representing the cleaned-out damage.
5. Lay out the first row of rivets. This row is laid out on a circle drawn one
edge distance, or 0.25 inch, from the edge of the hole. The diameter of this
circle is 2.0 inches and its circumference is n · D, or 3.14 · 2 = 6.28 inches.
1n order to have 13 rivets in each row, the spacing of the inner row is
6.28 + 13 = 0.48 inch. This is slightly more than 5D which is well within
the 3D to 12D range. Make a mark for the center of each rivet in this row.
6. Lay out the second row of rivets. The row is laid out on a circle that is 75 %
of the pitch from the first row. This circle has a diameter of 2.75 inches
and a circumference of3.14 · 2.75 = 8.64 inches. The 13 rivets in this row
••• ••
- - - .. r-!.h,<tl•. 1. 1 {,-··
•' •' •'
•'
•' •'
•'
J 1 l,l}!l' 1 J~·:;. "' ,....... .... •• • ••
...:·~···,. ~
0
•'
,n' ,•' ,.. •• .. ·- 1 . . _•_~ J) J...l
--------------------------------------------------------------~
Setting Up the Equipment
The gas welding equ ipment for most maintenance shops is mounted on a cart
and ready for operation as soon as it is wheeled into position. There are some
precautions and procedures that should be observed for maximum safety.
flame, control the torch oxygen valve until there is a definite white feather
around the inner cone, and the n increase the oxygen until the feather ju st
disappears. The e nd of the inner cone should be rounded, and the outer flame
Reducing flame
should be blue with a tinge of purple around its outer edges and at the point.
A reducing flame, sometimes called a carburizing name, is cooler and its
temperature is about 5,700°F. A reducing flame should be used only for very
special purposes, as the extra acetylene-causes carbon to be deposited in the Oxidizing flame
molten metal. A reducing name is identified by a very distinctive white
feather around the inner cone, and the o uter flame will be whiter than it is Fig ure 2-104. Oxyacetylene flames
around a neutral fl ame.
An ox idi zing flame is one in which there is more oxygen than in a neutral oxidizing fla me. An oxyacetylene flame in
which there is an excess of oxygen. The
flame. The inner cone is pointed rather than rounded, and the outer name is
inner cone is pointed and often a hissing
smaller than that around a neutral flame. A hissing sound is often heard when sound is heard.
the torch is adjusted to produce an ox idi zing flame. The temperature of an
oxidizing name is around 6,300°F.
Figure 2-107. Forehand welding is used Figure 2-108. Backhand welding is used
for thin-gage tubing and sheet. for heavy-gage sheet steel.
The preferred method for welding heavy-gage metal is the backhand method,
shown in Figure 2-108. Point the torch away from the direction the weld is
progressing. Add the rod to the puddle between the flame and the finished
back h a nd weld ing . We lding in wh ich the
weld. Backhand welding is not used on thin-gage metal because the greater to rch is pointed away from the d irection
amount of heat produced in the metal is likely to overheat and burn it. the weld is progressing.
Welding Positions
The ideal position for welding is the nat position, in which the material is flat
and the welding is all done from the top with the torch pointed down on the
work. But this is not always poss ible in the real world of airc raft repair. When
welding on tubular structure, some of the we ld is flat, some is horizontal,
some is vertical, and some is overhead.
When welding in the overhead position point the torch upward toward the
work and prevent the puddle from sagging by keeping it small and not
allowing a drop to form . Use the rod to control the puddle and keep the volume
of name to the minimum needed to ensure good fusion of the base metal and
the filler rod.
Horizontal welding is done by holding the torch in such a way that the
flame is inc lined upward at an ang le be tween 45° and 60°. Dip the rod in the
top of the puddle and do not allow the weld to get too hot.
Vertical welds are started at the bottom with the n ame inclined upward
between 45° and 60°. It is important that a vertical weld not be allowed to
become overheated. To prevent overheating, you may have to periodically
remove the flame from the weld for an instant and then return it to the puddle.
Add the rod at the top of the puddle in fro nt of the flame.
Figure 2- 111. Di.\lorrion can be minimi::.ed in a long butlll'eld !Jy skip u·ehling. Tack \l'eld Figure 2-1 10. Alloll'ance .for expansion in
rhe pieces roger her and rhen complete the u·elds as is shml'n by the ai'I'OI\'S.
a srraighr h1111 u·eld
• No oxides should form on the base me ta l more than '12 inch from the weld.
• The weld should s how no signs of blow holes, porosity, projecting g lobules. normalizing. A process o r strain-relieving
steel that has been welded and left in a
or unde rcutting of the base metal.
strained cond ition. T he steel is heated to a
• The base metal should show no signs of burns, pits, cracks, or distortion. speci fi ed temperature, usually red hot, and
allowed to coo l in still air to roo m
Never file welds to improve their appearance, and never fil I the m wi th solde r, temperature.
brazing mate ri al, orfillerofan y sort. Jfi t is necessary to reweld ajoint, re move
all the old weld before rewelding .
Brazing
Brazing is the process of joining metal parts by melting a brazing alloy on the
surface. These alloys generally have a bronze base and they melt at about
J,600°F. (Steel melts at around 2,600°F.)
Thoroughly clean the surface to be brazed and heat it, in the case of steel,
to a dull red. Heat the brazing rod and dip it in a flux made of borax and boric
acid. The flux adheres to the rod so none need be applied to the metal. Move
the torch with a neutral flame in a semicircular pattern over the seam to be
brazed and hold the brazing rod in the flame near the tip. When the rod melts
and flows over the base metal that is hotter than the melting point of the rod,
the bronze alloy flows into the joint by capillary attraction. Continue to add
rod until the joint is built up to the smooth seam you want. After the seam is
completed, allow it to cool slowly.
A brazed joint is not strong enough for most aircraft structural applica-
tions, and it can be used as a repair procedure only in applications in which
brazing was miginally approved. A brazed joint should never be repaired by
welding, as the brazing material gets into the structure of the metal and
prevents a proper weld.
Silver Soldering
Silver soldering is a form of brazing used for attaching the fittings to high-
pressure oxygen lines. Its chief characteristics are its ability to withstand
vibration and high temperature.
Clean and assemble the end of the tube and the inside of the fitting. The
fitting must fit tightly over the end of the tube as the solder is drawn into the
joint by capillary attraction. Prepare borax and boric acid paste flux and wipe
it on the tube to cover the area where the fitting is installed. Use a soft, neutral
fl ame to heat the fitting and tube until the flux turns liquid. Shortly after the
flux liquefies, touch the joint with the silver solder. It will melt and be drawn
into the fitting around the tubing. Only an extremely small film of solder is
needed to give the joint the integrity it needs.
Soft Soldering
Soft soldering is done with an alloy of tin and lead, and its melting temperature
is determined by the ratio of these two components. An alloy of 50% tin and
50% lead is common!y used for general soldering. Its melting point is 4 J4 oF.
Solder used for electronic components is usually 63% tin and 37% lead, and
it melts at 361 °F.
I09. T he most widely used fue l gas for aircraft gas weldi ng is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 138
1 I 0. [t (is or is not) permi ssible to use technical oxygen for charging a breathing
oxygen system in an aircraft. Page / 39
111. Acetylene gas is produced when _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ __ _ _ _ _ reacts with water. Page /39
112. The acetylene in a storage cylinder is absorbed in _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ which makes it safe to store
under pressure. Page 140
I 15. The temperature of the n ame used for gas welding is determined by the
_ _ _ _ __ _ _ _______ .Page /43
116. A twist drill _ __ _ __ _ _ _ __ (is or is not) the correct too l to use to clean the orifice in a
welding torch tip. Page 143
117. The valve on the oxygen cylinder should be opened _ _ __ _ _ __ _ _ _ (all the way or
part way). Page 144
11 8. The valve on the acetyle ne cylinder should be opened _ _ __ __ _ _ _ _ (all the way or
part way). Page 144
Continued
119. Welding hoses and connections should be checked for leaks with _ _ __ _ _ _ _ __ _ __
Page 145
120. The oxyacetylene flame that is the hottest is a/an _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ (reducing, neutral, or
oxidizing) flame. Page 145
121. A flame that has a rounded inner cone and no feather around it is a/an _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(reducing, neutral, or oxidizing) flame. Page 145
122. Thin steel tube and sheet is best welded by the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (backhand or forehand) method.
Page 147
123. A flame that has a definite feather around its inner cone is a/an _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(reducing, neutral, or oxidizing) flame. Page 145
124. Another name for a reducing flame is a /an _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ flame. Page 145
125. When making a vertical weld, the weld should be started at the _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(top or bottom). Page 147
126. When welding aluminum, flux should be applied to _ _ _ _ _ _ ______ (both sides or
top side only) of the metal. Page 151
127. After welding aluminum, all traces of the flux should be removed by scrubbing the area with a
bristle brush and . Page 151
128. The amount of heat put into the metal when gas welding aluminum is controlled by varying the
_ _ _ _ _ __ _ between the torch and the metal. Page 151
Power source
Water GTAW torch
In Out
~
\:..3
Shielding ·:.
F+--'gas
Shielding Gases
The gases used to shield the arc in GTA welding are either argon or helium.
An arc shielded with helium is hotter than one shielded with argon and it
produces a deeper penetration, but there is a greater tendency to splatter.
Because of argon's greater density, it produces a cleaner weld and is used
almost- exclusively for welding very thin material. Helium and argon are
stored in steel cylinders similar to those used for oxygen. Both helium and
argon cylinders are painted gray, but helium cylinders have an orange band
at the top and argon cylinders have a white band.
Power Unit
The power unit used for GTA welding can supply DC-straight polarity (the r ever se polarity welding. DC-elcctric arc
electrode is negative), DC-reverse polarity, (the electrode is positive), and welding in which the electrode is positive
with respect to the work.
A C. DC-straight polarity produces the most heat and deepest penetration, but
DC-reverse polarity has an advantage in welding aluminum and magnesium
that, as the e lectrons flow from the work into the electrode, they blast off the
surface oxides that have formed on the metal.
AC welding is similar to a combination of straight polarity and reverse straight polarity welding. DC-electric arc
polarity DC, but if the oxide coating Qn the surface of the metal is strong welding in which the ele<:trode is negative
enough, it acts as a rectifier and no current flows during the half cycle when with respect to the work.
the electrode is positive, and the welding is similar to DC-straight polarity.
Figure 2-116. This truck-mounted GTA welding equipment has a power supply that
provides AC and DC with high frequency AC for arc starting and stabilizing. This entire
equipment can be taken/a the aircraft for on-the-sp01 repairs.
Electrodes
The electrodes for GTA welding are made of tungsten wire and are available
in diameters from 0.010 inch to 0.250 inch and in lengths from 3 inches to 24
inches. Pure tungsten electrodes are used for most general welding of steel,
but its current-carrying ability is limited. Tungsten alloyed with thorium
emits electrons more readily than pure tungsten, it resists contamination
better, and makes the arc easier to start and more stable. But, thorium alloyed
rods are much more expensive than pure tungsten electrodes. Tungsten
water
133. The filler rod is dipped into the front or back of the puddle when using
GTA welding. Page /61
134. Too wide a bead indicates that the weld was made too (fast or slow).
Page 761
136. Two methods of welding very thin aluminum alloy and stainless steel sheets are
_ _ _ __ __ _ _ __ and . Page 162
The damage
I
Inside
sleeve
tube
Replacement tube
Inside
sleeve tube ~----- SA -----~
A ~--------~~~~4-~~~--~--~
'(
Original tube
t
*-~--~~~~--------~~~---J A
t
Original tube
138. Heat-treated landing gear components _ _ __ ___ (may or may not) be repaired by welding.
Page 163
139. The material used for a patch over a damaged longeron should be of the same material and the same wall
thickness as the . Page 164
140. When making an inner-sleeve repair, there should be a gap of inch between the
ends of the replacement tube and the original tubing to allow the outer tubing to be welded to the
inner sleeve. Page 165
141. The diameter of the holes for a rosette weld is _ _ _ _ __ __ of the diameter of the original
tubing. Page 165
Continued
Continued
Aircraft Wood
There are two basic classifications of wood, hardwood and softwood. These deciduous. A type of tree that sheds its
classifications are not based on the actual hardness of the wood, but on its fol iage at the end of the growi ng season.
Hardwoods come from deciduous trees.
cell structure.
Hardwoods come from deciduous, broadleaftrees whose leaves fall each
hardwood. W ood from a broadleaftrcc
year. The wood has visible pores and is usually (but not always) heavier and
that sheds its leaves each year.
denser than softwoods. Softwoods come from evergreen trees that have
needles and cones and are typified by their fiber-like cells.
softwood. W ood from a tree that bears
The properties of the various woods that are used in aircraft construc- cones and has needles rather than leaves.
tion are seen in Figure 3-1.
Northern white pine 85% to 96% of spruce Must use increased size to
compensate for lower strength.
Yellow poplar Slightly less than spruce Must use increased size to
compensate for lower strength.
Defects permitted:
Cross grain- Spiral grain, diagonal grain, or a combination of the two is acceptable providing the grain does not diverge from the longi-
tudinal more than 1 in 15. A check of all four faces of the board is necessary to determine the amount of divergence. The direction of
free-flowing ink will frequently assist in determining grain direction.
Wavy, curly and interlocked grain- Acceptable, if local irregularities do not exceed limitations specified for spiral and directional grain.
Knots- Sound hard knots up to 3fs inch in maximum diameter are acceptable providing: (1) They are not in the projecting portions of
!-beams, along the edges of rectangular or beveled unrouted beams, or along the edges of flanges of box beams (except in low-
stressed portions) (2) They do not cause grain divergence at the edges of the board or in the flanges of a beam of more than 1:15.
(3) They are not in the center third of the beam and are not closer than 20 inches to another knot or other defect (pertains to %-inch
knots-smaller knots may be proportionally closer). Knots greater than %inch must be used with caution.
Pin knot clusters- Small clusters are acceptable providing they produce only a small .effect on grain direction.
Pitch pockets- Acceptable, in center portion of a beam providing they are at least 14 inches apart when they lie in the same growth ring
and do not exceed 1% inch length by Vs inch width by Vs inch depth, and providing they are not along the projecting portions of
!-beams, along the edges of rectangular or beveled unrouted beams, or along the edges of the flanges of box beams.
Mineral streaks- Acceptable, providing careful inspection fails to reveal any decay.
Types of Glue
Today there are a number of high-strength glues on the market. Plastic resin
and resorcinol are generally FAA-approved for use on certificated airplanes.
Other glues, such as epoxies, also produce extremely strong glued joints, but
they should be specifically approved by the local FAA inspector before they
are used on certificated aircraft.
Nails to supply
pressure for
gluing Plywood gusset
Figure 3-6. A plywood gusset glued over the joims in a truss-type wing rib provides the
strength needed for an end-grain joint. The pressure needed for the gluing is provided by
aircraft nails.
c 6A
{ ~
~ v-- .----
...----
---- - .--- {
~
L 6A +------ 6A
10A
.... No fitting within these limits
"---~
~y
~cc=
'
~
' ( ----------
''' / (
,,
: --.. /
" '
,,
,, ~ :---- /
1
" ' ...,......._
" "
Figure 3-7. Acceptable method for :,p/icing a solid or laminated wood wing spar
Rib Repairs
The most common damage to a wing rib is a broken cap strip. This may be
repaired by removing the damaged area by cutting the cap strip with a 12:1
taper (I 0: I minimum). Cut the replacement material with the same taper and
glue the pieces together. When cutting the taper in both pieces of wood, be
sure that the cuts are parallel to the grain of the wood so there will be no end-
grain glue joints. See Figure 3-5 on Page 178.
Glue the pieces together and when the glue is completely dry, cut
reinforcing plates of aircraft-grade plywood as shown in Figure 3-8, and glue
them in place using aircraft nails to supply the pressure. The face grain of the
plywood must be parallel to the cap strip.
l
12F Recommended
10F Minimum ,' :•
'
'
,'.
'
• :' •
,'
2. Hardwoods _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (are or are not) always more dense than softwoods. Page 175
3. The standard for comparing all aircraft structural wood is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 175
4. A wood product made of strips of wood glued together in such a way that all of the grains run in the
same direction is called wood. Page 176
5. Wood propellers are made of laminations of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (what kind of wood). Page 176
6. The grains in the plies of a sheet of aircraft plywood cross each other at either _ _ _ _ __
or degrees. Page 176
7. Aircraft plywood with mahogany or birch faces often have cores made of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
or . Page 176
8. The light bands seen in the end of a piece of wood are called _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (springwood
or summerwood). Page 176
10. The maximum allowable grain divergence in aircraft spruce is 1: _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 177
Continued
11. A sound hard knot that is % inch in diameter in the web of a solid wood wing spar _ _ _ _ _ __
(is or is not) an acceptable defect. Page 177
12. A pitch pocket 1 inch long, lfs inch wide and %2 inch deep in the center of a solid wood wing spar
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (is or is not) an acceptable defect. Page 177
13. A wood wing spar blank containing some compression wood _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (is or is not)
acceptable for use. Page 177
14. Nails in a glued joint _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ (do or do not) increase the strength of the joint.
Page 178
16. There should be a time lapse of no more than _ __ _ __ _ hours between the final surfacing of the
wood and the application of the glue. Page 178
17. When preparing solid wood for a glued joint, the surface _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (should or should not)
be roughened to help the glue adhere. Page 178
18. Final smoothing of the wood surfaces to be joined _ __ _ _ _ _ __ __ (should or should not)
be done with fine sandpaper. Page 178
19. When using aircraft nails to apply pressure for gluing gussets to a wing rib, the maximum distance
between nails is inch. Page 179
20. A laminated wood spar (may or may not) be used to replace a solid wood spar
if they are both made of the same quality wood. Page 180
21. The majority of the flight loads applied to a wing spar are carried in the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(caps or web) of the spar. Page 180
22. Locations where bolts pass through a wooden spar are reinforced with plywood made of
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ .Page 180
23. Elongated bolt holes in a wing spar (should or should not) be repaired by
drilling the hole oversize and using the next larger size bolt. Page 180
25. The reinforcing plate over a splice in a wing spar _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (may or may not) be in a
location through which the wing strut bolts pass. Page 180
26. A small hole in the leading edge of a plywood wing that cleans out to less than one inch in diameter
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (can or cannot) be repaired with a fabric patch. Page 182
27. The choice repair for all types of plywood skin damage is a _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (splayed or scarf)
patch. Page 182
28. Aircraft wood with a moisture content of less than _ __ _ _ __ _ % is not susceptible to decay or
dry rot. Page 183
29. When a sharp knife point stuck into a piece of aircraft wood pries up a chunk of wood instead of a hard
splinter, the wood (is or is not) likely infected with decay. Page 183
Organic Fabrics
Cotton and linen are two popular natural, or organic, covering fabrics . Cotton
is still used, but linen is not readily available in the United States.
For many years, mercerized long-staple Grade-A cotton has been the
standard covering material for aircraft. This fabric weighs approximately
4.5 ounces per square yard, has between 80 and 84 threads per inch (tpi), and
a minimum strength of 80 pounds per inch in both the warp and fill direc-
Aircraft Re-Covering
Re-covering an aircraft is an expensive and time-consuming project. Do not
undertake it until it is definitely necessary. The structure to be re-covered
must be thoroughly inspected, and all measures must be taken to preserve
the structure, since it will not be visibie for another inspection for several
years.
Is Re-Covering Necessary?
The fabric on an aircraft is allowed to deteriorate until its strength is 70% of
that required for the original fabric. New Grade-A cotton fabric has a strength
of 80 pounds per inch, and it is allowed to deteriorate until its strength is 56
pounds per inch.
Fabric Testing
The technician is required on each I 00-hour or annual inspection to deter-
mine that the fabric meets at least its minimum strength requirements. Two
commonly used methods of determining the strength of the fabric are the
Maule test and the Seyboth test.
The Maule tester, Figure 3-9, is a precision spring-loaded instrument
with a blunt pin on its end and a scale calibrated in pounds per inch. Hold the
tester squarely against the fabric and press until the scale indicates the mini-
mum allowable strength of the fabric. If the tester penetrates the fabric, it
indicates that the fabric strength is below the minimum allowable. If both
the fabric and the finish are good, the tester will make a small depression
that will return to its original smooth surface with no permanent damage.
The Seyboth tester has a specially shaped, spring-loaded sharp point and
an indicator pin that is marked with green, yellow, and red-colored bands. To
use this tester, hold it straight against the fabric and press it down until the
Figure 3-9. The Maule .fabric tester point penetrates the fabric enough to allow the wide shoulder to rest on the
indicates the strength of the fabric in surface of the fabric. The amount of force required to penetrate the fabric is
pounds per inch withour making a hole
in the fabric.
indicated by the color of the band on the indicator pin that protrudes from the
body of the tester. If the fabric is very weak, only a small amount of force is
plast icizer. A constituent in dope or lacquer needed, and the red band will show. If the fabric is somew hat stronger, more
that gi ves its fi lm fl exibility and resilience. force is needed and the yellow band will be exposed. If the fabric is airworthy,
enough force will be needed to cause one of the green bands to show. When
r ej uvenate. Restore the resilience to an the test is completed, place a small circular patch over the hole left by the
aircraft fi nishing material. This is done by tester. See Figure 3-10.
the usc of a rcj uvenator. The indications given by these two testers are adequate to identify good
fabric, but since both of them test fabric that is covered by the dope film, they
do not indicate the actual strength of the undoped fabric. To determine the
actual strength of the fabric by itself, remove a strip of fabric about l l,l4 inch
wide and 6 inches long from the upper surface of the wing or fuselage. Take
it from an area that is finished with a dark color, because dark colors absorb
heat and in these locations the fabric is most likely to be weakened. Soak the
aircraft for re-covering. In this portion of our text, we follow the procedure ~
used for covering the popular Piper Super Cub, as this procedure is typical for
most fabric-covered aircraft.
First remove the wings and tail surfaces and carefully store them in the Figure 3-10. The Seyboth fabric tester
proper type of cradle so they will not be damaged while the aircraft is disas- indicates the relative strength of the fabric
sembled. with colored bands around the indicator
pin. This pin protrudes from the top of the
tester when it is pushed in until the wide
Remove the Old Fabric .face of the plunger rests on the fabric.
Carefully remove the fabric by cutting it along one of the fuselage longerons
or the trailing edges of the wings and tail surfaces. Cut all the lacing cord used
to hold the fabric to the structure. If the fabric is held to the wing with screws
or clips, cut the surface tape and remove them.
Roll up the old covering and keep it until the re-covering job is complete,
because you will probably need it to locate the positions for inspection rings
and the holes through which control cables must pass.
I)
t
/
~
Aileron well
""
i'\v~
~
to the rear spar at the next bay outboard. Trailing edge
Drag wires oppose the forces that try to
drag the wing backward.
Figure 3-11. Truss -type airplane wing
antidrag wire. A structural wire inside a
Pratt truss airplane wing between the
Inspect the leading and trailing edges for corrosion or cracks. The leading
spars. Antidrag wires run from the rear
spar inboard, to the front spar at the next edges of these wings are covered with thin aluminum alloy sheet back to the
bay outboard. Antidrag wi res oppose the front spar, and this metal is easily dented. Repair any dents or replace sec-
forces that try to pull the wing forward . tions of the metal that are dented beyond repair.
Check the control cables and pulleys. Replace any pulleys that are stuck
or that show wear from the cables. Check the electrical wiring and replace
any whose insulation is cracked. Secure the wire to the structure by the method
used by the manufacturer. Check the pitot-static plumbing to be sure there
are no leaks in the lines to be covered.
Check the wing truss for squareness. Use a wood or metal trammel bar
and a pair of trammel points. Place a mark in the center of the top of both the
front and rear spars aligned with the center of each of the compression struts.
Set the trammel points to measure distance A, Figure 3-12, then measure
distance B. If these distances are not exactly the same, adjust the drag and
antidrag wires unti l they are.
After all the adjustments are made, look down each of the spars to deter-
mine that they are perfectly straight. If they are not, repeat the trammel
process.
Cap strips
Figure 3-13. Wing ribs are braced with reinforcing tape wrapped around the middle of
the cap strips in this fashion .
Textiles
Purchase the fabric from a legitimate supplier of aircraft materials. Grade-A
fabric should be stamped TSO-Cl5 or AMS 3806 along the selvage edge.
This fabric is usually available either by the yard in widths of 50 or 64 inches,
or in pre-sewn envelopes tailored for specific aircraft.
Thread for sewing the fabric must meet VT-276 specifications, and the
fabric is attached to the aircraft structure with waxed linen rib-lacing cord
which meets MIL-T-6779 specifications.
Reinforcing tape is a narrow tape made of heavy cotton thread. It is
placed over all of the ribs and any part of the structure to which the fabric is
to be laced. It is normally available in widths from 1/ 4 to 1/ 2 inch, and wider
for special applications. Reinforcing tape is also used to support the wing
ribs before the fabric is installed, as shown in Figure 3-13 on Page 191.
Surface tape is made of Grade-A cotton and cut with pinked, or notched,
edges to prevent its raveling. This tape is doped over all of the ribs after the
rib lacing is completed, around the leading and trailing edges, and around the
tips of all of the surfaces.
The length of most surface tape is parallel to the warp threads, but there
bias-cut su rface tape. A fabric tape in is a bias-cut tape whose threads cross its length at a 45° angle. Bias-cut tape
which the threads run at an angle of 45° to is used around the tips of some wings and tail surfaces where straight-cut tape
the length of the tape. Bias-cut tape may
will not lie down smoothly.
be stretched around a compound curve
such as a wing tip bow without wrinkling.
Chemicals
Fabric-covered aircraft use a number of highly specialized chemicals such as
cements, dopes, thinners, solvents, retarders, and rejuvenators. It is extremely
important when buying these chemicals that they are all fresh and compatible.
The best way of assuring this is to use materials from the same manufacturer
and purchase them from a reputable supplier of aircraft materials.
There are many places where the fabric is glued to the structure rather than
sewn. The adhesive used to attach the fabric is similar to a heavy nitrate dope,
but it contains different plasticizers. It can be thinned to the proper brushing
consistency with nitrate thinner, but because of its different components, it
should not be mixed with dope.
Aircraft dope consists of a film base, solvents, plasticizers, and thinners.
The film base is made of cellulose fibers dissolved in an acid. It wets and
encloses, or encapsulates, the fibers ofthe fabric, and when it dries it shrinks
the fibers and pulls them tightly together. Solvents dissolve the film base
material, and plasticizers are mixed with the dissolved film base to control its
characteristics and give it resilience to prevent its cracking when it dries.
down into it, working out all of the air bubbles. After the cement is dry, trim
1/16"--f 1- "i 1- 1/16"
the fabric, and turn the wing over. Pull the fabric smooth but not tight, and c:;:::; 5)
brush a coat of thinned nitrate cement over the fabric that has just been ce-
mented down. Press the fabric down into the wet cement and work out all the Folded fell
air bubbles. Continue all around the trailing edge and the wingtip bow.
Figure 3-14. Machine-sewed seams used
When the cement is dry, trim the fabric with pinking shears to leave at to join aircraft colton fabric
least a one-inch overlap around the wing tip and the trailing edge. Cement
the overlap and close out the aileron well as described in the envelope method
section.
~"' 3
0
Cl
-~ 2 1 - - - - - - - t - -
"'c.
"'E
:::J
E 1
·;c
"'
:!E
100 150 200 250 300
Placard Never-Exceed Speed MPH Indicated
Mark each rib with a lead pencil where the rib stitches will be placed. The
spacing between the first and last stitches is one half of the spacing for all of
the other stitches. Notice that the stitch spacing inside the slipstream is much
closer than the spacing outside. For this purpose, the slipstream is considered
to be the diameter of the propeller plus an additional rib on each side.
Soak strips of reinforcing tape in nitrate dope and squeeze the dope reinfor cing ta pe. A narrow strip o f woven
through the tape with your fingers to completely saturate it, with no air in the fab ric materi al placed o ver the fabric as it
is being attached to the aircraft str ucture
fibers. Place the tape over each rib with about a half-inch extending beyond
with rib laci ng cord. This tape carries a
the first and last stitches. Pull the tape smooth and press it down over the rib large amount of the load and prevents the
with your fingers. fabric tearing at the stitches.
Use a rib-stitch needle and punch holes on each side of each rib at the
location marked for the stitches. Make the holes as close to the cap strips as
you can get them. Place the knots on the side of the wing where they will be
least visible. On a high-wing aircraft, place them on the top and on a low-wing
aircraft, place them on the bottom.
For the typical wing, begin with lengths of rib-stitch cord about four times
the length of the wing chord. Follow th_e procedure in Figure 3-16. Begin at
the holes nearest the trailing edge and, using a long rib-stitch needle, make a
double loop of the cord around the rib and tie a square knot in the center of
the reinforcing tape on the side of the wing opposite that on which the regular
stitches will be made.
Bring both ends of the cord back through the same holes and tie them with
another square knot, this one placed on the side of the reinforcing tape. Lock
this knot on both sides with half hitches around the loop, and cut off the excess
cord on the short end. See Figure 3-16 on the next page.
First step
Start of
first knot
S/2
\__
First ste p of
during pull no. 2 starting stitch
Figure 3-16. Starting stitch for single-loop Tie square knot on
Pull no. 1-10 lb. center of capstrip
to tighten stitch ~+--~~~~ rib stitching
Figure 3-18. Use this splice knot to join lengths of waxed rib lacing cord.
Martin clip
Thin plastic
Thin head or aluminum
Cessna clip sheet metal screw washer
Figure 3-19. Fabric clips used to secure fahric to the wing~· of some aircraft
t
Fabric
Using a clip to attach the fabric to a wing that originally used rib stitching
constitutes a major alteration to the airframe, and should be approved by the Metal rib
FAA before the work is started.
Another method of attaching the fabric to the wing ribs is by using very
short sheet metal screws and a plastic or thin aluminum washer like that in Figure 3-20. Attachment offahric to metal
Figure 3-20. Before drilling screw holes in a wing rib to which the fabric was Iring rib cap strips with sheet metal screws
originally stitched, have the alteration approved by the FAA. and a plastic or thin aluminum washer
surface tape. Strips of aircraft fab ric that Application of Surface Tape
are doped over all seams and places where After the fabric has been attached to the wings, brush on a coat of full-bod-
the fabric is stitched to the aircraft
ied butyrate dope.
structure. Surface tape is also doped over
the wi ng leading edges where abrasive
Allow this coat of dope to dry completely and then lightly dry-sand it
wear occurs. with 320-grit sandpaper. Sand it just enough to remove the rough nap of the
The edges of surface tape are pinked, or fabric raised by the dope. Be extremely careful when sanding. It is terribly
notched. to keep them from rave ling easy for the sharp sandpaper to cut completely through the doped fabric.
before the dope is applied. Before beginning to dry-sand any fabric-covered aircraft structure, ground
it electrically by connecting some metal part of the structure to a cold water
nap of the fabric. The ends of the fibers in pipe or to some metal part of the shop building. Rubbing the dry fabric with
a fabric. The first coat of dope on cotton or sandpaper will generate enough static electricity to, unless the structure is
linen fabric raises the nap, and the fiber
ends stick up. These ends must be carefully
adequately grounded, produce a spark that could cause the nitrate dope fumes
removed by sanding to get a smooth finish. to explode.
Cut lengths of 2-inch pinked-edge surface tape long enough to go from
the trailing edge around the leading edge, and then back to the trailing edge.
pinked-edge tape. Cloth tape whose edges Saturate this tape with dope, and brush a coat of full-bodied dope over the
have small V-shaped notches cut along rib. Place the tape in the dope, centered over the rib, and work it down into
their length. The pinked edges prevent the the dope with two fingers straddling the reinforcing tape. Press out all the air
tape from raveling. bubbles.
By this time the fabric has some stiffness, and will not move around any
more, so you can cut it around all of the fittings that are to protrude. Use a
very sharp knife to cut around the fittings, and then apply surface tape or a
pinked-edge patch to reinforce the fabric at these points.
Materials Used
Three weights of Poly-Fiber fabric are available, all three are lighter than
Poly-Fiber Acft. Grade-A cotton, and two of them are considerably stronger. All three of the
P-103 fabrics approved for use with this STC are identified with a stamp similar to
the one in Figure 3-21 stamped along one edge at three-foot intervals.
F.A.A. P.M.A. Both machine sewing and hand sewing require polyester thread, and
68 x 68 threads there are two types of polyester rib-lacing cord used with this system. One is
a round cord, and the other is a flat braided cord used where the minimum
2.7 oz./sq. yd. protrusion is desired.
Over 116 lbs./in. A woven twill-type polyester reinforcing tape with an adhesive coating
applied to one side is used over the wing ribs and is available in several widths.
Figure 3-21. Markings such as this
A tape made of the same material without the adhesive coating is available
are used to identify fabric used when for inter-rib bracing.
re-covering an aircraft by the Poly- Pinked-edge finishing tape is available in the various weights of fabric
Fiber system. and widths. Linear tape is used for most of the required taping, and bias tape,
with the threads oriented at 45° to the length, is available for use around
wingtip bows and other severe compound curves.
Tire fabric is attached to the structure with a high-strength cement called
Poly-Tak. When Poly-Tak is used with the recommended overlaps, there
are no wing loading or VNE restrictions.
The fabric is heat-shrunk on the structure, and Poly-Brush, which is a
high-solids-content one-part air-drying adhesive coating, is used to seal the
weave of the fabric.
ena mel. A type of fi nishing material that Almost the only natural enemy of polyester fabric is the sun. The fill coats
flows out to form a smooth surface.
of Poly-Spray are aluminum pigmented to prevent the ultraviolet rays from
Enamel is usually made of a pigment
suspended in some form of resin. When
reaching the fabric, and to provide a sanding base for a smooth finish.
the resin cures. it leaves a smooth, glossy For the finish coats, use Poly-Tone material. For a more chemical resistant
protective surface . finish, use Aero-Thane enamel, a flexible, two-part polyurethane enamel.
The Finish
After completing the fabric installation· and placing all of the tapes and hole
reinforcements, apply the second coat of Poly-Brush.
When the Poly-Brush coats are dry, spray on three coats of Poly-Spray,
wet-sanding after the second coat. When the third coat is applied , completely
cover all the surface to block the ultraviolet rays of the sun from the fabric.
Light from a 60-watt bulb held near the surface of the fabric should not
be visible from inside the structure.
Finish Poly-Fiber with either Poly-Tone or Aero-Thane.
Superflite System I
Superflite System I uses Superflite 102 fabric that is attached to the structure
with SuperBond cement. After the fabric is in place and all of the edges
cemented to the structure, shrink it by ironing it with an accurately calibrated
iron adjusted to 250°F. After shrinking the surface evenly at this temperature,
increase the temperature to 350°F and further shrink it. This temperature
should produce a fully tightened, wrinkle-free surface.
Once the fabric is uniformly tight, brush a full wet coat of reduced Dac-
Proofer over the entire surface. When the first coat is dry, use a brush or a
short-nap, bonnet-type paint roller to apply the second coat. This one is
applied at right angles to the first coat. This second coat should be thinned with
dope roping. Brushing aircraft dope onto enough retarding thinner to allow it to dry slowly and not rope.
a surface in such a way that it forms a The Dac-Proofer acts as a foundation for the fill and topcoats. It pen-
stringy, uneven surface rather than flowing etrates the fabric and encapsulates the fibers, bonding to itself on the back side
out smoothly.
of the fabric. Since it is not used as a filler, use only enough to give the fabric
an even blue appearance.
Attach the dried, Dac-Proofer coated fabric to the structure with screws,
clips, or rib lacing, as it was originally attached by the manufacturer. You can
follow the procedure for rib lacing described earlier in the organic fabrics
section, but the applications manual also describes a hidden-knot method of
lacing you can use with this system.
Apply the surface tapes, using either nitrate or butyrate dope. Use a roller
and apply a swath of full-bodied dope slightly wider than the tape where the
tape is to go. Lay the tape into the dope and smooth it in place with your
fingers. Then roll on a second coat of dope, applying enough pressure to
squeeze out all of the air bubbles. Extra passes of the roller will pick up the
dope that has been squeezed out and will result in a smooth surface.
Superflite System 11
Superflite System 11 uses the same fabric and the same installation procedure
as System 1, but it uses special chemicals to allow a polyurethane enamel to
be used for its famous wet look.
Attach the fabric to the structure using SuperFiite U-500 urethane adhe-
sive. Use a mixture of primer base, catalyst, flexative, and reducer as both
the primer and fill coats. Spray three coats of the mixture on the entire sur-
face, waiting only until the surface is dry to touch between coats.
The final finish is provided by two coats of Superthane pigmented
polyurethane, to which has been added the catalyst, a flexative, and the
required reducer. Spray this on in a light tack coat and allow it to set for a few
minutes, and then follow it with a full wet coat.
Materials Used
The Ceconite 7600 system uses a 3.8-, 2.8-, or 1.9-ounce-per-square-yard
polyester fabric that has been precoated under controlled temperature and
pressure with a thermoset water-borne epoxy-ester resin. This precoating
makes the fabric easy to work with and ensures the proper bonding of its
chemicals.
The Finish
The 7601 Filler Coat used with this system contains many solids to provide
a surface that blocks the ultraviolet rays of the sun and also fills the weave of
the fabric. This material must be mixed thoroughly to completely suspend all
the solids, and then strained to remove any clumps of pigment.
Clean the fabric area to remove all dust, then wipe it down with a cloth
dampened in Flexi-Gioss Cleaner to remove all fingerprints and all traces of
oil that may have gotten onto the fabric. Dampen the fabric thoroughly with
distilled or demineralized water applied with a sponge, and while the fabric
is still wet, apply the filler with a foam brush, paying special attention to get
even coverage.
Apply subsequent coats of the filler with a spray gun. Use the material
unthinned and with only enough air pressure on the gun to get thin, even coats.
After enough filler has been sprayed on the surface to fill the weave, wet- or
dry-sand the surface with 320 or400 sandpaper, taking care not to cut through
the fabric.
With the Ceconite 7600 system, use finish coats either of catalyzed
polyurethanes or several coats of pigmented butyrate dope (applied by the
methods described in the section on aircraft painting and finishing).
30. Grade-A cotton fabric is manufactured under Technical Standard Order TSO C-_ __ __ _ __ _
Page 186
31. New Grade-A cotton fabric has a minimum strength of _ _ _ _ __ __ pounds per inch in both warp
and fill directions. Page 185
32. Three types of fabric that may be used to cover an aircraft structure are: _ _ __ _ _ _ __ __
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ , and . Pages 185 and 186
33. Re-covering an aircraft with the same materials and the same methods used by the original manufacturer
is classified as a . Page 186
34. Re-covering an aircraft with different materials from those used by the original manufacturer is classified
as a . Page 187
35. When an aircraft is re-covered, the work must be inspected by an aviation maintenance technician who
holds an Inspection Authorization, and an FAA Form must be completed and filed
with the FAA FSDO. Page 187
Continued
36. Aircraft fabric must be replaced when its strength has deteriorated to _ _ _ _ _ _ _ % of the strength
of the fabric required for the aircraft. Page 187
37. A fabric whose strength has deteriorated to 65% of that required for new fabric _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(can or cannot) have some of its strength restored by rejuvenation. Page 188
38. Cracks in the finish of a fabric-covered structure _ _ _ __ _ __ _ _ _ _ (are or are not) an indica-
tion that the fabric should be replaced. Page 188
39. When making a fabric test, check the fabric in an area that is finished with a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _
(dark or light) color. Page 188
40. The squareness of a wing truss is checked by making comparative diagonal distance checks across each
bay with a bar and points. Page 190
42. Pinked-edge surface tape has a series of V-shaped notches cut along its edges to prevent it
______________________ .Page192
43. Surface tape that lies down most smoothly around wing tips and the tips of control surfaces is
__________________ (bias or straight) cut. Page 192
44. The two types of dopes are ___________________ and ___________________ . Page 193
45. The type of dope that is best for the initial attachment of the fabric to the structure is
_ __________________ (butyrate or nitrate). Page 193
46. It __________________ (i s or is not) proper to apply nitrate dope over butyrate dope. Page 193
47 . Aircraft dope and fabric are protected from damage by ultraviolet rays of the sun by a layer of
_________________ -pigmented dope applied over the clear dope. Page 193
48. When mixing aluminum paste with clear dope you should pour the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(dope into the paste or paste into the dope). Page 193
49. If a bleeding dope is to be used for one of the colors on an aircraft, it should be applied
_______________ (first or last). Page 193
50. The two methods of applying fabric to an aircraft structure are the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
and methods. Pages 194 and 195
52. When mixing fungicidal paste with clear dope you should pour the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(dope into the paste or paste into the dope). Page 196
53. Wrinkles arc pulled out of cotton fabric by wetting the fabric with (dope or
water). Page 195
54. The first coat of dope applied to cotton fabric is typically (nitrate or
butyrate). Page 196
55. The first coat of dope applied to cotton fabric should be (full bodied or
thinned). Page 196
56. The rib stitch spacing for the end stitches is that of the rest of the stitches. Page 197
57. Replacing rib stitching with metal clips constitutes a major (repair or
alteration). Page 199
58. The second coat of dope that is applied to cotton fabric should be _ _ __ __ __ _ __ _
(nitrate or butyrate). Page 200
59. Before dry-sanding any doped surface, the aircraft structure should be _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
to prevent a spark caused by static electricity. Page 200
60. Surface tape, drain grommets, and inspection rings are applied with the _ _ _ __ _ _ _ (first or
second) coat of dope. Page 200
61. The description of a repair in AC 43.13-1 B (does or does not) constitute approved
data for making a major repair to a fabric-covered aircraft. Page 208
62. When sewing an L-shaped tear in. aircraft fabric covering, start sewing at the _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(ends or apex) of the tear. Page 208
63. A doped-on patch repair may be made to a fabric-covered aircraft provided the VNE is not greater than
_ _ __ _ _ _ __ mph and the damage does not exceed inches in any direction.
Page 209
64. When baseball stitching a patch into an aircraft structure, the stitches should be spaced approximately
_ _ __ __ -inch apart and locked with a half hitch ever or stitches. Page 208
Metal Finishing
An aircraft's finis h is important for more than just cosmetic reasons. It
preserves the metal, and its smoothness reduces air resistance, making the
aircraft fly more efficiently.
T he many hours transport aircraft fly today have brought about some
serious problems, known as problems ofthe "aging fleet. " T hese aircraft often
have hidden corr-osion that must be found and properly treated, then the
aircraft refinished.
In this section of the AMTS we consider the preparation of the structure
for receiving the fini sh and review the finishing systems.
Paint Removal
Begin preparing the metal to receive the finish by removing any old finish.
For years the only way to remove old finish was to use chemical stripper
that loosened it and allowed it to be washed away. But today with the em-
phasis on environmental protection, the residue from chemical stripping
is considered hazardous waste, and the cost of its disposal has made dry-
stripping a viable alternative.
Before beginning any paint removal, prepare the aircraft by very care-
fully masking off all areas that should not be stripped. Protect windshields and
windows with aluminum foil taped down tightly so no stripper can get under
it, and cover all of the other parts with a good grade of polyethylene sheeting.
It is very important that any time you work with potent chemicals you
have adequate physical protection. Follow the recommendations of the
manufacturer of the chemicals for the type of respiratory and eye protection
you will need.
Chemical Stripping
There are two basic types of finish on metal aircraft, enamels and lacquers,
and each requires different procedures for its remo val.
Enamel cures to a hard, impervious finish that bonds tightly to the primer
on the s urface of the metal. To remove it, apply a heavy coat of stripper with
a bristle brush or a nonatomiz ing spray, and cover it with polyethylene
sheeting to prevent it evaporating before it does its work. The potent solvents,
principally methylene chloride, in the stripper enter the enamel film and swell
it enough that it buckles, or wrinkles up, and pulls away from the primer.
Dry Stripping
Aircraft refinishing shops that work on large aircraft have an expensive
problem of disposing of the hazardous waste products left when paint is
chemically stripped. These shops have done quite a bit of research into dry
plastic media blasting (PMB). A method
stripping or plastic media blasting (PMB), and this has proven to be an
of removing paint from an aircraft surface
effective method of removing paint from heavy-skinned aircraft, especially by dry-blasting it with ti ny plastic beads.
Corrosion Detection
Review the section on Cleaning and Corrosion Control in the General text-
book of the Aviation Maintenance Technician Series to get a good under-
standing of the appearance and causes of corrosion. Any traces of corrosion
you find must be removed and the surface treated to prevent the formation of
subsequent corrosion.
The form of corrosion that is most likely to be found under a paint film
is filiform corrosion. This is a thread-like corrosion primarily caused by
improperly cured wash primer that left some of the phosphoric acid trapped
beneath the paint film. Tf there are any tracks left from the corrosion or gray
powdery residue on the surface of the metal , scrub it all away with a nylon
scrubber such as a Scotch-Brite pad.
Carefully examine the area around all fasteners for any indication of
galvanic corrosion. Any blisters in the metal that could indicate intergranular
corrosion should be probed with a sharp tool to determine whether or not they
are actually pockets of corrosion deposits. If you find traces of intergranular
corrosion, use an eddy cunent or ultrasonic tester to determine its extent.
Intergranular corrosion is usually difficult to remove and often requires the
replacement of the affected metal.
Conversion Coating
Three conditions must be met for a metal to corrode: there must be an elec-
trode potential difference, there must be a conductive path between the areas
of potential difference, and an electrolyte must cover these areas. A surface
may be protected from corrosion by the elimination of any one or more of
the three.
Primers
A primer provides a good bond between the surface being finished and the primer. A component in a fi nishing
material used for the topcoats. There are several types of primers avai !able, but system that provides a good bond between
the three discussed here are zinc chromate, wash primer, and epoxy primer. the surface and the material used for the
topcoats.
Zinc Chromate
epoxy. A polyether resin that has wide
For decades zinc chromate has been the standard primer for use on aircraft.
appl ication. as a matrix for composite
It is an inhibitive primer, meaning that its base of alkyd resin is somewhat materials. and as an adhesive that bonds
porous and when water enters it, some of the chromate ions are released and many di fferent types of materials.
held on the surface of the metal. This ionized surface prevents the electro! ytic
action necessary for corrosion to form.
Zinc chromate can be used on both ferrous and nonferrous metals and is
compatible with most finishing materials, but there are some necessary
precautions. It should not be applied over a wash primer unless the phosphoric
acid has been completely converted into the phosphate film. The zinc
chromate will tend to trap water and allow filiform corrosion to form. Also
zinc chromate is not recommended for use under acrylic lacquers because the
solvents used with acrylics tend to lift the zinc chromate.
Zinc chromate primer conforms to MIL-P-8585A and is available in both
yellow and dark green colors. It is thinned with toluene or proprietary thinners
to get it to the proper consistency for spraying. To increase the usefulness of
this primer, it is also available in aerosol spray cans.
Wash Primer
High-volume production of aircraft requires a primer that cures quickly and
allows the topcoat to be sprayed on relatively soon after its application. A
three-part wash primer that meets specification MIL-P-15328 satisfies this
requirement and is widely used in aircraft factories.
Wash primer is prepared by mixing 4 parts of the primer with 1 part of its
activator, an acid diluent, and adjusting its viscosity with between 4 and 8
parts of thinner. Allow it to stand for 20 minutes to begin its cure, stir it, and
spray it on the surface. It should be sprayed on in a very thin coat, only about
0.000 3 inch (0.3 mil). A coat of this thickness does not hide the surface of the
metal , but gives it a slightly greenish-amber tint.
The acid in the primer requires about 30 minutes to convert into the
phosphate film, and you must not apply the topcoats until this has taken place.
But you must apply them within 8 hours or the primer will harden to the extent
that the topcoats will not adhere as they should. If the topcoat is not applied
within this time limit, spray on another coat of the primer, this time without
the activator. When the primer is dry to the touch it is ready for the topcoats.
It is important that there is enough moisture in the air to convert the acid
in the primer into the phosphate film. Specific information is given with the
primer, but, basically, if the relative humidity is less than 55% with a paint
room temperature of 75°F, you should add about an ounce of distilled water
to one gallon of the thinner to provide the needed water.
Epoxy Primer
Epoxy primer gives the best conosion protection of any of the modern primers.
This two-component primer produces a tough dope-proof finish, and it can be
used over all metals as well as composite materials. When you need maximum
corrosion protection, you can apply epoxy primer over wash primer.
To use epoxy primer, first wash the surface with a clean rag wet with
MEK. Methyl-ethyl-ketone. an organic MEK, toluol, or acrylic lacquer thinner. Then mix the epoxy primer with the
chemical solvent that is soluble in water amount of mixing liquid specified by the primer manufacturer. Stir these
and is used as a solvent for vinyl and components separately and then stir them together. Add the required amount
nitrocellulose films. MEK is an efficient
of thinner to adjust the viscosity for spraying and allow the mixture to sit for
cleaner for preparing surfaces for priming
or painting. 30 minutes to begin its cure. Spray on a single, light, even coat of primer, just
enough to slightly color the metal.
Epoxy primer must be allowed at least five hours , and preferably
overnight, to develop enough hardness to prevent acrylic lacquer or synthetic
enamel topcoats from sinking into it and losing their gloss. Polyurethanes are
ideally suited for application over epoxy primer and can be applied after a wait
of only one hour.
Finishing Systems
Three popular finishing syste ms are used for all-metal aircraft. Most of the
high- volume general aviation aircraft were finished at the factory with acrylic
lacquer because of the speed with which the entire finishing system could be
app I ied. Synthetic enamels have been used for many years because of the good
fini sh they produce and their ease of application. But the most popular
finishing system today is the polyurethane system because of its chemical
resistance, durability, and its famous wet look.
Acrylic Lacquer
Apply acrylic lacquers over a wash primer or over an epoxy primer. After the lacquer. A fini shing material made of a
primer has completely cured, rub it down with a handful of wadded-up kraft fil m base. solvents, plasti ei;ers, and
paper to provide enough surface roughness so the topcoats will bond properly. thi nners . The film base forms a tough fil m
over the surface when it dries. The
The low solids content of acrylic lacquer requi res careful attention to its solvents d issolve the fi lm base so it can be
application. The fin ished color is best applied over a whi te base coat, and it applied as a liquid. T he plasticizers give
should be applied in several thin coats rather than fewer heavy coats. Thin 4 the fi lm base the needed resilience. and the
parts oflacquer with 5 parts of thinner, and spray on a very light tack coat. As thinners dilute the lacquer so it can be
applied with a spray gun . Lacquer is
soon as the solve nts have evaporated, spray on at least three cross coats,
sprayed on the surface as a Iiqu id and
allowing about a half-hour between the coats . The gloss ofthe final coat may when the solvents and thinners evaporate.
be improved by adding about one-fourth as much retarder as there is thinner. the fi lm base remai ns as a tough decorative
When retarder is used, the finish should dry overnight before doing any taping and protective coating.
or masking.
kraft paper. A toug h brown wrapping
Synthetic Enamel paper like that used for paper bags.
Synthetic enamels arc made of pigments suspended in res ins that cure by
oxidization. These enamels have been used for years to finish automobiles and
have been used to some extent for metal aircraft. They produce a glossy fin ish
that does not require rubbing but their chemical and abrasive resistance is not
nearly so good as that of polyurethanes.
Synthetic enamel can be applied over a zinc chromate primer and is
thinned to the proper viscosity for spraying. Spray a light mi st coat on the
surface and as soon as the thinner evaporates out, in about 10 or 15 minutes,
spray on a wet cross coat. After drying for about 48 hours the surface will be
ready to tape and mask for trim coats.
Finishing Problems
The function of a finishing system on an aircraft is to provide a surface that
is both protective and decorative, and anything that prevents either of these
qualities can be considered to be a finishing problem. The problems consid-
ered here are common with cellulose dope finishes.
Blushing
Blushing is the most common problem with dope finishes. When the humidity
is high, the drop in temperature that occurs when the solvents in the dope
evaporate cause water to condense from the air. When this water mixes with
the wet dope film, it causes the cellulose to precipitate out. This gives the film
a chalky appearance which is neither strong nor attractive.
Prevent blushing by heating the air in the spray booth. Warm air can hold
more water in its vapor state, and the temperature drop caused by the thinners
evaporating wi ll not cause water to condense out.
If the humidity is not too high, some retarder can be mixed with the retarder . Dope thinner that has certain
dope in place of some of the thinner. The slower evaporation of the solvents add itives that slow its rate of evaporati on
to prevent the dope blush ing.
in the retarder does not drop the temperature enough for water to condense
from the air.
If the dope you have just sprayed blushes, spray over it a very light mist
coat consisting of a mixture of one part retarder and two parts thinner. Allow
it to dry and then spray on another coat. The blushed surface should melt down
and re-form as a smooth glossy surface. Tfthis does not remove the blush, sand
the surface to remove the blushed area and reapply the finish when the
humidity is lower.
Pinholes
Aircraft dope is composed of solids and solvents. The sol ids remain on the
surface of the fabric and the solvents evaporate. If the dope film is exposed
to too much heat or to a draft of air, the surface will h <u·den enough to prevent
the vapors escaping as the solvents evaporate. Tiny bubbles of vapors will
unite beneath thi s hardened surface until they form a large bubble with enough
pressure to force its way through the surface . R ather than the surface re-
fo rming smoothly, pits or pinholes will remain where each bubble burst.
Excessive atomi zing air on the spray gu n will force enough air into the
dope film that will also cause pinholes to form .
Fisheyes
Fisheyes are localized spots in the finish that do not dry. They are typically
caused by surface contaminations such as wax, oil, or some of the silicone
products. These contaminants mix with the dope and prevent its drying.
Fisheyes can be prevented by keeping the surface clean and free of the
contaminants. Before spraying the dope on the surface, scrub it with a rag
damp with toluol or MEK.
Dope Roping
Dope roping is the rough trail of dope that is left behind the brush when the
dope is too heavy for properly application. This means you are not using
enough thinner, or that the dope is too cold for proper brushing.
Finishing Equipment
In this sectio n, we consider the basic equipment necessary for setting up
a paint shop in a facility that could do an occasional paint job. Fixed base
operators that specialize in aircraft finishing have special buildings used
solely for aircraft painting. These buildings have provisions for fi ltering the
air and removing all paint fumes. Stringent OSHA (Occupational Safety and
Health Act) requirements must be met in regard to paint storage, electrical
outlets, personal protection, and fire safety, as well as the collection and
disposition of the materials removed from the aircraft when the finish
is stripped.
Spray Area
When aircraft fini shing is occasional, the area in which it is done may be
isolated from the rest of the shop in a temporary spray booth. Build it with a
framework that can be covered with polyethylene sheeting to contain the
fumes and paint overspray. An exhaust fan located near the floor should be
able to move enough air that there is never more than just a slight odor of the
finishing mate rial. There should be no e lectrical extension cords or unpro-
tected electrical outlets in the spray booth that could cause an electrical spark,
and there should be adequate fire extingu ishers inside the spray booth.
An ample supply of running water should be available to flu sh your eyes
if you should get any finishing material in them. There should also be
provisions for f lushing the floor with water when sweeping up dried over-
spray from dope and lacquer. This overspray is highly flammable when it is
dry, but can safely be swept when it has bee n wet with water.
Fluid
adjustment
,:~~'t
valve
Fluid tip
Air valve
Figure 3-24. An air-atomi::.ing spray gun can be used as either a suction cup gun or a
pressure pot gun by changing the fluid tip.
This spray gun has three valves to give the operator control of the material
that is being app lied.
When the trigger is first pulled, it opens the air valve which sends atom-
izing air into the wing-port holes. Continued pulling of the trigger opens the
fluid valve and allows the material to spray from the gun.
The wing-port air valve is adjusted by the upper knob, and it determines
the shape of the spray pattern. When the valve is screwed in, very little air Suction-feed gun
flows through the wing-port holes and the pattern is circular. Opening the
valve flattens the spray pattern. The wide part of the spray pattern is always
perpendicular to the wing ports.
I~
The fluid adjustment valve, the lower knob, controls the amount of fluid
that is allowed to flow from the gun. Screwing the knob out increases the
amount of fl uid that can be discharged.
The spray gun in Figure 3-24 can be used as either a suction cup gun or
a pressure pot gun by changing the flui d tip. When it is used as a suction cup
Pressure-feed gun
gun with a one-quart cup attached, the J?roper fluid tip extends beyond the air
cap. When a pressure pot is connected to the gu n, a fluid tip is used that is Figure 3-25. The fluid tip determines
flu sh with the air cap. See Figure 3-25. whether the spray gun is set up for a
suction cup or a pressu re pot.
A tip that protrudes from the air cap
produces enough suction to draw material
from a cup allaclzed to the gun.
A tip that i~)Tush with the air cap is
used when the material is forced by air
pressure from the pressure pot to the gun.
Fire Safety
All large aircraft paint shops are equipped with sprinkler systems that will
deluge the entire shop with water if a fire should develop. Small shops should
be protected by a sufficient number of carbon dioxide fire extinguishers of
Cartridge-type mask adequate size strategically located within the shop.
All solvents in the paint shop should be stored in safety cans of a type that
is approved by the insurance company that carries the policy for the shop.
Rags that have been used for the application of conversion coating
materials should be kept wet until they can be thoroughly washed out, and
then they should be kept in closed containers until they are disposed of.
Dried dope and lacquer overspray should never be dry-swept from the
paint shop. Flood the floor with water and sweep the overspray while it is wet.
Respiratory Safety
The exhaust fan should remove most of the vapors from the paint booth, but
there are usually enough contaminants left in the air that they could cause
respiratory problems.
Two types of protective devices that can be used when painting aircraft
are: cartridge-type masks, and hoods that cover the entire head. Some car-
tridge masks filter out only solid particles, while others remove certain fumes.
The hoods are slightly pressurized with compressed air, and they prevent
any fumes reaching the wearer.
Hood-type respirator AI ways wear the type of mask that is recommended by the manufacturer
of the finishing material, and on cartridge-type masks, change the cartridges
Figure 3-26. Respiratory protection
devices for paint spray safety
at the recommended intervals.
Toxicity Safety
Some finishing materials are toxic and irritating to certain people. When
using any toxic material, protect yourself with gloves, long polyethylene
sleeves, and a face mask. If any toxic material gets on your skin, flush it off
immediately. If any gets in your eyes, flush it out with plenty of fresh water
and get medical aid without delay.
Figure 3-28. A suction cup gun is used for Figure 3-29. Measure the correct air pressure for 5praying at the gun, not at the trans-
applying the trim and for small paint jobs. former. The difference in the two pressures arises from the pres.ntre loss in the hose.
Sequence of Painting
When the spray gun is properly adjusted, you may begin to apply the material.
Before spraying the flat portions of the aircraft, spray the edges and corners.
By spraying along the corner, the thickest film will be along the edges, and
it will blend out in the flat portion.
Each time you make a pass with a spray gun, you deposit a single layer
of finishing material about I0 to 12 inches wide. This coat is slightly thicker
in the center and tapers off at the edges. To get an even buildup of finish, spray
the first pass across the surface, then come back and spray the second pass,
overlapping all but about two or three inches of the finish left by the first pass.
Continue overlapping most of the previous stroke with each new stroke until
you have an even film of the correct thickness with no runs or sags .
When painting a complete aircraft, first paint the ends and leading edges
of the ailerons and flaps, then the flap and aileron wells. Then paint the wing
tips and the wing leading and trailing edges. Paint all the landing gear and
wheel wells and all of the control horns and hinges. After all of these difficult
Figure 3-31. When painting the comers areas have been sprayed, spray the flat surfaces.
of a sutface, spray parallel to the corner
Spray the tack coats crosswise on the fuselage and spanwise along the
first and then blend this in with the rest of
the suiface by spraying perpendicular to wing and tail surfaces. Spray the primer and finish coats lengthwise on the
the corner. fuselage and chordwise on the wing and tail surfaces.
228 AVI ATION MAINTENA;\Cl': T ECHN ICI A:\ SERI ES Volume 1: AIRFR AME STRUCTURES
Distorted Spray Pattern
The coiTect and incorrect spray patterns are illustrated in Figure 3-32. A
coiTect spray pattern is an ellipse, and a pattern that is more round than
elliptical indicates an insufficient amount of atomizing air pressure. Exces-
sive atomizing air pressure will cause the pattern to be dumbbell shaped. A
pattern that is somewhat pear shaped is caused by a material buildup around
one side of the fluid nozzle, cutting off the atomizing air to one side of the
pattern. A banana-shaped pattern indicates that one of the wing-port holes is
plugged and the pattern is being blown to one s ide by air through the opposite
wing-port hole.
Correct spray Insufficient atomizing
Spray Gun Spitting pattern air pressure
Suction cup spray guns spit when air gets into the fluid as it is being sprayed.
This can indicate too little material in the cup, or air leaking into the fluid line
between the cup and the fluid nozzle.
111111111 1
•••••• ••••
••••••
1 111111111
D =one inch
Figure 3-33. Letters and numerals used for aircraft registration numbers
Ready-made masks, or stencils, are available that have the characters die-cut
into an adhesive paper. You may apply the body color and stick the stencil in
place. Remove the letter portion of the mask and spray on the color for the
numbers. Or, you may spray on the color for the numbers and stick the stencil
in place and remove all but the letter portion, then spray on the body color.
There is a typical universal template that will allow you to lay out the
registration numbers. This template is shown in Figure 3-34, and it may be
made from thin aluminum sheet.
with a soft lead pencil. Do not use a ball -point pen, as the ink will bleed up I lL I" '
through the finish. !
l
Mask the characters with thin tape pressed down firmly and smoothly 1/ t
along the edges. Do not cut the tape as there is a danger of cutting the fabric;
rather tear it back against the edge of a knife blade or piece of thin aluminum ""''"' ""' 1/
l
t !/
sheet held flat against the surface. Fill in all parts of the characters that you
do not want to paint, and mask beyond the top and bottom of the numbers with
D =one inch
-
Width
2/3height
~ Stroke
1/6 height - ~
8 inches 2inches
Height
12inches
0
Figure 3-35. Layout of registration numbers
65. Paint strippers remove _ _ _ __ _ _ __ (enamel or lacquer) by swelling the film and causing it
to pull away from the primer. Page 212
66. Paint strippers remove acrylic lacquer by _ __ _ _ __ _ _ (softening or swelling) the film.
Page213
67. The wax left on a surface after paint stripper has been used _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (can or cannot)
be removed with lacquer thinner. Page 213
68. The finish may be dry-stripped from an aircraft surface by blasting it with _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
Page 214
69. Corrosion that occurs in the form of thread-like deposits under a paint film is called
_ _ __ _ _ _ _ corrosion. Page 214
70. If intergranular corrosion is suspected, the area should be inspected with alan
_ _ __ _ __ ____ or instrument. Page 274
71. Acrylic lacquers should be applied in _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (one heavy coat or several light
coats). Page 217
72. Synthetic enamels _ _ _ _ _ __ _ __ (may or may not) be applied over zinc chromate primer.
Page 217
73. Synthetic enamel should dry for at least _ __ __ _ _ __ hours before it is taped for the trim
coats. Page 217
74. Polyurethane enamels should be applied over a/an _ _ _ _ _ __ ___ primer. Page 218
75. It is best if polyurethane enamel is allowed to dry for _ _ _ _ ______ hours before it is taped
for the trim coats. Page 218
76. The fill coats of dope _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (should or should not) completely fill the weave of
cotton fabric. Page 219
77. The aluminum-pigmented dope _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ (is or is not) used primarily to provide a smooth
surface for the finish coats of dope. Page 220
78. For the richest colors in a doped finish, all of the surfaces should be undercoated with
_ __ _ _ _ _ _ dope.Page220
80. A draft of air across the surface of freshly applied dope will cause _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (pinholes
or fisheyes). Page 221
81. A surface resembling the peel of an orange may be caused by the thinner in the dope evaporating too
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (fast or slow). Page 222
82. Fisheyes can be prevented by scrubbing the surface to be sprayed with a rag damp with
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ or .Page222
83. A topcoat of nitrate dope _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (will or will not) bond to butyrate fill coats. Page 221
84. Rejuvenation _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (does or does not) restore strength to weakened fabric. Page 222
85. The shape of the spray pattern produced by a paint spray gun is determined by the amount of air flowing
through the holes. Page 228
86. The exhaust fan in a spray booth should be _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ (near the floor or high up on
the wall). Page 223
87. To get the proper thickness of paint film, the spray gun should be held between _ _ _ _ _ and
_ _ __ inches from the surface being sprayed. Page 228
88. Each pass of the spray gun should overlap all but about _ _ _ _ _ _ _ or _ _ _ _ _ _ inches of the
previous pass. Page 228
89. The correct shape for the spray pattern of a paint gun is alan _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 229
90. A dumbbell-shaped spray pattern is caused by too _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (much or little) atomizing air
pressure. Page 229
91. A paint spray gun _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (should or should not) be cleaned by soaking the entire gun
in a container of thinner. Page 229
92. The registration numbers of an aircraft certificated in the United States must be preceded by the letter
_ _ _ _ _ _ .Page229
94. A ball-point pen (is or is not) a good instrument to use when laying out
registration numbers on a doped fuselage. Page 231
95. The masking tape used to lay out the registration numbers _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (should or should
not) be removed as soon as the finish is no longer tacky to the touch. Page 231
Composite Structures
Aircraft structures have evolved fully as much as have their powerplants.
The very first airframes were made of open trusses of either wood strips or
bamboo. The aerodynamic surfaces were made of lightweight wood cov-
ered with cotton or linen fabric, shrunk and made air tight with a syrup-like
collodion. Cel lul ose nitrate used as a fi lm collodion product that dried to a hard film.
base for certain aircraft dopes. The next major development came with the welded steel tube fuselage
structure that replaced the wooden truss. This structure is strong, but it has the
disadvantage that to give it a streamlined shape, a superstructure must be built
around the load-bearing truss. This adds weight but is needed for aerody-
namic smoothness and esthetics.
In the late 1920s, the Lockheed Company developed a streamlined
monocoquc. A single-shell type of aircraft wooden monocoque structure that carried virtually all of the stresses in its
structure in which all of the fl ight loads are outer skin. This lightweight streamlined structure was used on some of the
carried in the outside skin of the structure. most efficient aircraft of the time. It, however, had the disadvantage of be-
ing extremely labor intensive in its construction.
The next logical step in the evolution of aircraft structure was to replace
the wooden monocoque with a thin aluminum alloy monocoque. This
decreased the dependence upon skilled craftsmen for its construction and
made mass production of interchangeable parts practical and cost effective.
Metal stressed-skin aircraft structure has been the standard since the
1930s, but a new era is dawning, that of composites. Composite structure can
be made stronger, lighter in weight, more rigid, and less costly than metal.
plastics. The generic name fo r any of the W_e have experienced what may be termed a plastics revolution. Early
organic materials produced by polymeriza- plastic materials such as celluloid and Beetleware gave promise of a low-cost,
tion. Pl astics can be shaped by mold ing or easy-to-manufacture material, but they did not have the strength needed for
drawing. structural applications. One of the first plastic materials used in aviation was
a thermosetting phenol-formaldehyde resin that was reinforced with paper or
linen cloth. This phenolic material, called Micarta, pioneered in the early
1930s, is still used for control cable pulleys and fairleads and for electrical
insulators.
Figure 3-36. The Beech Starship is one of the first commercially produced general
a~•iation
aircraft to make extensive use of composite construction.
Composite Materials
Modern composite structure consists of high-strength fibers oriented in the
proper direction to withstand the stresses imposed upon them. These fibers
are encapsulated in a matrix that bonds them together and carries the aero-
dynamic and structural loads into the fibers.
By their very nature, composite materials are divided into two basic
categories: the reinforcing materials and the matrix.
Reinforcing Materials
Reinforcing materials consist of fibers that may be made into tapes, woven
into a fabric, grouped together into a loosely compacted mat, or lightly twisted
roving. A lightly twi sted roll or strand into a roll, or strand, called roving.
of fibers.
Fiberglass
Thin fibers are drawn from molten glass and spun together into threads and
woven into a shiny, white cloth. There are two types of glass used for fibers,
E-glass (electrical glass) and S-glass (structural glass). E-glass has high elec-
trical strength and is used for most nonaviation and some aviation applica-
tions. S-glass is stronger, tougher, and stiffer than E-glass and is used in
applications where its superior qualities outweigh its higher cost.
Kevlar
Kevla r '". A patented synthetic aramid Kevlar"® is the DuPont Company's registered trade name for its aramid
fiber noted for its tl exibility and light fiber. It has a yellow color and is lightweight, strong, and extremely flexible
weight. It is lOa great extent replacing and has excellent resistance to the chemicals normally associated with air-
fiberglass as a reinforcing fab ric for
craft operations.
composite constructi on.
Kevlar is used to replace fiberglass in many applications. A properly
designed Kevlar part has the strength of a similar metal part, but is much
lighter in weight.
Graphite
Graphite, or carbon, fibers are woven into a black fabric that is extremely graphite. A form of carbon. Structural
strong for its weight and is very stiff. It is used for primary structure where high graphite is used in composite structure
because o f its strength and stiffness.
strength and rigidity are the prime considerations. The stiffness of graphite
fibers has made it possible to explore the potential of the efficient forward-
swept wing in the research airplane, the Grumman X-29.
Figure 3-37. The aerodynamic advantages of a forward-swept wing were not able to be
exploited until graphite fibers were developed. Th e extreme stiffness of graphite made it
possible to build a wing that does not twist under aerodynamic loads.
Fiber Orientation
Wood is weak across its grain, but strong parallel to it, and when it is neces-
sary for wood to have multidirectional strength, it is made into plywood
whose thin veneers are glued together with their grains oriented at 45° or
90° to each other.
The same thing is true about composite materials whose major strength
and stiffness is parallel to its fibers. Strength and stiffness can be tailored to
the aerodynamic loads it must carry by the proper choice of the fabric weave
and by the orientation of the fibers in the adjacent plies in the fabric layup.
•· I
..,.
'
.,. f •
'
I
Major fibers Small cross threads
Figure 3-38. All of the major fibe rs in a piece of unidirectional fabric run in the
same direction.
When the maximum amount of strength and rigidity are needed in a structure,
several layers of unidirectional fabric can be laid up with the fibers of each of
aeroelastie tailoring. The desig n of an
the layers running in the direction required to furnish the required strength.
aerodynamic surface whose strength and The stiffness required in the Grumman X-29 forward- swept wing is furni shed
stiffness are matched to the aerodynamic by a wing box whose covers are made up of crisscrossed tapes of unidirec-
loads that will be imposed upo n it. tional graphite, crossing each other at 45° angles to oppose the aerodynamic
stresses. There are 156 layers of material at the point of maximum thickness.
wa rp threa ds. Threads that run the length Thi s type of design in which the characteristics of the material are matched
of the roll of fabric, paralle l to the se lvage to the aerodynamic loads is called aeroelastic tailoring.
edge. Warp threads arc often stro nger than
fill threads.
Bidirectional Fabrics
plain-weave fabric. Fabric in which each Woven fabrics are made by interlacing fill threads with the warp threads as
warp thread passes over one fi ll thread and the fabric is being woven on the looms. The particular weave is chosen to give
under the next. Pl ain-weave fabric the fabric the desired characteristics. Some of the most generally used weaves
typica lly has the same strength in both are the plain weave and various types of satin weaves.
warp and fi ll directions .
In the plain-weave fabric , Figure 3-39, each warp thread passes over one
fill thread and under the next. Plain-weave fabrics are the most stable for lay-
satin-weave fabric. Fabric in which the
ups because the threads slip less than other weaves.
warp threads pass under one fi ll thread and
over several more. Satin-weave fab rics arc
Satin weaves are those in which one warp thread passes over several fill
used when the lay-up must be mad e over threads and under just one. Satin weaves are used when the fabric must be
complex shapes. draped into complex shapes with a high degree of smoothness.
Hybrids
A hybrid fabric is composed of different types of fibers woven together to
obtain special characteristics. One of the more popular hybrid composites is
Kevlar and graphite. Fibers of each material are woven together to produce
a fabric that has some of the better characteristics of both of the fibers.
Polyester Resins
polyester resin. A thermosetting resin Polyester resins were the first developed, and have been used primarily with
used as a matrix fo r much of the fiberglass fiberglass. Polyesters do not provide the strength needed for most of the
used in composite construction.
modern applications, but because of their low cost and relative ease of use,
they are used for some nonstructural applications such as fairings.
Polyester resins are two-part materials: a resin and a catalyst. Typically
about one ounce of catalyst is used with one gallon of resin.
Epoxy Resins
A number of epoxy resins are used as a matrix material. Each of them have
different characteristics. Some are liquids as thin as water, and others are thick
syrups. Some have good high-temperature characteristics, others are better
suited for low-temperature applications. Some are very rigid, whi le others are
quite flexible. Some cure quickly, and others allow for a longer working time
before they cure.
Almost all aircraft structural epoxy is a two-part material, resin and
catalyst, that is quite different from polyester resins. Rather than using a small
amount of catalyst to initiate the resin's cure as is done with polyester, epoxy
resins use a different type of catalyst, or hardener, and use much more of it.
It is extremely important to follow the approved instructions when
mixing epoxy resins. The material must be fresh; that is, it must be used within
its allowable shelf life which is stamped on the container. You must use the
correct resin and the correct hardener, and the two materials must be
accurately weighed and mixed for the recommended length of time. After
mixing the materials, you must use them within the usable pot life, which is
given in terms of minutes, and which is stamped on the container.
Adhesives
An adhesive is a resin that is used to bond parts together. Some adhesives
are available as two-part liquids that are mixed when they are needed.
Another form of adhesive that is extremely handy for certain types of con-
struction and repair is film-type adhesive. This adhesive is made up of cata-
lyzed resin that is formed into a thin film. A plastic backing sheet is put on
one side and stored in a refrigerator. To use it, cut a piece of the film to the
proper size and put it into place between the prepared surface and a prepreg
patch. Heat and pressure cure the adhesive and securely bond the patch
in place.
Foaming adhesives are used to bond sections of honeycomb core. This
adhesive is in the form of a thick tape or sheet which is wrapped around the
replacement core plug. When heat is applied, the adhesive foams up and
expands to fill all of the crevices and hardens to ensure a good joint.
Core Materials
Aluminum alloy has a high enough tensile strength that a very thin sheet
may be strong enough for a given application, but this thin sheet does not
have enough stiffness to make it a totally adequate structural material. One
of the early incursions into the field of composite materials was done by
bonding end-grain balsa wood betweeR two thin sheets of aluminum alloy.
The metal provided the strength, and the balsa wood provided the thickness
and thus the stiffness without adding too much weight. This type of compos-
ite is called sandwich construction.
sandwich material. A type of composite
Sandwich construction in which a lightweight core material is bonded structural material in wh ich a core material
between face plies of metal or resin-reinforced fabric is used today for all is bonded between face sheets of metal or
types of aircraft from homebuilt machines to high-speed, state-of-the-art resin- impregnated fabric.
military aircraft.
TWidth
Manufacturing Methods
T he manufacturing of a composite structure requires entirely different proce-
du res from those used with sheet metal. The basic principle of much
composite construction involves the process of laying up the reinforcing
material in such a way that the maximum strength of each ply is oriented in
the correct direction. The engineers who designed the part have computed all
of the stresses to which the part will be subjected and have specified the Heated female die
orientation of the fibers. As was mentioned earlier, the top and bottom skins
Resin-impregnated fibers
of the wing box o f the forward-swept wing of the Grumman X-29 are made
up of unidirectional graphite tapes. The pi ies of these tapes are oriented at45°
Figure 3-41. Heated matched dies are
increments to g ive the wing its unique ability to wi thstand the twisting loads used for making a large number of
without the divergence that has prevented the use of the effi cient forward- identical parts.
swept configuration in the past.
After the correct number of plies of material have been laid up with the
proper orientation, the complete assembly must be cured. This is typical ly
done with pressure and heat. There are three ways to apply heat and pressure:
by matched dies, by a vacu um bag, and in an autoclave. a utoclave. A pressure vessel inside of
which air can be heated to a high tempera-
Matched Dies ture and pressure rai sed to a high value.
Autoclaves arc used in the composite
When a la rge number of identical parts are to be made, manufacturers use a manufacturing industry to apply heat and
set of heated matched dies similar to the ones in Figure 3-41. Prepreg material pressure for curing the resi ns.
is placed over the female die, orunimprcgnated fibers are laid in a bed of resin
in the female die. The male die is then forced down into the female die to give
the finished product the desired shape and to ensure that all of the fibers are
completely encapsulated with the resin. Pressure and heat are applied for a
specific length of time to c ure the resin.
Heated
female
mold
Figure 3-42. A vacuum hag may be used to apply the pressure to a composite lay-up ro
ensure that it takes the shape of the female die and to ensure that all of the individual
fibers are completely encapsulated.
Autoclaves
An autoclave is a pressure vessel in which air can be heated to a high tem-
perature and pressure raised to a high value. Many manufacturers of com-
posite structures use autoclaves to apply the heat and pressure needed to
cure resins.
Filament Winding
When a component such as a helicopter rotor blade or a propeller blade must
have the most strength possible, it may be filament-wound as illustrated in
Figure 3-43. A mandrel in the shape of the component is mounted in a fixture
that rotates it. Preimpregnated filaments are fed off spools and wrapped
around the mandrel. The head through which the filaments pass is computer-
controlled so the different layers of the filaments can be oriented at the angle
specified by the engineers. When the wrapping is completed, the component
is placed in an autoclave and heated and held under the required pressure for
the specified length of time.
Repair
Assume that a careful inspection has found damage in a piece of honeycomb-
core composite material that has three plies of fabric on each side. The damage
extends through the surface skin into the core material. Two typical repairs
are described in this section to show the room-temperature cure and the hot
curing method.
Room-Temperature Cure
First, outline the damaged area. In this example, no part of the damage extends
beyond a two-inch circle. The edges of the cleaned-out hole will taper back
so that one inch of each ply is exposed on each side of the damage. For this
repair in a three-ply face sheet, an area 10 inches in diameter must be cleaned
up and prepared.
Ply orientation -
Edge of extra ply
Edge of ply 1
Cleaned·out damage
and filler ply
4 .0 ~
6.0
8.0 --~.,
Figure 3-44. Typical dimensions for a room -temperature repair to the face plies of a
honeycomb core composite panel
Figure 3-43. When the maximum strength is required, the part may be filament-wound and
cured in an autoclave.
Inspection
Before any repair is considered, you must determine the extent of the damage
and choose a method of repair.
Delamination is one of the most common types of damage found in dela mina tio n. T he separation of the layers
composite structure. If the face pi ies separate from the core material, or if some o f a laminated material.
of the plies separate from each other, the material loses its strength and must
be repaired. One of the simplest methods of inspecting a structure for delami-
nations is to tap the suspected area with the edge of a coin. If there is no
delamination, the coin will produce a clear ringing sound, but if there is
delamination, the sound will be a dull thud. The coin tap procedure is not a
quantitative test, but it gives an indication when further investigation is needed.
Cracks in the surface may be indications of serious damage, or they may
be superficial and require no repair other than touching up the paint. It is
important to be able to determine which is the case. U ltrasonic inspection may
be used to determine if a part is actually damaged. Pulses of high-frequency
vibrations are fed into the part and renected back into a pickup. The results
are displayed on the screen of a cathode-ray tube.
Sealing tape
Bleeder material
c=======================================~~
-----------------------------~ Perforated parting film
Sanding ply
------------------------------------------------~
=
=~~;~~~~~~~~~~~~~§~E=:=~~~==:==:---
==--- Extra
Repairply
plies
_ _ _ Filler ply
==============~ --------
! II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II If
Figure 3-46. Typical lay-up for vacuum-bagging of a room-temperature cured repair
Prepare the area as described above, using the dimensions shown in Figure Ply
orientation Edge of extra ply
3-47. In a hot-bond repair, cut back each layer half an inch on each side.
Remove the damaged material and draw a circle with a five-inch diam-
eter, centered on the damage. This will be the outer edge of the original
material. Carefully sand through each ply of material , tapering the sanding so
you expose half an inch of each ply, but do not expose the core. Clean the
surface with a rag damp with methyl-ethyl-ketone (MEK) or acetone.
Cut a plug of honeycomb as described in the room-temperature-cured
repair section, and wrap it with a foaming adhesive. When the repair is cured,
the heat causes the adhesive to foam and bond the core to the surrounding
honeycomb.
Lay out the repair ply inserts by tracing the actual size of each insert onto
pieces of clear plastic. Mark an arrow on each circle to show the orientation
of the warp threads.
Use prepreg and the adhesive specified in the SRM to make this repair. Figure 3-47. Typical dimensions for a hot-
Lay the plastic patterns for each of the ply inserts over the prepreg, orienting bond repair to the face plies and core of a
the arrow on the plastic with the warp threads, and cut the inserts, following honeycomb composite panel
the pattern.
Be sure that the structure is ready to receive the patch. Lay a piece of film
adhesive in place, and remove the plastic from the filler ply that is the same
size as the exposed core. Carefully put it in place, observing the direction of
the warp threads as specified in the SRM. Then remove the plastic from each
of the repair plies and the extra ply, and lay them in place, again paying
attention to the ply orientation.
Vacuum bag
=~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~§§~~~~~~~~;~===
=
Extra ply
Repair plies
{I I II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II II 11
Figure 3-48. Typical fay-up fo r a hoi hand repair
Place the thermocouples from the heater on top of the parting film and lay a
sheet of bleeder material over the film. This bleeder is a porous material that
holds the resin squeezed from the material as it is placed under pressure to cure
the repair. Place a piece of non perforated parting film over the bleeder and the
heat blanket on top of it.
Lay the sealing tape around the repair area, and then carefully seal around
the wires for the heat blanket and the thermocouple. Place the vacuum
bagging material that has the fitting for the vacuum pump over the tape. Press
it down into the tape to produce a seal. Connect the vacuum pump and check
for leaks.
Figure 3-49. Computerized controller for applying the heat and pressure to the repair at a
carefully programmed rate.
Figure 3-50. Brad-poinl drills are used to drill Kevlar without leaving fuzz inside the hole.
Side view
C>® End view
Hole cutters designed to cut fuzz-free holes in Kev lar are available. They have
carbide cutting edges and diameters from 7/ 16 inch up to 3 inches.
Drill graphite with a spade drill like the one in Figure 3-51. This drill has
ample space for the drill dust to leave the hole, so it will not enlarge the hole.
Figure 3-51. Spade drill fur drilling Graphite, like Kevlar, should be drilled at a high speed with only a little
graphite material pressure on the drill.
Glass and graphite fibers will dull ordinary steel saw blades, so be sure
to use carbide-tipped saws or saws with diamond dust for their cutting edges
when you are cutting cured composite materials.
The best way to scarf laminated materials is to sand with a small, high-
speed, right-angle sander. These sanders can be fitted with one-inch, two-
inch, or three-inch-diameter disks, and they turn at about 20,000 rpm. Alu-
minum oxide disks are suitable for sanding glass or Kevlar, but you should
use silicon carbide for sanding graphite.
You must wear a dust respirator when sanding composite materials be-
cause the tiny airborne particles can be extremely hazardous to your lungs.
Skin Care
Take special care to keep the chemicals used in composite construction and
repair from direct contact with the skin. If any of them do, wash them off
immediately. Wear latex or butyl gloves when working with these chemicals,
and wear a shop coat to prevent the chemicals from contaminating your
clothing and holding the vapors in contact with your skin.
There are protective hand gels that can be used on your hands before
working with the resins. These gels leave a thin, invisible, flexible film on
your hands that prevent the chemicals getting to your skin. The gel is easy to
wash off when the work is finished. Typically this protective gel must not be
used when wearing gloves.
Eye Care
Take all precautions to protect your eyes. It is extremely important to wear
goggles that provide complete eye protection when working with composite
materials. Be sure that the goggles you wear protect your eyes from splashed
chemicals as well as from sand ing dust and particles that fly when you cut or
drill the cured materials.
If you should get any chemicals in your eyes, rinse them immediately
with plenty of fresh water and get medical assistance at once.
Respiratory Care
Particles of glass and graphite produced by sanding can be extremely haz-
ardous to your lungs, and you should not sand without wearing a respirator
that protects against these particles.
When working with resins such as epoxies in a poorly ventilated area,
you should wear a respirator mask designed to protect against these vapors.
96. An aircraft stmcture that carries most of the aerodynamic stresses in its outer skin is called a/an
_ _ __ __ _ _ _____ structure. Page 234
97. The glass fibers that produce the stronger structure are made of _ _ _ __ _ _ _ __
(E or S)-glass. Page 236
98. Kevlar fabric is noted for being _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (flexible or stiff). Page 236
99. Graphite fabric is noted for being _ _ _ __ _ __ _ __ _ _ (flexibl e or stiff). Page 237
100. Corrosion can be a problem with aluminum alloys when they are bonded to
..,..------ -- - -- - - (fiberglass or graphite). Page 237
I 0 I. The type of plastic material that is softened by heat and that regains its hardness when it is cooled is a
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ (thermoplastic or thermosetting) material. Page 240
I 02. Polyester resins (are or are not) used as a matrix material for modern
high-strength composite structures. Page 240
103. There _ _ _ _________ (is or is not) more than one type of epoxy resin. Page 240
104. Prepregs are prevented from curing before they are used by storage in a/an
_ _ _ _ _ _______ .Page241
I06. The adhesive recommended to bond a plug of honeycomb material into a honeycomb panel is alan
_ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___ adhesive. Page 241
108. Urethane foam _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___ (can or cannot) be used with a polyester resin. Page 242
I 09. Three ways heat and pressure can be applied to composite component are:
a. _ __ _ __ __ _ __ __ _ _ _ _ __
b. _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ __ __ _ _ _
c. _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ __
Page 243 Continued
111. A method of nondestructive inspection used to check a piece of composite structure for crack damage
is alan inspection. Page 245
113. The fini sh on a piece of composite structure to be repaired may be properly removed with
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (paint stripper or sandpaper). Page 247
114. After the damage has been removed from a piece of honeycomb-core composite material , all of the
sanding dust should be removed with (vacuum or compressed air). Page 247
115. When installing the replacement plug in a piece of honeycomb core, it is important that the length or
_ _ _ _ _ __ __ _ direction of the plug be the same as that of the structure. Page 247
116. When drilling cured composite materials, the drill should be turned _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(fast or slow). Page 252
Transparent Plastics
Acrylic plastics have been used for windshields and side windows of the
smaller general aviation aircraft for many years. Acrylics are of the thermo-
plastic family of resins, which means that they can be softened by heat, and
when they are cooled they will regain their original hardness and rigidity.
They are not damaged by repeated heating and cooling, so long as they are not
overheated. Acrylic plastics are known by their trade names of Plexiglas and
Lucite in the United States. and in the United Kingdom as Perspex.
It is possible that acetate plastics may be encountered in some older
aircraft. T hese are also thermoplastic,- but since they yellow and become
brittle with age, they have almost all been replaced with the superior acrylic.
Determine whether the material is acetate or acrylic by rubbing a bit of ac-
etone on the surface. If it softens, it is probably acetate, but if the surface
turns white and does not soften, it is acrylic.
Cutting
A band saw is the favored tool for cutting acrylics. Mark the outline of the
part on the protecting paper and cut to within about V16 inch of the line. Do
the final trimming with a disk or belt sander.
Use a circular saw for straight cuts if the blades are hollow ground , or have
Dubbed off to
enough set to the teeth to prevent binding. When cutting thick material , take
care not to feed it into the saw too fast. This will cause overheating and the
material will begin to melt at the edges of the cut. If the material smokes, or
starts to soften, slow the cutting.
Drilling
The poor heat conductivity of acrylics requires the use of a coolant when
drilling deep holes. Use a water-soluble cutting oil, which will provide ad-
equate cooling and not attack the plastic.
The drill used for acrylic should have smooth flutes and a 0° rake angle,
and the included angle should be greater than that used for drilling aluminum.
Turn the drill at a high speed and use a light to moderate pressure. Back up thin
Slow spiral
polished flutes
material with a piece of wood so the drill will not break or chip the edges of
the hole when it comes through the back side.
Figure 3-52. Drill for aoy lic plastics
~== Q ru ~ ~ ...
,4 You can also cement plastics with the glue method. Dissolve some acrylic
shavings in the liquid solvent to make it into a viscous syrup. Apply the syrup
to either one or both of the parts and allow the cushion to form. Assemble the
Press two pieces together and hold parts and apply pressure. Allow the pressure to remain until the solvents
pressure until solvents evaporate.
evaporate and the cushions harden.
~~/$?> )~\]
t When solvents have evaporated , trim
excess material that has extruded
Press pieces together and from between parts .
apply steady pressu re.
into a larger volume. The solvent content and the strength of the cured
material is nearly the same as that of the original material. Equilibrium
after heat
There are several good commercial polishes on the market that clean and
polish plastic windshields. These cleaners typically contain an antistatic
material that prevents the windshield from attracting dust, and wax that fills
the minute surface scratches . When applying these waxes, use only a clean,
soft cloth or a lint-free wiper. Do not use ordinary shop rags, because they
collect tiny particles of metal and abrasives that are not removed in their
normal laundering.
A good grade of paste wax will protect the plastic and cause rain to ball
up and blow off rather than spreading out and distorting vision.
Crazing
The most common types of damage are crazing and cuts. Crazing, or tiny,
hair-like cracks that may or may not extend all of the way to the surface, may
be caused by stresses or by chemical fumes. These tiny cracks cannot be felt,
but must be removed with abrasives. It is extremely important, afterremoving
all of the damage, to ensure that the window still has the required thickness,
and that the removal has not caused visual distortion. Because of the high cost
of the windows and the disastrous consequences if they were to blow out, any
damage to windows of pressurized aircraft should be assessed and repaired
by specialists. Repair stations who specialize in window repair can measure
thickness of the repaired window accurately with ultrasonic thickness mea-
suring instruments, and use grid patterns to check for optical distortion.
An AMT can usually repair minor damage to windshields and side
windows for small unpressurized general aviation aircraft by using progres-
sively finer sandpapers and finishing the repair by polishing it with Micro-
Mesh®,_ the registered trademark of Micro Surface Finishing Products of
Micro-Mesh"'. A patented graduated series Wilton, Iowa.
of c loth -backed cushi oned sheets that Remove a scratch in a window by beginning the sanding with 320 wet-
contain abrasi ve crystals. Micro-Mesh is or-dry sandpaper wrapped around a foam sanding block, sanding with
used for polishing and restoring transpar-
ency to acrylic plastic windows and
straight strokes, and using firm, but not hard pressure . Do not use circular
wi ndsh ields. strokes, and periodically change the direction of the strokes by 90°. Remove
the damage with the 320-grit paper, then remove the pattern it left with 400-
grit paper. Next remove the pattern of this paper with 600-grit.
After you remove the damage, the surface retains the pattern left by the
600-grit paper. Restore the full transparency by polishing it with Micro-Mesh.
Micro-Mesh comes with a graduated series of cloth-backed cushioned sheets,
Surface patch
Beveled edge
All stresses concentrate at end of crack. Stop-drilling end of crack spreads Finished repair has piece of acrylic
stresses around entire circumference cemented over damage.
and stops crack.
117. One of the biggest differences in working aluminum and acrylic plastics lies in the _ _ __ _ _ _ __
(better or poorer) heat conduction of the acrylic. Page 256
120. When a piece of acrylic plastic is cut on a band saw to the approximate outline of the part, the final
trim can be made with a/an . Page 256
122. Small pieces of acrylic plastic can be heated for forming in a/an _ __ _ __ _ _ _ __
(oil or water) bath. Page 257
125. The best type of clamp to use to apply pressure when cementing two pieces of acrylic plastic together
is alan clamp. Page 258
126. The best method of removing dirt from a plastic windshield is by flushing it with
______________________ .Page259
127. Oil and grease can be removed from acrylic plastic with a _______________________ solution.
Page 259
128. After cleaning a windshield, it should be coated with a good grade of ________________________
Page 259
129. The window of a pressurized aircraft can be checked for thickness with a/an - - - - - - - - - - - -
thickness measuring instrument. Page 260
130. Crazing can be removed from an acrylic windshield with - - - - - ---- - - - ---- . Page 260
13 1. When removing scratches from a windshield with sandpaper, the paper should be moved in a
___ _ __ __ _ ____ (straight or circular) motion. Page 260
132. A patch cemented over a hole or crack should extend for _____________ inch
beyond the damage. Page 262
264 AVIATIO'< M AINTENA:-;CE T t-:CI INICIA:-: SERIES Volume 1: AIRFRAME STR UCTUR~-5
AssEMBLY AND RIGGING
4
Airplane Controls 269
Airplane Primary Flight Controls 269
Con troLs for Roll 269
Ailerons 269
Elevons 271
ControLs/or Pitch 271
Elevator 271
Stabilator 272
Ruddervator 273
Canard 273
Controls for Yaw 273
Airplane Secondary Flight Controls 274
Surfaces That Modify the L(ft 274
Flaps 274
Plain Flaps 274
Split Flaps 275
Slotted Flaps 275
Fowler Flaps 275
Triple-Slotted Flaps 275
Leading Edge Flaps 275
Slats 276
Spoilers 276
Devices That Change the Oper_ating Forces 277
Balance Surfaces 278
Tabs 278
Trim Tabs 278
Balance Tabs 278
Servo Tabs 279
Spring Tabs 279
Antiservo Tabs 279
Adjustable Stabilizer 280
Continued
Airplane Controls
This chapte r considers the hardware used to control aircraft, and the way roll. Rotation of an aircraft about its
aircraft are assembled and rigged for the most efficient night. longitudinal ax is.
speed brakes. A secondary control of an moving downward. The extra upward travel creates just about enough para-
airplane that produces drag without site drag to counteract the induced drag caused by the lowered aileron. The
causing a change in the pitch attitude of aileron shown in Figure 4-2 is a Frise aileron. Part of its nose extends below
the airplane. Speed brakes allow an the bottom wing surface as an additional aid in preventing adverse yaw.
airplane to make a steep descent without
At the beginning of a turn, the pilot uses the rudder to overcome adverse
building up excessive forwa rd airspeed.
yaw by rotating the airplane about its vertical, or yaw, axis. This starts the
nose moving in the correct direction. As soon as the bank is established, the
adverse yaw force disappears and the rudder is neutralized. The rudder con-
trols of some airplanes, such as the one in Figure 4-3, are interconnected
balance panel. A flat panel that is hinged
to the leading edge of some ailerons that
with the aileron controls through a spring in such a way that rotating the
produces a force wh ich assists the pilot in control wheel pulls the rudder cable.
holding them deflected. The balance panel Many large jet transport airplanes have two ailerons on each wing and
divides a chamber ahead of the aileron in flight spoilers to assist in roll control. The flight spoiler deflects on the wing
such a way that when the aileron is with the upward moving aileron. See Figure 4-34 on Page 286. The outboard
deflected downward, for example, air
ailerons are locked in their faired , or streamline, position when the trailing
flowing over its top surface produces a low
pressure that acts on the balance panel and edge flaps are up. The inboard ailerons and the flight spoilers provide enough
causes it to apply an upward force to the roll control for high-speed flight, but when the flaps are lowered, the inboard
leading edge as long as it is dctlcctcd . and outboard ailerons work together to provide the additional roll control
needed for low-speed flight. All the flight spoilers can be raised together to
act as speed brakes.
The ailerons are hydraulically powered, but they have internal balance
servo tab. A small movable tab built into panels and servo tabs to help move them in case of hydraulic system failure.
the trailing edge of a primary control
surface of an airplane. The cockpit
controls move the tab in such a direction
that it produces an aerodynamic force that
moves the surface on wh ich it is mounted.
Stabilator
stabilator. A single-piece horizontal tail Some airplanes use a stabilator for pitch control. This is a single-piece hori-
surface that serves the functions of both zontal surface that pivots about a point approximately one third of the way
the horizontal stabilizer and the elevators. back from the leading edge. When the control wheel is pulled back, the lead-
The stabilator pivots about its fro nt spar.
ing edge of the stabilator moves down and increases the downward force
produced by the tail. This rotates the nose up. When the wheel is pushed in,
the nose of the stabilator moves up, decreasing the tail load, and the airplane
rotates nose down.
Canard
Conventional aircraft achieve longitudinal stability and control through hori- canard. A horizontal control surface
zontal stabi lizers on the tail that produce a downward aerodynamic force . mounted ahead of the wing to provide
longitudinal stability and colllrol.
This downward force acts as part of the flight load, and the wing must pro-
duce lift to overcome it.
A canard is a horizontal stabi lizing surface located ahead of the main center of gravity. The location on an
wing that makes the airplane inherently stall-proof. The center of gravity is aircraft about which the force of gravity is
located ahead of the main wing, and the angle of incidence of the canard is concentrated .
greater than that of the main wing, so it will stall first. See Figure 4-6. When
the canard stall s, the nose drops and the smooth airflow over the canard is angle of incidence. The acute angle
restored, and its lift is increased to bring the airplane back to straight and formed between the chord line of an airfoil
level 1light. and the long itudinal ax is of the airplane.
Some canards have movable surfaces on their trailing edge for pitch
control and others pivot the entire surface for control. The angle of sweep of
canards mounted on some high-performance airplanes may be varied in flight
to optimize the flight characteristics.
Figure 4-6. The angle of incidence of the canard is greater than that of the main wing and
it will stallfirst. When it stalls, the nose of the airplane drops and flying speed is restored.
Flaps
Flaps are the most widely used method for modifying lift. Most flaps are on
the trailing edge of the wing inboard of the ailerons, but some are located on
' ', ' ' the wings' leading edges.
'' ''
' ' ''
'' '' Plain Flaps
' ' ,' ,, ,
,, The simplest type of flap is the plain flap, illustrated in Figure 4-8. This flap
",, is simply a hinged portion of the trailing edge of the wing inboard of the
Fowler Flaps
Fowler flaps are similar to slotted flaps , except that they move aft along a set
of tracks to increase the chord of the wing (and thus its area) when they are
lowered. A Fowler flap produces a greater increase in lift with the least change
in drag than any other type of flap. See Figure 4-11.
Figure 4-11. Fowler flaps move aft along
a set of tracks to increase the wing chord
Triple-Slotted Flaps when they are lowered. They produce a
Many large jet transp011 airplanes use triple-slotted flaps like the one in Fig- large increase in lift and a minimum
ure 4-12. As this flap is lowered, it slides out of the wing on tracks and increase in drag.
increases the camber and wing area in the same way as a Fowler flap, but it
separates and forms slots between its segments. The air flowing through
these slots is forced down against the flap upper surface, which delays air-
flow separation and produces additional lift.
~Foreflap
~
Leading Edge Flaps
Some high-performance airplanes have flaps on the leading edges as well as }--(,_ Mid ll•p
~-~
on the trailing edges. Figure 4-13 on the next page shows a drooped leading
edge that is lowered at the same time as·the trailing edge flaps to increase the
camber of the wing and allow it to attain a higher angle of attack before the
airflow breaks away over the upper surface.
Aftflap
Spoilers
Flight spoilers are hinged surfaces located ahead of the flaps. They are used
in conjunction with the ailerons to assist in roll control. When the ailerons are
deflected, the flight spoilers on the wing with the up aileron automatically
deploy to a maximum of 30° to decrease the lift on the wing that is movi ng
down. They also produce additional parasite drag to overcome adverse yaw.
When a large amount of aileron is used, the spoilers account for about 80%
of the roll rate.
Flight spoilers move differentially when they are used for roll control, but
they may be deployed symmetrically and used as speed brakes by actuating
the speed brake control. When used as speed brakes they may be extended
between 0° and 45 ° depending on the position of the speed brake control.
Ground spoilers deploy to their full 45° opening when the airplane is on the
ground with weight on the landing gear and the speed brake lever is moved
through its I0° position.
Some high-performance general aviation airplanes have spoilers, or
speed brakes, installed on the front wing spar in such a way that they may be
raised above the upper wing surface in flight to allow the airplane to make a
steep descent without gaining an excess of speed, and without having to
decrease the engine power to the extent that the cyl inders will be damaged by
too rapid cooling.
pilot must have some kind of assistance to move them. The controls on most
large airplanes are moved by electrical or hydraulic servos. This section, controllability. The characteristic of an
however, discusses only the devices that change the forces aerodynamically. aircraft that allows it to change its flight
att itude in respo nse to the pilot" s move-
ment of the cockpit contro ls.
Tabs
Small auxiliary devices on the trailing edges of the various primary control
surfaces are used to produce aerodynamic forces to trim the aircraft or to aid
the pilot in moving the controls. Some tabs are fixed to the surface and are
adjustable only on the ground. These tabs are used to produce a fixed air load
on the control surface to trim the airplane against a permanent out-of-balance
condition. The tabs discussed in this section are adjustable to compensate for
Figure 4-16. This empennage has m1 varying flight conditions.
aerodynamically balanced rudder. The top
portion of the rudder extends ahead of the Trim Tabs
hinge line to provide an aerodynamic
as~ist in deflecting it.
Trim tabs such as those in Figure 4-17 may be installed on the rudder, aile-
ron, and elevator. They are controllable from the cockpit and allow the pilot
to deflect them in such a direction that they produce an aerodynamic force
trim tab. A smal l control tab mounted on on the control surface that holds it deflected to correct for an out-of-balance
the trailing edge of a movable control
condition. This allows the airplane to be adjusted to fly straight and level
surf ace . The tab may be adjusted to
provide an aerodynamic force to ho ld the
with hands and feet off of the controls. Once a trim tab is adjusted, it main-
surface on which it is mou nted deflected to tains a fixed relationship with the control surface as it is moved.
trim the airplane for hands-off tl ight at a
specified airspeed . Balance Tabs
A balance tab, like that in Figure 4-18, works automatically to produce an air
balance tab. An adj ustable tab mounted
load on the control surface that assists the pilot in moving the surface. When
on the trail ing edge o f a control s urface
to produce a force that aids the pi lot in
the cockpit control is moved to raise the trailing edge of the control surface,
moving the surface. The tab is automat i- the linkage pulls the balance tab so that it moves in the opposite direction. This
cally actuated in such a way it moves opposite deflection produces an aerodynamic force that assists the pilot in
in the direction opposite to the direction moving the surface. The linkage for many balance tabs is adjustable to allow
the control surface on which it is the position of the tab to be changed in flight so the tab can serve as a trim tab
mounted moves.
as weU as a balance tab.
Control Balance
J ackscrew surface Jackscrew surface tab
Figure 4-17. A trim tab is adjustable from the cockpit to Figure 4-18. A balance tab moves in the direction opposite to that of the
allow the pilot to trim the airplane ~o it will fly straight control ~urface on which it is mounted. This opposite deflection produces
and level with hands and feet off of the controls. an aerodynamic force that aids the pilot in moving the surface. This
balance tab may be udju~ted in flight so that it also acts as a trim tab.
Figure 4-19. A servo tab is controlled from the cockpit Figure 4-20. A spring tab deflects only when control forces
to produce an aerodynamic force which moves the become so high that the pilot needs assistance in moving the
primary control su1jace. primary control surface.
Servo Tabs
A servo tab, also called a control tab, is installed on the control surfaces of
airplanes requiring such high control forces that it is impractical to move the
primary surface itself. The cockpit control is attached to the servo tab so that
it moves in the direction opposite that desired for the primary surface. Adjustment jackscrew
Balance attached to fuselage
Deflection of the servo tab produces an aerodynamic force that deflects the
weight ~
primary surface, which in turn rotates the airplane about the desired axis.
See Figure 4-19 .
k------+- ~ Stabilator Antiservo
Spring Tabs pivot point tab
Antiservo tab is connected to adjustable
A spring tab is used on high-performance airplanes that, under high-speed jackscrew to allow pilot to position it to
conditions, develop aerodynamic forces so great that assistance is needed to produce correct tail-down load for hands-off
straight and level flight.
help the pilot move the controls. Figure 4-20 shows that the control horn is
attached to the control surface through a torsion rod. For normal flight the
horn moves the control surface and the spring tab does not deflect. But at high
speeds when the control force becomes excessive, the torsion rod twists and
allows the horn to move relative to the surface. The linkage deflects the spring
tab in such a direction that it produces an aerodynamic force that aids the pilot When control wheel IS pulled back, stabilator
in moving the primary surface. nose moves down, increasing down load on
tail and rotating airplane nose up about its
lateral axis. Antiservo tab moves up to
Antiservo Tabs produce stabilizing force on stabilator.
An anti servo tab is installed on the trailtng edge of a stabilator to decrease its
sensitivity. The tab is attached to the aircraft structure through a linkage rod
and a jackscrew to allow it to be used as a trim tab.
When the stabilator is deflected, air strikes the portion ahead of the pivot
point and tries to increase its deflection. This makes the stabilator too sensitive.
To decrease this sensitivity, the antiservo tab on its trailing edge moves in the When control wheel is moved forward,
same direction as the stabilator. When the trailing edge of the stabilator moves stabilator nose moves up, decreasing
downward tail load and allowing airplane to
up, the antiservo tab moves up and produces a downward load that tries to rotate nose down about its lateral axis.
move the stabilator back to its streamline position. When the trailing edge of Antiservo tab moves down.
the stabilator moves down, the antiservo tab moves down, producing an
upward force that tries to streamline the stabilator. See Figure 4-21. Figure 4-21. Antisen1o tab
Rear spar
Horizontal stabilizer pivot point
Figure 4-22. Some airplanes provide Figure 4-23. A balance panel uses the low pressure caused by the deflected
longitudinal trim by pivoting the horizon- aileron to create a force that helps hold the aileron deflected.
tal stabilizer about its rear spar and
raising or lowering the leading edge by
means of a jackscrew. Bungee Spring
Some airplanes have a spring whose tension may be contro lled by the pilot.
The spring holds a mechanical force on the control system to trim the air-
plane for hands-off flight at the desired airspeed. Such a bungee system is
shown "in Figure 4-24.
Elevator
~
0
,..
...!.... Control wheel
Elevator
bellcrank Elevator
Figure 4-25. The elevator dmvnspring produces a mechanical f orce on the elevator that
lowers the nose and prevents a stall when an aft CG location causes the tail load to be
ineffective at/ow airspeed.
ill
Nonflexible cable is used for straight runs where the cable does not pass
•
over any pulley. Flexible cable can be used where it passes over a pulley, but
should not be used where the flexing requirements are extreme, as they are in
t most primary flight control systems. The extra-flexible, or 7 x 19, cable is the
7x7 flexible 7x19 extra-flexible one most widely used for primary control systems.
The strengths of 7 x 7 and 7 x 19 cable are shown in Figure 4-27. These
Figure 4-26. Steel control cables used in strengths are for straight runs of cable and do not include the effect of
aircraft control systems wrapped ends.
The smallest cable that can be used in the primary control system of an
aircraft is '18 inch, but smaller cables may be used to actuate trim tabs if the
manufacturer has approved it.
~·'--·'-~=::ls:l
Eye-end cable terminal
terminal shown in Figure 4-29. In this type of terminal the end of the cable is
passed through a heavy copper sleeve, wrapped around a steel thimble and
passed back into the s leeve. The sleeve is then crimped with a special
crimping tool. This type of terminal has 100% of the strength of the cable on
Figure 4-28. Swaged control cable terminals
which it is installed.
There is more information on cable terminals in the General textbook of
this Aviation Maintenance Technician Series.
Guard pin
Figure 4-31. Two types of guards used with a pulley to prevent the cable from slipping out of the groove
Ji
Self-aligning Check Threaded
'":;~~(~~--.------------'!Liu_m_i_n_;~~';'
Steel or Clevis
;'
\\ \\
Figure 4-32. A typical push-pull control rod
Rod-End Fittings
The rod-end bearing shown in Figure 4-33 is typical of the terminal used on
a push-pull rod. When installing this type of fitting be sure that the threaded
portion of the rod end extends into the fitting far enough that the inspection
hole is covered. This ensures that there are enough threads engaged to give full
strength to the joint. On an inspection, try to insert a piece of safety wire into
the inspection hole. The threaded end of the rod should prevent the wire from
going through the hole.
The antifriction bearing installed in a rod-end fitting is covered with a
disc of thin sheet metal held in place by the edges of the fitting peened over
the disc. When you install the bearing, you must be sure that the closed side
of the fitting is next to the device to which the rod is attached, as illustrated
Figure 4-33. The correct installation of an in Figure 4-33. The rod will still remain attached to the device even if the
antifriction rod-end bearing bearing should fail.
- Outboard aileron
Figure 4-34. Flight controls for a Boeing 727 jet transport airplane
Pitch Control
The elevators are controlled by two dual hydraulic power units that are sup-
plied by both A and B systems and controlled by fore-and-aft movement of
the control column. The elevator tabs act as balance tabs for normal flight
when hydraulic pressure is available, but if hydraulic pressure should fail,
the tabs can be moved from the cockpit so that they act as control tabs to
produce aerodynamic forces that move the elevators.
A feel computer is incorporated in the elevator system. It senses airspeed,
which gives the pilot a progressive restraint on the control column, and
indicates the amount of control forces being used.
Pitch trim is provided by varying the angle of incidence of the horizontal
stabilizer with a jackscrew that can be actuated electrically or manually.
Yaw Control
The Boeing 727 has two separate, independent rudders. The upper rudder
power unit is supplied from B system and the lower rudder is operated from
A system, or from the standby system. Both rudders have antibalance tabs.
Wing Flaps
The two triple-slotted Fowler flaps on each wing's trailing edge are operated
by torque tubes and jackscrews which are powered by separate hydraulic
motors for the inboard and outboard flaps. The hydraulic motors are supplied
by A system. When the outboard flaps extend 2° the leading edge flaps and
slats extend.
In the event of loss of all hydraulic pressure, the flaps may be operated by
electric motors which drive the torque tubes, while the hydraulic fluid
circulates in the hydraulic motors without causing opposition.
1. The aileron that moves upward travels a _ __ _ __ __ (greater or lesser) distance than the aileron
that moves downward. Page 269
2. Large transport aircraft have two ailerons on each wing. For high-speed flight the _ _ _ _ _ __
(inner or outer) aileron is locked in place and does not move. Page 270
3. When the ailerons of a large transport airplane are deflected, the flight spoilers on the wing with the
_ _ _ _ _ (up or down) aileron extend automatically. Page 270
4. Flight spoilers may be extended the same amount on each wing to act as _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
Page 270
5. Delta-wing airplanes have movable control surfaces on the trailing edge of the wings that act as both
elevators and ailerons. These smfaces are called . Page 271
7. In a conventional airplane using a horizontal stabilator and elevators mounted on the tail, the normal
aerodynamic force acts (upward or downward). Page 271
8. A canard surface has an angle of incidence that causes it to stall _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (before or after) the
main wing stalls. Page 273
9. The type of wing flap that produces the greatest amount of increase in lift with the minimum change in
drag is the flap. Page 275
10. A leading edge flap _________ (increases or decreases) the camber of a wing. Page 275
11. Slats extend from the leading edge of the wing to _ _____ (increase or decrease) the wing camber.
Page 277
12. A trim tab (does or does not) move relative to the control surface on which it is
installed as the surface is moved in flight. Page 278
13. A balance tab moves in the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (same or opposite) direction as the control surface on
which it is mounted. Page 278
14. The type of tab that is controlled from the cockpit to produce an aerodynamic force that moves the
primary control smface is called a/an tab. Page 279
15. A servo tab moves in the _ _ __ _ _ _ _ (same or opposite) direction as the control surface on
which it is mounted. Page 279
16. A spring tab automatically deflects when the control forces are _ __ _ _ _ (high or low). Page 279
17. An antiservo tab moves in the _ _ _ _ _ _ (same or opposite) direction as the control surface on
which it is mounted. Page 279
18. Adjusting the leading edge of a movable stabilizer upward gives the airplane a nose-_ _ _ __ _
(up or down) trim. Page 280
19. An elevator downspring is effective in slow flight when the CG position is at or beyond its
_ _ _ _ _ (forward or aft) limit. Page 281
Continued
20. The strength of a swaged cable terminal is ______ percent of the cable strength. Page 282
21. The smallest size cable that can be used in a primary control system is inch diameter.
Page 282
22. The strength of a Nicopress thimble-eye cable terminal is percent of the cable strength.
Page 282
23. A fairlead should not deflect a control cable more than _____ degrees. Page 282
24. To determine that a rod-end bearing is properly installed on a push-pull rod, the threads of the rod end
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ (should or should not) cover the inspection hole. Page 284
25. When installing an antifriction rod-end bearing, the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (open or closed) side of the bearing
should be against the device being actuated. Page 284
26. A tube that is used to apply a torsional force to a control surface is called a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ tube.
Page 284
27. The Boeing 727 airplane uses _ _ _ __ _ _ _ (electrical or hydraulic) actuators to move the
primary flight control surfaces. Page 285
Airplane Assembly
Airplane assembly, like almost all other aspects of aviation maintenance,
has grown in complexity as airplanes become more efficient and complex.
No step-by-step assembly procedure can be described that would apply to
all airplanes or all situations, but several pointers do apply in most instances.
Aileron
Flap
!/
Figure 4-35. Major strucmral subassemblies of a typical light aii1Jiane
0
0
0
0
0
A low-wing airplane uses several bolts on both sides A high-wing airplane attaches the front-wing spar to the center section
of top and bottom flanges of the front spar. with high-strength dowel pins held in place by bolts and nuts.
Figure 4-38. The angle of incidence of some ca~1tilever airplanes is adjusted by rotating
wash in. A twist in an airplane wing
eccentric bushings in the rear winf? sparfittinf?.
that increases its angle o f incidence
near the tip.
dence, increasing the lift and the induced drag on that wing. This typically
decreases the airspeed slightly. Lengthening the rear strut decreases the angle wing heavy. An out-of-t rim fl ight
of incidence and washes the wing out. If very much conection is needed, condition in which an ai rplane fli es hand s
one wing is washed in and the opposite wing is washed out. o ff, with one wing low.
Symmetry Check
The manufacturer's maintenance manual lists the points to be measured on a
symmetry check. These usually include measuring from a point near the tip
vertical fin. The fi xed vertical surface in of the vertical fin to a point near the tip of both sides of the horizontal stabi-
the empennage of an airplane. The vertical lizer, and from the point on the vertical fin to points on each wing near the
f]n acts as a weathervane to give the tip. Another measurement is made from the point near each wing tip to a
airplane directional stabi lity .
point on the nose of the fuselage. All of the measurements on the right and
left sides should be the same within the tolerances allowed by the manufac-
turer. Any difference in these measurements is an indication of structural
deformation. A careful investigation must be made to find the reason for the
difference and appropriate action taken to correct the problem.
When all the surfaces are balanced within the tolerances allowed by the
manufacturer, they are ready for installation and rigging. Install the surface
according to the directions in the appropriate maintenance manual and use
only the hardware specified in the illustrated parts list.
3/16 7 X 19 160
If)
5/32 7 X 19 1- 140 "0
120
c:
1/8 7 X 19 ...... ::l
0
3/32 7x7 100 c..
......
1/16 7x7 ...... 80 ·=
"0
ell
60 0
...J
1-" 1- 40 Ol
c:
20 ·a,
Ol
0 a:
-65 -60 -50 -40 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 11 0 120 130 140 150 160
Temperature in Degrees Fahrenheit
Figure 4-42. A typical rigging load chart fo r aircraft steel control cables
Check the cable tension with a tensiometer like the one in Figure 4-43.
Release the trigger of the tensiometer and pass the cable between the anvils
and th~ riser. Then clamp the trigger against the housing, to cause the riser to
press against the cable. Push the pointer lock in to lock the pointer, and then
remove the tensiometer and read the indication. Use the chart furnished with
the tensiometer to convert the dial indication to the cable tension. The chart
in Figure 4-44 is similar to the chart furnished with the tensiometer.
To find the tensiometer indication that shows the cable is adjusted to 79
pounds, usc the chart in Figure 4-44 and interpolate. Seventy-nine pounds is
90% of the way between 70 and 80, so the tensiometer indication will be 90%
of the way between 50 and 57, or 56.
Install riser No. 1 in the tensiometer, and adjust the turnbuckles until the
tensiometer reads 56. The cable tension will then be 79 pounds, which is
correct for 100°F.
296 AVIATION M AINT ENANCE T ECH NIC IAN SERI ES Volume 1: AIR FRAME STRUCTURES
Checking Control Travel
The Type Certificate Data Sheets for the airplane specifies the travel for
each of the primary controls. Once you've adjusted the cable tension, you
are ready to check for the correct travel.
One type of tool you can use for this is the protractor shown in Figure
4-45 . Attach it to the upper surface of the ai leron with its rubber suction cup,
and with the aileron locked in its streamline position, rotate the circular dial
until zero is below the tip of the weighted pointer. Remove the rigging tool
from the control column and unlock the aileron. Move it to its full up posi-
tion and read the protractor to find the number of degrees the aileron has
traveled. Without changing the protractor, move the aileron to its full down
position and read the degrees of downward denection. Tf the travel is not
correct, follow the instructions in the maintenance manual to adjust it so that
it is within the tolerance allowed by the manufacturer.
A precision measuring instrument you can use for measuring control Figure 4-43. A tensiometer determines
surface denection is the universal propel ler protractor in Figure 4-46. This control cable tension by measuring the
instrument can measure deflection to a tenth of a degree and is primarily used force required to deflect the cable a
~pecijic amow11.
for measuring propeller pitch. Flight control travel is not usually measured to
the fraction of a degree. This instrument has a movable ring and a movable
disk with a spirit level in the center of the disk. To usc it, follow these steps:
I. Align the zeroes on the ring and the disk scales.
2. Place the bottom of the protractor on top of the ai leron.
3. Un lock the ring from the frame and rotate the ring until the bubble centers
in the spirit level.
4. Lock the ring to the frame and deflect the aileron fully up. Unlock the
disk from the ring and turn the disk adjuster until the bubble centers in the
spirit level.
5. Read the up denection on the disk scale against the zero mark on the ring.
See Figure 4-46 on the next page.
Use Riser No. 1 with 1/16, 3/32, and 1/8 inch cable Figure 4-44. Typical chart relating
Use Riser No. 2 with 5/32 and 3/16 inch cable control cable tension to a given
tensiometer reading
Tensiometer Indication Cable Tension
Cable Diameter (inch) {pounds)
1/ 16 3/32 1/8 5/32 3/ 16
12 16 21 12 20 30
19 23 29 17 26 40
25 30 36 22 32 50
31 36 43 26 37 60
36 42 50 30 42 70
41 48 57 34 47 80
46 54 63 38 52 90 Figure 4-45. This type of control surface
51 60 69 42 56 100 protractor is held on the surface 1rith its
46 60 110
50 64 120 rubber suction cup when measuring
comrol swface traFel.
0
Frame Corner spirit level on frame folded in
Double-wrap spiral
Double-wrap
Single-wrap spiral
Single-wrap
The size and type of safety wire for each cable size is shown in Figure 4-48.
·~
Cable :::~=:::;= : ==-===-=~~- :::":; ;~-
Type of Diameter Material
Diameter Wrap of Wire of Wire ,----·-- -- -- -- ---- _ l~~~!- =-~-=-===·=--=--==- = ~ -::
J- .
m<DI H =~=
3/32 Single 0.040 Brass
1/8 Single 0.040 Stainless Steel
1/8 Double 0.040 Brass
1/8 Single 0.057 (min) Brass
Figure 4-48. Turnbuckle safetying guide Figure 4-49. MS Clip-type locking device for turnbuckles.
Pedal
I
Piece of wood
(2 X 4) t
C-clamp
Figure 4-50. Rudder pedals may be held in place for rigging by clamping a piece of wood
across the pedals with C-clamps.
0
Hold the rudder centered by clamping straightedges on both sides, and
centering the rudder midway between them as shown in Figure 4-51. Adjust
the turnbuckles to get the recommended cable tension.
After adjusting the cable tension, remove the straightedges and the lock
from the rudder pedals, and check for full travel in both directions. Two
common ways of checking this travel are illustrated in Figure 4-52. You can
make a wire pointer of a welding rod taped to the aft end of the fuselage and
bending it until it touches the trailing edge of the rudder. Deflect the rudder
Block each way, and measure the distance between the pointer and the rudder
trailing edge. The manufacturer's service manual specifies the distance tol-
erance. for this type of measurement.
When the cable tension and the rudder travel are conect, check the entire
system for freedom of operation, and safety all of the nuts and turnbuckles.
Rudder _:...-,..._;..-++-
Wire pointer
A wire taped to aft end of fuselage can be A template made according to plans in
bent until it touches rudder trailing edge when aircraft maintenance manual can be held
rudder is locked in place. Deflect rudder and against vertical fin to measure amount of
measure distance between end of wire and rudder deflection.
rudder trailing edge.
When the control wheel is pushed in to rotate the airplane nose down about
its lateral axis, the trailing edge of the elevators should move down. When it
is pulled back to rotate the airplane nose up, the elevator trailing edge should
move up.
When the control wheel is rotated to the right to rotate the airplane to the
right about its longitudinal axis, the trai ling edge of the right aileron should
move upward and the trailing edge of the left aileron should move down.
Rotating the wheel to the left moves the controls in the opposite direction.
Moving the right rudder pedal forward deflects the trailing edge of the
rudder to the right, and moving the left pedal forward moves the rudder
trailing edge to the left.
Rotating the elevator trim tab to trim the airplane for nose-down flight
raises the trailing edge of the tab. This creates an aerodynamic load on the
elevator that moves it down and deflects the airplane nose down.
28. The method that should be used for leveling an aircraft for proper assembly and rigging may be found in
the for the aircraft. Page 292
29. The dihedral on a strut-braced airplane is adjusted by changing the length of the _______ (front
or rear) strut. Page 293
Continued
30. Twisting a wing in such a way that its angle of incidence at the tip is increased is called washing the
wmg (in or out). Page 293
3 1. A check to determine that the major components of an airplane are in their proper basic alignment is
called a/an check. Page 294
32. lf a bolt in the control system is subject to rotation, a self- locking nut _ _ _ _ _ __ _ _ (should or
should not) be used. Page 298
33. Use the rigging load chart in Figure 4-42 and find the proper rigging load for a Vs-inch 7 x 19 extra
flexible cable when the temperature is 85°F. The cable should be rigged to a tension of _ _ _ __
pounds. Page 296
34. Use the tensiometer chart of F ig ure 4-44. For a lis-inch 7 x 19 cable to have a tension of 73 pounds, the
tensiometer should read . Page 297
35. A turnbuckle in a control system must not come closer to a pulley or fairlead than _ ____ inch/es.
Page 298
36. To ensure that the turnbuckle ends have sufficient threads inside the barrel to develop their full strength,
no more than threads are allowed to be outside of a turnbuckle barrel. Page 298
37. When safetying a turnbuckle with safety wire, the safetying must terminate with at least _ _ _ __
turns of wire around the turnbuckle end. Page 299
38. When the control wheel is pulled back, the trailing edge of the elevators should move _ _ _ __
(up or down). Page 301
39. When the control wheel is moved forward, the trailing edge of the elevators should move
_ _ __ __ (up or down). Page 301·
40. When the control wheel is rotated to the right, the trailing edge of the right aileron should move
_ _ _ _ _ (up or down). Page 301
41. When the control wheel is rotated to the left, the trailing edge of the left aileron should move
_ _ _ __ (up or down). Page 301
43. When the elevator trim tab is adjusted for a nose-down condition, the trailing edge of the tab should move
_ _ _ _ _ (up or down). Page 301
Increase pitch
position for
vertical flight
! ----":..-_..
Stabilizer bar
does not move
Pitch
change arms
~t--~ Collective
pitch sleeve
Swashplate .
;::_mbly -
---"
- 1-':::..:
: ::..::
:··c:..:.
···::..:
··:..::
···::..:
··:.:.:
···:..::
···::..:
··:.:.:
···:..::
···::..:
··:..::
· · ·:..::
-··:.:.:
·-::. P_Ia_n_e_o_f~
' "--.__ _ _
rotation
Figure 4-55. Raising the collective pitch control raises the collective pitch sleeve which
causes the pitch of all of the rotor blades to increase at the same time.
Sideward flight
Figure 4-56. The collective pitch control fever has a twist-grip throttle control to allow the
pilot to trim the RPM to the exact value needed.
Cyclic control stick
moved sideways
The Cyclic Pitch Control
Forward flight
The cyclic pitch control operated by the pilot's right hand tilts the swash plate
to change the pitch of the rotor blades at a particular point in their rotation.
This pitch change tilts the plane o f rotation of the rotor disk. The lift always
acts along the bisector of the coning angle, and when the rotor disc is tilted the
lift develops a horizontal vector that moves the helicopter in the direction the
disc is tilted.
The cyclic control operates the two pitch arms on the swash plate. When Cyclic control stick
moved forward
the pilot moves the cyclic control forward, the swash plate tilts forward. See
Figure 4-58 on the next page. When the swash plate tilts forward , the pitch of
Figure 4-57. The fij1 produced by a
the advancing blade is decreased and.thc pitch of the retreating blade is
helicopter rotor always acts along the
increased. Because of gyroscopic precess ion, the effect of the pitch change bisector of the co11ing angle of the rotor
will be felt 90° after the point the pitch change is made, and the rotor disc will blades. This produces a horizo11taf vector
tilt forward. that moves the helicopter in The direction
rhe rotor is tilted.
''
''
" - - -- - -1 I
- - - ~ ~~? - - - :-~
1 \
Planes of
rotor
rotation
IForward>
Figure 4-58. When the cyclic control is moved.forward, the swashplate tills forward. This
decreases the pitch of advancing blade and increases the pitch of the retreating blade.
Because of gyroscopic precession, the rotor disc will tilt .forward.
Horizontal Stabilizers
The rotor disc must be tilted forward in order for a helicopter to Oy forwards .
This results in a nose-low attitude for the fu selage, which is an inefficient
flight attitude. To allow the fuselage to achieve a more level attitude in
forward tlight, most helicopters have some form of horizontal stabilizer
mounted near the rear of the fuselage. Some of these stabilizers are synchro-
nized with the cyclic control, so their downward force increases as the pilot
moves the cyclic stick forward to increase the forward airspeed. Other
helicopters have fixed stabilizers with a deeply cambered airfoil that produces
a large aerodynamic download.
Main rotor
downwash
Circulation
control
nozzles
Pitch
Pulley
Rotor blade
Plane of rotation
Swashplate
Swashplate assembly link assembly
outer ring (rotating) -~~:::;;;;;;~~:::;;;;;;:::;;;;;;~
I
Flap
cp hinge
Figure 4-65. A semirigid rotor all aches to the mast with a teetering hinge that allows it to
flap as a unit. Pitch change arms control each blade about its feather axis.
Axis of
rotation
Helicopter Powerplants
The lack of suitable powerplants slowed the development of the helicopter.
Some helicopters use reciprocating eng ines similar to those used in airplanes,
but the ideal powerplant is a turbine eng ine, and almost all modern helicopters
except the small trainers are turbine powered.
Reciprocating Engines
Some reciprocating engines are mounted with their crankshaft vertical, and
these engines must have dry sump lubrication systems which carry their oil
supply in tanks outside of the eng ine. The engines in some of the smaller
helicopters are mounted horizontally and drive the transmission through a
series of V belts.
A helicopter has two engine problems that are not shared with airplanes.
Helicopters have no propeller to act as a flywheel and to supply cooling air
to the cylinders. The engine is coupled through the transmission to the rotor,
and so must be operated with a higher idling speed than a comparable airplane
engine. The engine is cooled by belt-driven blowers that force air through the
engine cool ing fins.
The engine of a helicopter is controlled differently from the engine of an
airpl ane. The power output is controlled by a linkage to the collective pitch
control that supplies the fuel needed to maintain the desired engine and rotor
RPM. When the collective pitch is increased, the rotor loads the engine, and
additional fuel is supplied to bring the engine speed back up to the desired
RPM. The relationship between the indications of the tachometer and mani-
fold pressure gage gives the pilot an indication of the power the engine is
supplying to the rotor.
Turbine Engines
The requirement for relatively constant engine speed, small size, and light
weight makes the turbine engine ideal for helicopters. For this reason, almost
all helicopters except the small trainers are powered by turboshaft engines.
Turboshaft engines used in helicopters may be of either the direct-shaft
or the free-turbine type. Direct-shaft engines have a single rotating element
and are similar to turbojet engines except that they have additional turbine
stages. These extra turbine stages extract additional energy from the expand-
ing gases and use it to drive the rotor through the transmission. A free-turbine
engine has one or more turbine stages that drive an output shaft that is entirely
Transmission
The engine drives the rotor through a transmission that reduces the engine
output shaft speed to the much lower speed needed to drive the rotor. Some
transmissions are mounted directly on the engine and others are driven by a
splined shaft. The transmission on some of the smaller helicopters is driven
from the engine with a series of rubber V belts.
The tail rotor is usually driven from the transmission, so its speed is
directly proportional to the speed of the main rotor.
Clutch
Reciprocating engines and direct-shaft turbine engines must have some
form of clutch between the engine and the transmission to remove the load
of the rotor from the engine when the engine is being started. These clutches
are often automatic, so that they are disengaged when the engine is being
started, but as soon as the engine reaches a predetermined speed, they auto-
matically engage and couple the engine to the rotor. Helicopters normally
have a dual tachometer with one needle indicating the engine speed and the
other the rotor speed. When the clutch is only partially engaged, the needles
are split, but when it is fully engaged, the needles are superimposed and are
said to be "married."
Free-turbine engines do not need a clutch, as the engine is not connected
to the gas-generator portion of the engine and therefore does not place any
load on the starter.
Some of the smaller helicopters that drive the transmission through V
Freewheeling unit engaged, with engine belts use a manual belt tightener as a clutch. The belts are loosened for starting
driving rotor
the engine, and when the rotors are to be engaged, the belt tightener is engaged
by the pilot and the transmission is gradually connected to the engine.
Freewheeling Unit
All hel-icopters must have some means of disconnecting the engine from the
rotor in case of engine failure. These units are always automatically operated
and are often of the sprag type seen in Figure 4-66.
When the engine is driving the rotor, the rollers bind between the sprocket
and the cam, and the sprocket drives the cam. Any time the engine slows and
the drive sprocket speed drops below that of the output shaft, the cam allows
the rollers to move back away from the sprocket and disengage the rotor from
the engine. As part of the pretakeoff check, the throttle is rolled back enough
Freewheeling unit disengaged, in for the engine speed to drop below the rotor speed. This allows the pilot to
autorotation position determine that the rotor disengages. When the throttle is opened, the engine
speed increases and the freewheeling unit re-engages.
Figure 4-66. Sprag-t)pefreewheefing unit
Figure 4-68. Checking helicopter rotor blade track with a strobe light
rate track and balance calculations, and it eliminates the need for costly fli ght
tests to determine whether or not the adjustments were correct.
Complete vibration information on the specific helicopter or airplane is
stored in a personal computer (PC), and when a vibration check is to be made,
thi s information is downloaded to a disc which is inserted into the balancer/
analyzer and is taken to the aircraft. Here it shows where to install sensors,
connect cables, and the correct location for the balancing weights.
45. The twist-grip throttle control is mounted on the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (collective or cyclic) pitch
control. Page 305
46. When the cyc lic control is moved backward, the pitch of the advancing blade is _ __ _ _ _ __ _
(increased or decreased). Page 305
47. The direction a helicopter moves in flight is determined by the direction the ts
tilted. Page 305
48. The main rotor of most single-rotor helicopters rotates to the (right or left) as viewed
from above. Page 308
50. To compensate for drift caused by thrust of the tail rotor, the main rotor mast is offset a few degrees to
the (right or left).. Page 308
5 1. The horizontal stabilizer on a helicopter is designed to hold the fuselage relatively level in
_ _ _ ___ (high or low) speed flight. Page 306
52. W hen the pitch of the advancing blade is increased, the helicopter will rotate nose _ _ _ _ _ (up or
down). Page 305
53. A nother name for the drag hinge in a helicopter rotor is the _ _ __ _ _ _ _ hinge. Page 310
Continued
54. The blades of a rigid rotor are allowed to rotate about their _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (flap, drag, or feather)
axis. Page 311
55. Fully articulated rotor blades typically have _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ (two or more than two) blades.
Page 310
56. Cooling air for a helicopter reciprocating engine is normally provided by an engine-driven
_ _ _ _ _ _ . Page3JJ
57. A helicopter with a free-turbine engine _ _ _ _ _ __ _ (does or does not) require a clutch between
the engine and the transmission. Page 312
58. A helicopter with a free-turbine engine _ _ _ _ _ _ (does or does not) require a freewheeling system
between the rotor and the transmi ssion. Page 312
59. Low frequency vibrations in a helicopter are normally related to the _ __ _ __ ___ . Page 313
60. A 1: 1 vertical vibration is usually caused by a main rotor blade being out of _ _ _ _ _ _ (balance
or track). Page 3 I 3
61. A I: 1 lateral vibration is usually caused by a main rotor blade being out of _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (balance
or track). Page 313
62. A strobe light check of blade track _ __ _ __ (can or cannot) be made in flight. Page 313
Continued
-t Here, we will review some of the terms and the principles of basic physics
used in this study. There is a comprehensive discussion of Basic Physics in
w Rectangle the Aviation Maintenance Technician Series, General textbook.
j_ Area
L---
1• --L-~•1 Area is measured in square inches or square feet in the English system, and
A= L·W in square centimeters and square meters in the metric system.
To find the area of a plane rectangular surface, multiply the surface's
IB
length by its width.
Area= Length· Width
Find the area of a square by squaring the length of one of its sides.
Area= Side2
1-- s- 1 The area of a plane triangular figure is exactly one half of the area of a
rectangle whose sides are the same length as the base and the altitude of the
triangle.
l~
Area= (Base · Altitude)+ 2
In most hydraulic and pneumatic actuators, the fluid acts on a piston that has
a circular head. To find the area of a circle, use the formula:
Area = R2
r- s - 1 1t
1t ·
3.1416
R = radius of the piston head
A simpler formula uses the diameter of the piston rather than its radius:
Area 0.7854 x D 2
0.7854 = a constant (or, 1t + 4)
D = diameter of the piston head
The constant 0.7854 is near enough to% (75%) to allow you to quickly
estimate the area of a circle by squaring its diameter and taking three-
A= 1t. R2 or 0.7854 · 02 quarters of this value. To find the approximate area of a circle with a 10-inch
diameter, square its diameter (10 2 = 100) and multiply this by 0.75. The
Figure 5-1. Formulas for finding area
approximate area is 75 square inches. The actual area is 78.54 square inches.
324 A VIATION MAINTENANCE TECH NICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFRAME STRUCTU RES
-
Distance circle. A closed plane figure with every
point an equal distance from the center. A
Practical mechanics is concerned with movement. The distance an object is
circle has the greatest area for its circum-
moved enters into many computations. ference of any enclosed shape.
Distance is measured in inches or feet in the English system, and in
centimeters or meters in the metric system.
rectangle. A plane surface with four sides
Volume whose opposite sides are parallel and
whose angles are all right angles.
Many fluid power computatio ns find or use the amount of Ouid available or
the amount of fluid moved.
Fluid volume is measured in cubic units. The English system uses cubic
square. A four-sided plane figure whose
inches or cubic feet; the metric system uses cubic centimeters or cubic meters. sides arc all the same length, whose
Find the volume of a square or rectangular container by multiplying the opposite sides are parallel. and whose
length, width, and height of the container. angles arc all right angles.
T
For example. the relationship between
-r- the le ngth of the circumference of a circle
H and the length of its diameter is a constant,
H
j_ 3. 1416. Th is constant is called by the
Greek name of pi (rr).
1-- L
V=L·W·H V =0.7854 · 0 2. H V= t. D3
Rectangular solid Cyl inder Sphere
Figure 5-7. The pressure produced bv Figure S-8. When pressure is applied to a
liquid in an open container is cmtsed by liquid in a closed container, the pressure
the height of the liquid above the poi111 at rises to the same amount in all parts of the
which the pressure is measured. The container.
higher the liquid above the gage, the
greater the pressure.
J .oinch P=
10 PSI
Figure 5-9. Hydraulic cylinders produce a mechanical advanrage. The work done by the
small piston is exactly the same as that done by the large pistol/. A snwll force on the small
piston will produce a large force on the large piston, hut the small piston must travel
farrher than the large one.
Figure 5-9 is a simple hydraulic jack. The small piston has an area of 1
square inch, and the large piston has an area of I0 square inches. When a
force of 10 pounds is applied to the small piston, a pressure of 10 psi is built
up in the fluid. According to Pascal's law, this pressure is the same through-
out the system, and 10 pounds of force acts on each square inch of the large
piston. This pressure produces a force of 100 pounds on the large piston that
lifts the weight.
When the small piston moves down 1 inch, 1 cubic inch of fluid is forced
out of the small cylinder into the large cylinder. This fluid spreads out over
the entjre large piston and it raises it only 0. 1 inch. The small piston must
move down I0 inches to raise the large piston I inch.
The work done by the small piston is I0 inches times I 0 pounds, or I 00
inch-pounds. The work done by the large piston is also I00 inch-pounds
(1 inch x 100 pounds).
Hydraulic systems are quite efficient, and we do not usually consider
system losses in the study of practical hydraulic systems.
2 3
Figure 5-10. The total energy in the fluid flowing through this venturi tube remuins
constanr ar all poinrs.
UUUl
Figure 5-11. Thefi'iction encountered as
There are many similarities between the flow of electrons in an electrical
system and the flow of fluid in a fluid power system. One of these similarities
is the drop in pressure as the flow of fluid encounters an opposition. This is
the same as the drop in voltage caused by current flowing through a resistance.
Figure 5-11 shows the way the pressure drops along a tube through which
fluid is flowing. The pressure in the reservoir is shown by the height of the
fluid flows through a lUbe causes a liquid. The pressure decreases along the line leaving the reservoir as is indi-
pressure drop. cated by the height of the fluid in each of the vertical tubes. The friction
encountered by the fluid causes the pressure drop in the same way resistance
in an electrical system causes a pressure drop.
Differential The pressure drop in a moving fluid can be used in fluid control devices
pressure gage like hydraulic fuses. When fluid flowing through a tube encounters a
restrictor, pressure is dropped across it. The amount of this pressure drop is
proportional to the rate of flow of the lluid. In a hydraulic fuse, an excessive
rate of flow will cause enough pressure drop to shut off all flow.
2. A fluid power system that uses a compressible fluid is called a _________ (hydraulic or pneu-
matic) system. Page 323
3. A hydraulic piston that has a diameter of 3.0 inches has an area of ______ square inches. Page 324
4. A cylindrical hydraulic reservoir that has a diameter of 6.0 inches and a height of 8.0 inches has a volume
of cubic inches. Page 325
5. A spherical container whose diameter is 12 inches has a volume of _ ______ cubic inches.
Page 325
6. A 395-pound drum of oil is rolled 40 feet across the hangar floor. It requires a fo rce of 15 pounds to roll
the drum. The work done in ro lling this drum is foot-pounds. Page 326
7. The amount of power needed to raise a weight is increased when the time used to raise it is
_ _ _ __ _ __ (increased or decreased). Page 326
8. One horsepower is the equivalent of _ _ __ _ __ foot-pounds of work done in one minute. Page 326
9. One horsepower is the equivalent of _ _ _ _ __ foot-pounds of work done in one second. Page 326
Continued
11. A 700-pound engine is raised with a hoist for a distance of 5 feet in 30 seconds. This requires
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ horsepower. Page 326
12. One U.S. gallon is equal to _ _ ____ cubic inches. Page 326
13. A flow of 3 gallons per minute of hydraulic fluid under a pressure of 1,000 psi produces _ _ _ _ __
horsepower. Page 326
14. A 3,000-psi hydraulic system acts on a piston having an area of 2 square inches. The piston produces
_ _ __ _ _ pounds of force. Page 327
15. A force of 4,000 pounds is required by a I ,000-psi hydraulic system. This force will require a piston having
an area of square inches. Page 327
16. For a piston with an area of 2.0 square inch to produce a force of 500 pounds, a hydraulic hand pump must
furnish psi of pressure. Page 327
17. When a piston with an area of 3.0 square inches is moved 6.0 inches, _ _ _ _ _ cubic inches of fluid
will be moved. Page 327
18. For a piston with an area of 6.0 square inches to move 36 cubic inches of fluid, it must be moved
_ _ _ _ _ inches. Page 327
19. A piston must move 100 cubic inches of fluid when it is moved 5.0 inches. 1n order to do this, the piston
must have an area of square inches. Page 327
20. Kinetic energy in a fluid power system is in the form of the _ __ _ _ _ _ _ (pressure or velocity) of
the fluid. Page 33 I
21. Potential energy in a fluid power system is in the form of the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (pressure or velocity) of
the fluid. Page 331
22. The pressure o n the bottom of a reservoir caused by kerosine that has a level of 18 inches above the bottom
ts psi. Page 328
23. A hydraulic jack requires a force on the handle of 30 pounds to exert a force of 600 pounds on the object
being raised. The jack has a mechanical advantage of . Page 330
334 AVI ATION MAINTENANCE TECHNICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFR A MF; STRUCTURES
-
24. According to Bernoulli's principle, when the total energy in a column of moving fluid remains constant, an
increase in the velocity of the fluid results in a corresponding (increase or decrease)
in the pressure. Page 331
25. The pressure drop caused by an obstruction in a line canying a flow of fluid is directly proportional to the
_ _ _ _ _ _ (rate or volume) of flow. Page 332
Brake lining
Brake reservoir
Master
cylinder
Figure 5-14. A re~ervoir-type master cylinder vents the lines and wheel cylinders to the
atmosphere through the compensator port to prevent heat expansion ofthejluidfrom
causing the brakes to drag. It also replenishes fluid lost in the system.
Figure 5-15. A selec1or valve allowsjluidji·omlhe ht111d pump logo to 1he actuator
cylinder, or 10 return ji-om the actuator to the reservoir.
-
338 AVIATION MAINTENANCE T ECH IClA~ SERIES Volume 1: AIRFRAME S TRUCTURES
-
Selector valve
Reservoir in gear down
position
~ Pump
on-line
Pump
off-line
Gear
down
Gear
up
Gear
locked
Engine-driven 1 Gear
pump y down
Figure 5-17. A manual pump control valve keeps the pump unloaded when no unit is actuated.
When some component in the system is actuated, the system pressure drops
r et urn manifold. T he portion of a fluid
power system through which the flu id is
to the unloading valve kick-in pressure, and the unloading valve shifts to shut
returned to the reservoir. off the flow to the reservoir and direct the pump output into the system
pressure manifold. The pump supplies all of the fluid needed forthe actuation.
A hand pump draws its fluid from the bottom of the reservoir, and may
kick-out pressure. The pressure at which be used to produce pressure or actuate the system when the engine is not
an unloading valve shuts off the fl ow of operating. If a leak in the system should allow all the fluid available to the
flu id into the system pressure manifold and engine-driven pump to be pumped overboard, the hand pump still has access
directs it back to the reservoir under a
to enough fluid below the standpipe in the reservoir to lower the landing gear
much reduced pressure.
and actuate the brakes. The system pressure relief valve in this system serves
the same function as that in the simpler system.
Figure 5-19. An open-center system requires 110 separate unloading valve, but returns fluid
to the reservoir through the open center of the selector valves when no unit is actuated.
26. The master cylinder in a simple brake system is a _ _ _ __ _ _ (single or double)-action pump.
Page 336
27. In a reservoir-type brake system, the brake line and wheel cylinders are vented to the atmosphere through
the port in the master cylinder. Page 336
Continued
28. Fluid is returned from a single-acting actuator by the action of a _ _ __ _ _ _ pushing on the piston.
Page 336
29. Hydraulic Ouid from the return side of a double-acting actuator returns to the reservoir through the
___________________ .Page337
30. An engine-driven hydraulic pump that moves a specific amount of fluid each time it rotates is called a
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ -displacement pump. Page 338
31. An engine-driven constant-displacement pump (does or does not) requ ire some type of
valve to unload the pump when no component in the system is actuated. Page 338
32. When lowering the landing gear in an airplane equipped with a hydraulic system using a manual pump
control valve, the gear selector valve is placed in the DOWN position (before or after)
the pump control valve is closed. Page 338
33. The hydraulic pump is unloaded when the manual pump control valve is _ _______ (opened or
closed). Page 339
34. A power control valve is similar to a pump control valve. Both are turned ON manually , but the power
control valve opens, or turns OFF, (automatically or manually). Page 339
35. A valve that prevents pressure rising to a dangerous level in a hydraulic system is called a/an
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ valve. Page 338
37. When an automatic unloading valve is used in a hydrau lic system, the pressure is held on the system when
the pump is unloaded by a/an . Page 339
38. The selector valves in an open-center hydraulic system are arranged in _ _______ (series or
parallel). Page 340
39. An open-center hydraulic system _ _ __ _ _ _ _ (does or does not) need a pump unloading valve.
Page 341
Hydraulic Fluids
Aircraft reciprocating engines use hydraulic valve lifters to open the intake
and exhaust valves, and these lifters use engine lubricating oil as their fluid.
Turbine eng ines are often equipped with variable inlet guide vanes and
compressor bleed valves that are moved by hydraulic actuators that use fuel
as the fluid. A pneumatic system uses air as its fluid. Almost any fluid, either
liquid or gaseous, can be used to transmit a force, but in an aircraft hydraulic
system, more requirements must be met thanjustthose oftransmitti ng a force.
Fluid that is used in an aircraft hydraulic system must be as incompress-
ible as practical, and it must have a low viscosity so it will flow through the
lines with a minimum of friction. lt must be chemically stable, have good
lubricating properties so the pump and system compo nents will not wear
excessively, and it must not foam in operation. It must be compatible with the
metal in the components and with the elastic materials of which the seals are
made, and it must have a high flash point and a high fire point.
The technical bulletins furnished by the fluid manufacturer provides
information about the compatibility of the hydraulic fluids with the various
aircraft materials.
Hydraulic systems operate with high pressures, and the components used in
Tetlon. The registered trade name for a
these systems have such close fitting parts that any contamination in the fluid
fl uorocarbon resin used to make hydraulic
will cause the components to fail. and pneumatic seals, hoses, and backup
When servici ng a hydraulic system, be sure to use only the correct fluid. ri ngs.
The service manual for the aircraft specifies the type of fluid, and the reservoir
should have the required type of fluid plainly marked with a placard near the
fi ller opening.
Use the patch test to determine whether or not hydraulic fluid is contami-
nated. Pass a measured volume of fluid through a special patch-type filter in
a test kit. After all of the nuid has passed through, analyze the filter and
observe the type and amo unt of contaminants. The instructions that accom-
pany the test kit explain the procedures used to evaluate the test patch.
To give an idea of the importance of using perfectly clean and uncontami-
nated nuid, Figure 5-20 on the next page shows a comparison of contaminant
size. One micron is one millionth of a meter, or approximately 0.000039 inch. micron. One millionth of a meter. The
(One inch is equal to 25,400 microns.) The unaided human eye can see con- micron is a unit of measurement that is
taminants as small as 40 microns, and modern hydraulic filters can filter out often used to measure the effectiveness of
a hydraulic fi lter.
contaminants larger than 3 microns. T his high degree of filtration is important
because some of the clearances in new hydraulic components are as small as
2 microns (0.000 080 inch).
=1 millionth of a meter
~
- Largest particle passed by 1 micron
modern micronic filter (1 meter X 1o-6)
1 micron =39 millionths of an inch
1 inch = 25,400 microns
;;:;;:j-
---- I
~ /r Approx. clearance for sliders
In control valves
41 . Hydraulic systems using vegetable-base fluid can be flushed out with ________ . Page 343
42. Hydraulic systems using vegetable-base fluid have seals made of _ _ _ _ _ _ __ rubber. Page 343
43. Mineral-base hydraulic fluid is dyed ______ for identification. Page 344
45. Hydraulic systems using mineral-base fluid have seals made of _ _ __ _ _ _ _ . Page 344
46. Mineral-base hydraulic Ouid can be removed from an aircraft tire by washing the tire with
___________________ . Page344
47. A popular synthetic hydraulic fluid with a phosphate ester base is popularly known as _ _ _ _ __ _
Page 344
48. Skydrol SOOB-4 Ouid is dyed _ __ _ _ _____ for identification. Page 344
49. Hydraulic systems using phosphate ester-base fluid can be flushed out with _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _
Page 345
SO. Hydraulic systems us ing phosphate ester-base fluid have seals made of _ _ _ _ ___ . Page 345
5 1. Skydrol hydraulic fluid that has been spilled on aircraft tires should be removed with
___________________ . Page345
Hydraulic Reservoirs
The reservoir is the component that stores the fluid and serves as an expan-
sion chamber to provide a space for the fluid when its volume increases
because of temperature. The reservoir also serves as a point at which the
fluid can purge itself of any air it accumulates in its operational cycle.
Reservoirs must have enough capacity to hold all of the fluid that can
be returned to the system with any configuration of the landing gear , flaps,
and all other hydraulically actuated units. It is important when servicing a
reservoir to decrease the system pressure to zero, as this will return the maxi-
mum amount of fluid to the reservoir_. If the reservoir is filled when the
accumul ator is charged with fluid, it will be overfull when the accumulator
is discharged.
Nonpressurized Reservoirs
Airplanes that fly at relatively low altitudes are usually equipped with
non pressurized reservoirs such as the one in Figure 5-2 1 on the next page. The
fluid-return fitting in the reservoir is usually directed in such a way as to
minimize foaming, and any air that is in the flu id will be swirled out, o r
extracted. Some reservoirs have filters built into their retu rn line to filter all
of the fluid that is returned from the system.
Pressurized Reservoirs
When airplanes fly at high altitudes, where the outside air pressure is low,
there is not enough air pressure to force the hydraulic fluid from the reservoir
into the inlet of the pump, so the pump tends to cavitate. Also, the hydraulic
Outlet to Outlet to
emergency engine-driven
fluid that is returned to the reservoir develops a tendency to foam at high
hand pump pump altitudes. To prevent pump cavitation and foaming of the return fluid,
reservoirs in high-flying aircraft are pressurized. It is important to relieve the
Figure 5-21- A rwical nonpressurized pressure in the reservoir before opening it for servicing.
hydraulic reservoir One method of pressurizing a reservoir is to inject air into the returning
fluid through an aspirator, or venturi tee fitting as shown in Figure 5-22. The
flu id flowing back into the reservoir passes through the venturi, where it
System return line
creates a low pressure and draws air from outside the reservoir into the venturi
throat. The hydraulic fluid with air in it is swirled as it enters the top of the
reservoir, and the air is expelled from the fluid. A relief valve in the reservoir
maintains an air pressure of about 12 psi on the fluid.
Some turbine-engine-powered aircraft use a small amount of filtered
Reservoir compressor bleed air to pressurize the reservoir. These systems have an ai r
ai r pressure pressure regulator between the engine and the reservoir to reduce the pressure
relief valve
to the proper value.
Reservoir
Pressurized fluid
to pump inlet
Fluid
i reservoir
(30psi)
t
Vent Figure 5-23. The principle of a pressur-
ized hydraulic reservoir, using hydraulic
System pressure
(3,000 psi) system pressure
52. Fluid taken from the standpipe in a hydraulic reservoir goes to the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(engine-driven pump or emergency hand pump). Page 348
53. A hydraulic unit that contains the· reservoir, pump, and all of the valves is called a/an
_ _ _ __ __ _ .Page 348
54. Some hydraulic reservoirs are pressurized to prevent the pump _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 348
Hand Pumps
single-acting h a nd pum p. A hand- Single-acting hand pumps move fluid only on one stroke of the piston, while
operated flui d pump that moves fl uid only
double-acting pumps move fluid with both strokes. Double-acting pumps are
during one stroke of the pump handle. One
stroke pulls the fl uid into the pump and the
commonly used in aircraft hydraulic systems because of their greater effi-
other forces the fl uid out. ciency. Figure 5-24 shows a diagram of a piston-rod displacement, double-
acting hydraulic hand pump.
d ouble-acting ha nd pump. A hand-
On the stroke of the handle that pulls the piston outward, fluid is drawn
operated fluid pump that moves fluid into the pump through the inlet check valve. The outlet check valve inside the
during both strokes of the pump handle. piston is seated, and the fluid on the back side of the piston is forced out of the
pump outlet.
On the return stroke of the pump handle, the piston is forced into the
cylinder. The pump inlet check valve seats, and the outlet check valve opens,
allowing fluid to flow into the chamber that has the piston rod. The piston rod
causes the volume of this side of the pump to be less than the volume of the
fluid that was taken in, and approximately one half of the fluid that has just
been taken into the pump is forced out the pump outlet.
To better understand the way this pump works, assume some values. The
large end ofthe piston has an area of two square inches. The area of the piston
rod is one square inch. The piston moves one inch each time the handle is
moved through its full travel.
When the piston moves all the way to the left, two cubic inches of fluid
are pulled into the cylinder through the inlet check valve, and the check valve
closes. Now, when the piston is moved all of the way to the right, this two
cubic inches of fluid passes through the outlet check valve. The volume of the
chamb.er on the left side ofthe piston is only one cubic inch because the piston
rod takes up the other cubic inch. Therefore one cubic inch of fluid leaves the
pump through the outlet port, and the other cubic inch of fluid remains in the
chamber on the left side of the piston. Each time the piston moves to the right,
one cubic inch of fluid leaves the pump and no fluid is taken in. Each time the
piston moves to the left, two cubic inches of fluid is taken into the pump and
one cubic inch of fluid leaves the pump.
Hand pumps are simple devices and give little trouble, but their simplic-
ity does not prevent some problems. For example, if the handle of a rebuilt
hand pump cannot be moved in the normal pumping direction, there is a
good probability that the outlet check valve is stuck closed or inconectly
Piston is moved to the left, pulling 2 cubic inches of fluid into inlet port and forcing 1 cubic inch
of fluid out the outlet port.
Piston movement )
Piston is moved to the right, taking in no fluid and forcing 1 cubic inch of fluid out the outlet port.
Power Pumps
Power pumps are classified as either constant-displacement or variable- shear section. A necked-down secti on of
displacement. A constant-displacement pump moves a specific amount of the drive shaft of a constant-displacement
hydraulic pump. I f the pump should seize.
fluid each time it rotates. A pump of this type must have some sort of relief
the shear section will break and prevent
valve or unloading device to prevent its building up so much pressure that it the pump bei ng destroyed.
will rupture a I ine or perhaps damage itself. The drive shaft of almost all power Some pum ps use a shear pin rather than
pumps has a necked-down portion, called a shear section, that will break if the a shear sect ion.
pressure-relief device fails. When this breaks, the pump will no longer
operate, but the system will not be damaged.
Vane-Type Pumps
Spacer
The vane pump is one of the simpler types of constant-displacement pumps
used to move a large volume of fluid with a pressure of up to about 300 psi.
See Figure 5-25.
Sleeve The four steel vanes are free-floating in slots cut in the rotor. They are held
Vanes against the wall of the steel sleeve by a steel pin spacer. As the rotor turns in
Rotor-¥+---'\\:-V>'II the direction shown by the arrow, the volume between the vanes on the in let
side of the pump increases, and the volume between the vanes on the
/ discharge side of the pump decreases. This change of volume pulls fluid into
the pump through the inlet port and forces it out through the discharge port.
I Vane-type pumps are used in some aircraft hydraulic systems, but they
Inlet port Outlet port are more often used as fuel pumps and as air pumps to supply air for
Figure 5-25. A vane-type pump moves a
gyroscopic instruments and pneumatic deicer boots.
relatively large volume offluid under a
low pressure. Gear-Type Pumps
Gear-type pumps move a medium volume of fluid under a pressure of
between 300 and 1,500 psi. Two types of gear pumps are used in aircraft
hydraulic systems, the simple spur-gear pump and the gerotor pump.
The spur-gear pump illustrated in Figure 5-26 uses two meshing external-
tooth gears that fit closely into a figure-eight-shaped housing. One of the gears
is driven by an engine accessory drive, and this gear drives the other one. As
gear-ty pe pump. A constant-displacement the gears rotate in the direction shown by the arrows, the space between the
fluid pump that contains two meshing
teeth o_n the inlet side of the pump becomes larger. Fluid is pulled into this
large-tooth spur gears. Fl uid is drawn into
the pump as the teeth separate and is space, trapped between the teeth and the housing, and carried around to the
carried around the inside of the housing discharge side of the pump. Here the teeth of the two gears come into mesh
with the teeth and is forced from the pump and decrease the volume. As the volume is decreased, fl uid is forced from the
w hen the teeth come together. pump outlet.
Pump outlet
pressure
relief valve
Pump inlet
Gerotor Pumps
Cover plate A gerotor pump, illustrated in Figure 5-27, is a combination internal and
external gear pump.
The four-tooth spur gear is driven by an engine accessory drive, and as it
turns, it rotates a five-tooth internal-gear rotor. As the gear and the rotor turn
in the direction shown by the anows, the space between the teeth gets larger
on one side and smaller on the other. A plate with two crescent-shaped open-
ings covers the gear and the rotor and forms the inlet and the outlet ports of
the pump.
The opening located above the space that gets larger as the gear and the
rotor turn is the inlet side of the pump, and the opening above the space that
gets smaller as the teeth come into mesh is the outlet of the pump.
Piston Pumps
Inlet port Outlet port
Aircraft hydraulic systems that require a relatively small volume of fl uid
under a pressure of 2,500 psi or more often use fixed-angle, multiple-piston
Liner External spur- pumps, such as the one in Figure 5-28.
type drive gear
There are usually seven or nine axially-drilled holes in the rotating
cylinder block of this type of pump, and each hole contains a close-fitting
piston attached to a drive plate by a ball-jointed rod. The cylinder block and
the pistons are rotated as a unit by a shaft that is driven from an engine
accessory drive.
The housing is angled so that the pistons on one side of the cylinder block
are at the bottom of their stroke while the pistons on the other side of the block
are at the top of their stroke. As the pump rotates one half of a turn, half of the
pistons move from the top of their stroke to the bottom, and the pistons on the
other side of the block move from the bollom of their stroke to the top.
A valve plate that has two crescent-shaped openings covers the ends of
Internal-tooth driven rotor
the cytinders. The pump outlet port is above the pistons that are moving up,
and the inlet port is above the pistons that are moving down.
Figure 5-27. A gerotur pump uses an As the pistons move down in the cylinder block, they pull fluid into the
external spur-type drive gear inside m1 pump, and as they move up, they force this fluid out of the pump into the
internal-tooth driven gear. system.
Variable-Displacement Pumps
An unloading valve of some sort must be used with a constant-displacement
pump, but the same force used to control the unloading valve may be used to
control the output of a variable-displacement pump, so there is no need for a
separate control.
Inlet port
- Rotating elements
[;§] Oscillating elements
r:z:z] Control system
Input fluid
Output fluid Piston Relief Bypass hole
- Bypass fluid for cooling hole
compressing the compensator spring. The spider that moves the sleeves over
the outside of the pistons is attached to the stem to vary the effective length
of the piston stroke.
When the system pressure is low, as it is in Figure 5-30, the compensator
spring forces the spider to move the sleeves to the left, or down on the pistons.
The sleeves keep the rei ief holes covered for the full stroke of the piston, and
the pistons move fluid out through the check valves into the pump discharge
line during their entire stroke.
When the system pressure is high, as it is in Figure 5-31, it acts on the
compensator-stem piston and compresses the compensator spring. This pulls
the sleeves to the right, or up on the pistons so the relief holes are uncovered
during most of their stroke. The pistons move through their full stroke, but
since the fluid passes out the relief holes, no fluid is forced from the pump.
Any time the system pressure is at an intermediate value, the sleeves
close the relief holes at some point along the stroke of the piston. ln this
way, just enough fluid is pumped to maintain the system pressure at the
level for which the compensator spring is set.
Pump Pump
inlet Sleeve discharge
56. A hydraulic hand pump that moves some fluid every time the pump handle is moved is called a
_ _ _ _ __ _ -acting pump. Page 350
57. A piston-rod displacement hand pump is a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (single or double)-acting pump. Page 350
58. If the handle of a rebuilt hydraulic hand pump cannot be moved in the direction of normal pumping, the
probable cause is an improperly installed (inlet or outlet) check valve. Page 350
59. A pressure regulator, or unloading valve: must be used with a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (constant or variable)-
displacement hydraulic pump. Page 35/
60. An engine-driven hydraulic pump is prevented from building up damagingly high pressure if the pressure
regulator and relief valve fail by alan in the drive shaft. Page 351
61. A vane-type engine-driven fluid pump is usually used for applications that must move a _ _ _ _ _ __
(large or small) volume of fluid. Page 352
62. Hydraulic fluid flowing through a spur-gear-type pump moves _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (between or around)
the gears. Page 352
64. An air leak in the inlet line to an engine-driven hydraulic pump will cause the pump to _ _ __ _ __ _
and . Page 354
65. A piston-type engine-driven fluid pump is usually used for applications that require a _ _ _ __ _
(high or low) pressure. Page 354
67. A Stratopower variable-displacement hydraulic pump varies the discharge flow by altering the
_ _ _ _ _ __ _ (actual or effective) stroke of the pistons. Page 355
68. The hydraulic fluid that fl ows through the heat exchanger in the fuel tank is fluid that flows from the
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ port o f the Stratopower variable-displacement pump. Page 357
Hydraulic Valves
Fluid power systems are much like electrical systems in that the object of the
system is to control a flow so it can perform work. In hydraulic systems there
are two types of valves, those that control flow and those that control pressure. Ball-type check valve
Full flow
{J~
Restricted flow
except the ball is replaced with a hollow cone. Fluid flows through the valve
from left to right, forcing the cone off of its seat and passing through the holes
in the surface of the cone. Reverse flow is prevented by the fluid and the spring
Figure 5-34. An orifice check valve allows holding the cone tight in its seat.
full flow offluid in one direction but a Large volumes of low-pressure fluid are often controlled by a flapper, or
restricted flow in the opposite direction.
swing-type, check valve. Fluid flows through this valve from left to right,
forcing the flapper off of its seat. Fluid flow in the reverse direction is
prevented by the spring and the fluid hold the flapper tight against its seat.
Selector Valves
One common type of flow control valve is the selector valve, which controls
the direction of flow of the fluid used to actuate some hydraulic component.
Two types of selector valves are open-center valves and closed-center
valves. An open-center valve directs fluid through the center of the valve back
Figure 5-35. Installation of an orifice to the reservoir when no units are being actuated. A closed-center valve stops
check valve in a landing gear actuating
the flow or nuid when it is in its neutral position.
cvlinder to slow the fluid .flow during
lowering the gear but allmring full .flow
Both types of selector valves direct fluid under pressure to one side of the
for raising it. actuator, and vent the opposite side of the actuator to the reservoir.
360 AVI ATION MAINTENANCE T EC'HNICi i\N S ERIES Volume 1: AIRFRAME STRUCTURES
-
Plug-Type Closed-Center Selector Valve orifice check val ve. A component i n a
hydraulic or pneumatic system that allows
Systems that use a relatively low pressure for actuation may use a simple
unrc>tricted tlO\\ in one direction. and
plug-type selector valve such as the one in Figure 5-36. In one position of n:.,trictcd flO\\ in the opposite direction.
the selector handle, the pressure port and the side of the actuator that extends
the piston are connected. The side of the actuator that retracts the piston is
closed-center selector valve. A type of
connected to the return line. When the selector handle is rotated 90°, the tlo\\ -control val ve used to direct pressur-
actuator ports are reversed; the retract port is connected to the pressure line, i7cd fluid into one side of an actuator. and
and the extend port is connected to the return line. Some selector valves at the >ame time. direct the retum fluid
have a neutral position in which the actuator is isolated from both the pres- from the other side of the actuator to the
fl uid reservoir.
sure and return manifolds.
Closed-center se lector valves arc
connected in parallel between the pressure
Return manifold and the return manifold.
manifold
Selector valve
in the position
to retract open-center hydraulic system. A fluid
power system in wh ich the selector val ves
£.·.. ~the piston Pressure
arc arranged in series with each other.
Selector valve in position
~v to extend piston Fluid nows from the pump through the
center of the selector val ves. back into the
reservoir\\ hen no unit i s being actuated.
Pressure
manifold
Selector valve in position
to retract piston
Actuating piston
cylinder ~
Return
manifold
Actuating cylinder
C Valve in neutral position,
A Flow through valve to extend piston rod from cylinder all poppets are closed
L~:J~:-:5~rTo next
open-
Control center Figure 5-37. Poppet-type closed-center selector valve
handle valve
Return
Extend Retract
manifold
c=t~~=~
high, the air loads on the flaps will require more pressure than the overload
valve will al low. The valve shifts, holding the pressure in the flap actuator but
returning fluid from the overload valve back to the reservoir through port R,
the check valve, and the selector valve. As soon as the air load decreases to
an allowable level the overload valve allows fluid to now into the actuator to
continue lowering the flaps.
I Flaps
t down
Figure 5-43. 7he flap overload valve prevents the jlapsjiwn being lowered at too high an
airspeed. If the flaps are down and the airspeed increases to too high a value, the flaps will
raise automaricallv.
If the airspeed increases to such an extent that the air load on the flaps becomes
dangerously high when the flaps are down with the selector valve in the
NEUTRAL position, the pressure on the down side of the actuator will
increase and shift the overload valve so fluid flows through it from ports F to
R and through the check valve to the up ~ide of the actuator, allowing the flaps
to retract until the air load is no longer excessive.
Pressure
manifold
l
Gear
down
crosstlow valve. An automatic flow- Figure 5-44. A flow equalizer in the gear-down lines of a landing gear retraction system
control valve installed between the gear-up causes the two landing gears ro move at the same speed as they retract and extend.
and gear-down lines of the landing gear of
some large airplanes.
When the landing gear is released from When the landing gear handle is placed in the GEAR-DOWN position, flu id
its uplocks, its weight causes it to fa ll flows through the selector valve and the flow equalizer valve on its way to
faster than the hydraulic system can supply the gear-down side of the two main-gear actuator cylinders. The fluid di-
fl uid to the gear-clown side of the aclUation
vides inside the flow equalizer and flows through two internal passages that
cylinder. The crossflow valve opens and
directs fl uid from the gear-up side into the
are connected by a free-floatig metering piston. If the right gear binds slightly,
gear-down side. This al lows the gear to more fluid flows into the left actuator than to the right, and the metering
move clown with a smooth motion. piston moves over and restricts the flow to the left cylinder, forcing more
fluid to flow into the right cylinder, keeping the flow to the two cylinders the
same.
When the selector valve is moved to the GEAR-UP position, return fluid
Return Landing gear selector valve from the two actuators flows through the flow equalizer. The metering piston
manifold in GEAR-DOWN position
moves to whichever side is necessary to restrict the flow from the actuator that
,..-:=[:::::/,¢=:::"\ Uplock
actuator is moving fastest, and forces them to retract at the same speed.
Pressure
manifold Landing Gear Crossflow Valve
When a heavy landing gear is released from its uplocks, it pulls the actuator
piston out faster than fluid from the selector valve can fill the down-side of
the cylinder. A crossflow valve allows fluid to flow directly from the up-side
of the actuator to the down-side until the system fluid can catch up with the
Figure 5-45. When a heavy la11ding gear is deman'ds of the actuator. See Figure 5-45.
released from its uplocks, its weight causes When the landing gear selector is placed in the GEAR-DOWN position,
the pistoll to move faster tha11 fluid from fluid releases the uplock and the landing gear drops down. The weight of the
the selector valve call jillrhe gear-down gear pulls the piston out of the cylinder, and fluid from the up-side of the
side ofrhe cylinder. Fluid flows through
!he crossjlow valve and allows the gear to
actuator flows through the crossflow valve from port A, out through port C
fall with a smooth and even motion. directly to the down-side of the actuator. This allows the gear to fall smoothly
Hydraulic Fuses
Hydraulic systems on modern jet aircraft are extremely important, not only
for raising and lowering the landing gear, but also for operating boosted
control systems, thrust reversers, flaps, brakes, and many of the auxiliary
systems. Most aircraft have more than one independent hydraulic system,
and hydraulic fuses are used in these systems to block a line and shut off the
flow of fluid if a serious leak should develop.
There are two types of hydraulic fuses; one shuts off the flow after a
speci fie amount of fluid has flowed through it, and the other shuts off the flow
if the pressure drop across the fuse indicates a broken line.
Figure 5-46 shows a pressure-drop-type fuse. Fluid flows through the Piston
fuse from left to right. When the flow rate is within the normal operating
range, there is not enough pressure drop across the fuse to move the piston s s s ,,
over against the force of the spring, and fluid flows through the fuse to the
actuator. But if a line should break, the pressure at the break will be so low Outlet
that the piston will be forced to the right and will shut off the flow of fluid to
> $ j
the actuator.
The fuse has no effect on the return flow of fluid from the actuator in
normal action. The return fluid flowing through the fuse forces the piston to Flow of fluid though fuse for normal operation
the left and uncovers the ports so fluid can flow through the fuse with no
restriction.
The second type of fuse is shown in Figure 5-47 on the next page. This
fuse shuts off the flow of fluid any time a specific amount of fluid flows
through it, and prevents a loss of fluid even though the leak is not severe Outlet
enough to cause the large pressure drop required to operate the other type
of fuse.
In normal operation, (view A), fluid has forced the sleeve valve over to
An excessive pressure drop has occurred and
the right and fluid flows through the val-ve with a minimum of opposition. As piston has been forced to the right, shutting off
the fluid flows through the fuse, some of it flows through the metering orifice flow of fluid.
and pushes the piston to the right.
By the time a specified amount of fluid passes through the fuse, the Figure 5-46. Hydraulic fuse that
piston is forced all the way to the right, where it covers the ports and shuts operates 011 the principle of an excessil·e
pressure drop.
off the flow of fluid through the fuse (v iew B).
B The piston has moved over to block the ports, and no more fluid
can flow through the fuse.
Check valve
Outlet Inlet
Figure 5-47. Hydraulic fuse that shuts off the flow ofjluid after a specific amount offluid
flows through
When tluid flows through the fuse in the reverse direction, the sleeve valve
and the piston are both moved to the left and fluid can flow through the fuse
unrestricted (view C). See Figure 5-47.
Relief Valves
The simplest type of pressure control valve is the relief valve. In practical
systems, however, a relief valve is used primarily as a backup device to
prevent high pressure from damaging the system rather than as a pressure Ball
control device. When a relief valve relieves pressure, heat is generated and
power is lost.
The system pressure relief valve opens and relieves any pressure above
that which is maintained by the system pressure regulator. Only in the event
of a malfunction of the regulator will the relief valve be required to function. Pressure _ _.=;=t;;~=--4--..:.>
port
There are typically a number of pressure control valves in a hydraulic
system with a wide range of relief pressures. To adjust any of the relief valves,
F igure 5--'8. Typical two-parr pressure
you must temporarily adjust the pressure regulator to a pressure above that of relief 1•a/ve
the highest relief valve. Adjust the relief valve with the highest setting first,
and then adjust the other valves in descending order of their relief pressure.
When you have adjusted all of the relief valves, adjust the system pressure
regulator to its correct pressure.
69. A now control valve that allows full now in one direction but no flow in the opposite direction is called
a/an valve. Page 359
70. A fl ow control valve that allows a full now in one direction but a restricted flow in the opposite direction is
called alan . Page 360
7 1. A mechanically operated flow control valve that prevents fluid flowing to one unit before some other unit
has actuated completely is called a/an valve. Page 363
Continued
72. A pressure-operated flow control valve that prevents fluid flowing to one unit until another unit has
actuated and hydraulic pressure has built up to a value high enough to shift the valve is called a/an
_ __ _ _ _ _ _ valve. Page 364
73. A flap overload valve is placed in the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (flaps-up or flaps-down) line. Page 365
74. Heavy landing gears are assisted in falling smoothly and evenly from the wheel wells by allowing fluid to
flow from the up-side of the actuator to the down side through a valve. Page 366
76. Plug-type selector valves are used in ______ (high or low)-pressure fluid power systems. Page 361
77. One characteristic of a spool-type selector valve is that it requires a (large or small)
force to operate the control. Page 363
78. A flow equalizer valve installed in the landing gear gear-down line (does or does not)
equalize the flow for both extension and retraction of the landing gear. Page 366
79. A component that shuts off the flow of hydraulic nuid if a line should rupture is called a hydraulic
_ __ _ _ _ . Page 367
80. A pressure relief valve is usually used as a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (primary or backup) pressure regulating
valve. Page 369
81. A thermal relief valve is adjusted to relieve at a pressure _ _ _ __ _ _ (lower or higher) than that for
which the main system pressure relief valve is adjusted. Page 369
82. Another name for a system pressure regulator is alan _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _ valve. Page 370
83. When one subsystem requires a lower pressure than the normal system operating pressure, alan
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ valve is used. Page 371
69. A flow control valve that allows full flow in one d irection but no flow in the opposite direction is called
alan valve. Page 359
70. A flow control valve that allows a full flow in one direction but a restricted flow in the opposite direction is
called a/an . Page 360
7 1. A mechanically operated flow control valve that prevents fluid flowing to one unit before some other unit
has actuated completely is called alan valve. Page 363
Continued
Swivel nut
Figure 5-54. AN812 high-pressure Figure 5-55. AN6287-I high-pressure Figure 5-56. MS28889 high-pressure
air valve air valve air valve
84. In order to store an incompressible fl uid under pressure in a hydraulic system, a/an
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ must be used. Page 373
85. The initial pressure of compressed air or nitrogen used to preload in an accumulator is approximately
_ _ _ _ __ __ _ of the system pressure. Page 373
Continued
86. The air valve core used in an accumulator is identified as a high-pressure core by the letter _ _ _ __
embossed on the stem. Page 374
87. An accumulator fitted with an AN812 air valve _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (should or should not) be deflated
by depressing the valve stem. Page 374
88. When hydraulic fluid is pumped into an accumulator, the preload air pressure will _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(increase, decrease, or remain the same). Page 375
Hydraulic Filters
Hydraulic fluid must be kept clean. As many of the solid contaminants as
possible must be removed from the fluid. These contaminants can damage the
pumps, valves, and actuators in a hydraulic system.
sintered metal. A porous material made The filtering capability of a hydraulic filter is measured in microns. One
by fusing powdered metal under heat and micron is one millionth of a meter, or 39 millionths of an inch (0.000 039
pressure.
inch). The unaided human eye can see contaminants as small as 40 microns,
and an effective filter should be able to remove contaminants larger than 5
microns. See Figure 5-20 on Page 346.
Two basic types of filters are used in aircraft hydraulic systems: surface
Head~
10 0 filters and edge filters.
Surface filters trap the contaminants on the surface of the element, which
.::1 may be made of sintered metal or a specially treated cellulose material. These
filters usually have a bypass valve built into them that opens to allow the fluid
to bypass the element if it should become clogged. Wire mesh and some
Q sintered metal filter elements may be cleaned and reused, but others are
noncleanable and are discarded on a regular scheduled basis.
Some of the latest filter elements are known as 5-micron noncleanable
Element elements. These elements are made of a combination of organic and inorganic
fibers integrally bonded with epoxy resin and faced with metallic mesh on
both sides for protection and added mechanical strength. These elements
should never be cleaned, but are replaced on a regular maintenance schedule.
Another new type of 5-micron filtering element is made of layers of very
fine stainless steel fibers drawn into a random but controlled matrix. The
matrix is then processed by compressing it and bonding all of the wires at their
crossing points into a very thin layer. This type of filtering element is made
in both cleanable and noncleanable forms.
The filter assembly in Figure 5-57 is typical of modern system filters. The
filter head is installed in the hydraulic system either in the pressure side of the
Figure 5-57. External view of a hydraulic pump or in the return line to the reservoir. The filter bowl can be unscrewed
filter assem!J/y from the head to remove the filter element. When the bowl is removed, the
W+-'-...J.-f- Shutoff
diaphragm
89. An efficient hydraulic filter should be able to remove contaminants larger than _ _ _ _ _ microns.
Page 376
90. A red indicator button sticking up on the top of a hydraulic filter is an indication that the filter element is
______________ .Page377
91. If a hydraulic filter clogs, unfiltered fluid flows to the system through a ______________ valve in the
filter. Page 377
92. The degree of filtration of a Cuno filter is determined by the thickness of the _________________
(disks or separators). Page 377
Hydraulic Actuators
hydraulic actuator. The component in a The ultimate function of a hydraulic or pneumatic system is to convert the
hydrau lic sy~ tem that converts hydraulic pressure in the fluid into work. In order to do this, there must be some form
pressure into mechanical force. The two
of movement, and this movement takes place in the actuator. Linear and
main types o f' hydrau lic actuators arc linear
actuators (cylinders and pisto ns) and rotary
rotary actuators are the most widely used. This section of the text discusses
actuators (hydraulic motors). both types.
Linear Actuators
linear actuat or . A fluid power actuator Linear actuators are made up of a cylinder and a piston. Thecyl inder is usually
that uses a piston mo ving inside a cylinder attached to the aircraft structure, and the piston is connected to the component
to change pressure into linear. or straight-
that is being moved.
line, motio n.
If two linear actuating cylinders with pistons having the same cross-
sectional area but different lengths of stroke are connected to the same source
of hydraul ic pressure, they will exert equal amounts of force, and move at the
same rate of speed. But it will take them a different length of time to reach the
end of_their stroke. If the cylinders have different areas, but are connected to
the same source of pressure, they will produce different amounts of force.
The rate of movement of the piston in a linear actuator can be controlled
by restricting the fluid nowing into or out of the cylinder.
Figure 5-59 shows three basic types of linear actuators. A single-acting
actuator has a piston that is moved in one direction by hydraulic fluid, and is
returned by a spring. A double-acting actuator uses hydraulic fluid to move
the piston in both directions. An unbalanced, double-acting actuator has a
piston rod extending from only one side of the piston, and a double-acting
balanced actuator has piston rods extending from both sides of the piston.
378 Avi,\TIO'\ MAI'\H..\Ai'C'E TecHNICIAi' SERIES Volume 1: AI RI· RA~Ih S IRtX TLRES
-
Piston Return spring
Seal
I Fluid
port 1
Fluid
port 2
Fluid
port
©~02~~~~1]~~~__!,©
Double-acting balanced actuator
Single-acting actuator
Fluid
port 2
Fluid
port 1
Unbalanced actuators have more area on one side of the piston than on the
other because of the area that is taken up by the piston rod. As much force as
possible is needed to raise the landing gear, so the fluid pushes against the full
area of the piston. Not as much force is needed to lower the landing gear
because or the weight of the struts and wheels, so the fluid is directed into the
end of the actuator that has the piston rod. The fluid pushes on only the portion
or the piston that is not taken up by the rod.
A balanced actuator has a shaft on both sides of the piston, so the area is balanced actuator. A hydraulic or
the same on each side, and the same amount or force is developed in each pneumatic actuator that has the same area
direction. Balanced actuators are commonly used for hydraulic servos used on both sides of the piston.
with automatic pilots.
Linear actuators may have features that adapt them to special jobs. Figure
5-60 (Page 380) illustrates a landing gear actuator that has internal locks to
hold the landing gear down. The actuat_o r is locked with the piston retracted
all the way into the cylinder until hydraulic pressure releases it. In Figure
5-60A, the piston is retracted, and the landing gear is down and locked by the
locking balls that are forced into the groove in the end of the piston by the
locking pin.
B Fluid has pushed locking pin back to release locking balls and
allow fluid to force piston to extend, raising landing gear.
Figure 5-60. Landing gear aclua/ing cylinder wilh internal down lock
pinion gear raises or lowers the landing gear. See Figure 5-61.
rack-and-pinion actuator. A form of
rotary actuator where the fl uid acts on a
pisto n on w hich a rack of gear teeth is cut
As the piston moves, it rotates a pinion
gear which is mated with the teeth cut in
the rack.
93. Two types of hydraulic actuators are _ _ _ _ _ _ _ and _ _ __ _ _ _ actuators. Page 378
94. A linear hydraulic actuator that has the same area on both sides of its piston is called alan
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ actuator. Page 379
95.lf two linear actuators with pistons having the same cross sectional area but different piston strokes are
connected to the same source of hydraulic pressure, the pistons will move at _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(the same or different) rates of speed. Page 378
96. If two linear actuators with pistons of different cross sectional area are connected to the same source of
hydraulic pressure, the pistons will produce (the same or different) forces. Page 378
97. The rate of movement of the piston in a linear actuator may be controlled by installing alan
_ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ in the inlet or outlet port of the actuator. Page 378
98. A hydraulic actuator whose piston is moved in both directions by hydraulic fluid under pressure is caJled a/
an actuator. Page 378
99. A rack-and-pinion linear hydraulic actuator has an output that is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (linear or rotary).
Page 381
100. On an aircraft having boosted controls, the pilot actually moves a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ valve which
directs fluid to the proper side of an actuator that moves the control surface. Page 382
Backup ring
Spreader
Chevron seals
Proper installation of chevron seals
End view of groove and mating surface Correct fit of 0-ring Incorrect fit of 0-ring
-
384 AVIATIOK MAIN I ~•.'lA ,CJ, TECBNICIA:\ SERIES Volume 1: AIRfRM·1E STRCCTt.;RES
-
T·Seals
Another type of two-way seal is the T-seal shown in Figure 5-67. This seal
can fit in the standard 0-ring grooves, and is backed up with two Teflon
A Improper arrangement of scarfed ends
backup rings. T-seals are most often installed in high-pressure (3,000 psi)
systems.
Seal Identification
B Proper arrangement of scarfed ends
The material of which a seal is made is dictated by the fluid used in the system.
Seals are identified by colored marks. See Figure 5-68.
There is perhaps no other component as small as a hydraulic seal upon
which so much importance is placed. The correct seal and a wrong seal may C Teflon backup rings after pressure
has been applied and Teflon has
look alike, and it is highly probable that if the wrong seal is installed, it may been permanently set
appear to work. The material of which the seal is made, its age, and its
hardness are all important when making the proper replacement. Figure 5-66. The proper installation of a
When replacing seals in a hydraulic system, use only the specific part Teflon backup ring
numberofthe seal specified by the aircraft manufacturer. Purchase seals from
the equipment manufacturer or a reputable aircraft parts supplier, and they
should be sealed in individual packages marked with the part number, the
composition of the seal, the name of the manufacturer, and the cure date.
The cure date is the date the seal was manufactured, and it is given in
quarters. For example, 2Q94 indicates that the seal was manufactured in the
second quarter, during the months of April, May, or June, of 1994. Rubber
goods are not considered fresh if they are more than 24 months old.
Hydraulic seals must be bought only from a reputable supplier, because
out-of-date seals can be repackaged and stamped with a fresh date. The old
seal could be installed in good faith by an aviation maintenance technician and
still fail because of deterioration. Yet, the technician is liable for the failure
because installing an improper part in an aircraft is a violation of Federal
Aviation Regulations.
Color Use
~~
Spoon type
DF!l
Push type
(external)
~c=>
Figure 5-69. Typical tools for installation and removal ofO-ring seals
Figure 5-70 shows how to use these 0-ring installation tools, and the proper
method of installing and removing 0-rings in both intem al and extemal
grooves.
When installing an 0-ring over a sharp edge, cover the edge with paper,
aluminum foil, brass shim stock, or a piece of plastic, as in Figure 5-7 1. See
Figure 5-7 1 on Page 388.
Extractor tool
~ Cylinder mouth
~ .¢.\
Cylinder ·Pull.........._
0-ring 0-ring
Backup ring Backup ring
;;;::::::== t= ~~=======
Removal tool (hook type) Extractor tool (push type) Removal tool (hook type) Extractor tool (wedge type)
Dual internal 0-ring removal using push type extractor Internal 0 -ring removal using wedge type extractor
and hook type removal tools and hook type removal tools
Extracting tool
External 0-ring removal using spoon type External 0-ring removal using wedge type extractor
extractor and removal tools and hook type removal tools
0-ring receiving
Figure 5-71. Proper methods of protecting 0-ring seeds from damage when installing them
over threads and sharp edges
Wipers
0-rings and chevron seals do not seal around the shaft completely. Enough
fluid is allowed to leak to lubricate the shaft, and this lubricant attracts dust.
A felt wiper is usually installed in a counterbore around the shaft to keep the
seals from being damaged when the shaft is retracted into the cylinder. This
wiper removes any dirt or dust without restricting the movement of the shaft.
I0 I. A high-pressure seal used to seal between two fixed surfaces is called a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (gasket or
packing). Page 383
102. A high-pressure seal used to seal between a fixed and a movable surface is called a _ _ _ _ _ _ __
(gasket or packing). Page 383
106. An 0-ring of the correct size can withstand pressures of up to about _ _ _ _ _ _ _ psi without
distortion. Page 384
I 07 . When leather backup rings are used with an 0-ring seal, the smooth, or hair, side of the ring should be
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ (toward or away from) the 0-ring. Page 384
108. A backup ring is installed on the side of an 0-ring _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (toward or away from)
the pressure. Page 384
109. An 0-ring seal used with MIL-H-5606 hydraulic fluid will be identified with a _ _ _ __ _
(what color) mark. Page 385
110. Four important bits of information that should be on the sealed envelope containing an 0-ring seal are:
a. _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___
b. _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ____
c. _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ ___
d. _______________________________
Page 385
111. A felt ring is often installed around an actuator shaft to prevent dust and dirt entering the actuator and
damaging the seals. This ring is called a/an . Page 388
Fluid Lines
There are two kinds of fluid lines used in aircraft systems, rigid and flexible.
Rigid tubing is used where there is no relative movement within the system,
and flexible hoses are used when a piece of rigid tubing connects to an actuator
or other device with relative movement between the two.
Body Sleeve
Low-Pressure Hose
Low-pressure flexible fluid lines are seldom used for hydraulic systems, but
they are used in low-pressure pneumatic systems and in aircraft instrument
in stallations. The maximum pressure allowed for low-pressure hose is typi-
call y less than 250 psi.
Low-pressure hose, MIL-H-5593, has a seamless synthetic rubber inner
I iner covered with a single cotton braid reinforcement. All low-pressure hose
is covered with either a layer of s mooth or ribbed synthetic rubber.
Figure 5-81. Low-pressure hose has an inner liner and 011e layer offabric-braid
reinforcemenr.
Medium-Pressure Hose
MfL-H-8794 hose has a smooth synthetic rubber inner liner covered with a
cotton braid, and this braid is in turn covered with a single layer of steel wire
braid. Over all of this is a rough, oil-resistant outer layer of cotton braid.
The operating pressure allowed for medium-pressure hose varies with its
size. The smaller the diameter of the hose, the higher the a llowable operating
pressure. Generally MIL-H-8794 hose is used in hydraulic systems that
operate with pressures of about 1,500 psi.
All of the flexible hose used in aircraft fluid power systems have a lay-
line, a yellow-painted stripe that runs along the length of the hose. This stripe
allows you to tell at a glance whether or not the hose is twisted. When
installing flexible hose, be sure that the lay-line does not spiral around the
hose. See Figure 5-82 on the next page.
High-Pressure Hose
MIL-H-8788 hose has a smooth synthetic inner liner, two high-tensile car-
bon steel braid reinforcements, a fabric braid, and a smooth black synthetic
rubber outer cover.
Another high-pressure flexible hose is similar to MIL-H-8788, but it has
a butyl inner liner and a smooth synthetic rubber outer cover that is colored
green instead of black. The lay-line and the markings on this hose are white
instead of yellow.
This green hose is to be used only with phosphate ester hydraulic fluid
(Skydrol), and it is su itable for pressures of up to 3,000 psi, the same as
MIL-H-8788 hose.
Figure 5-l!3. High-pressure hose has an inner liner and two or three layers of steel wire
braid. It has a smooth outer cover.
Teflon Hose
The liner of Teflon hose is made of tetrafluorethylene, or Teflon, resin and
covered with a stainless steel braid. Medium-pressure Teflon hose is covered
with one stainless steel braid, and high-pressure hose has two layers of
stainless steel braid.
Teflon hose has some very desirable operating characteristics and it may
be used in fuel, lubricating oil, hydraulic, and pneumatic systems in aircraft.
It has one characteristic, however, that you must be aware of in order to get
the best service from it. The inner liner of Teflon hose is extruded, and it will
take a set, or will become somewhat rigid, after it has been used with high-
temperature or high-pressure fluids. After Teflon hose has been used, it
Medium -pressure Teflon hose is covered with one layer ofstainless steel braid.
High-pressure Teflon hose is covered with fll'o layers of stainless steel braid.
Figure 5-84
Some components in aircraft hydraulic systems use National Pipe Taper (NPT)
fillings to anach fluid lines to casti ngs. Figure 5-85 shows a typical fitting.
The end of these fi ttings that screws into the casting is tapered about
1/
16 inch to the inch, and when it is installed in a casting, the first thread
should be inserted into the hole and an approved thread lubricant applied
sparingly to the second thread. When the fitting is screwed into the casting,
the lubricant will squeeze out between the threads and prevent the threads
from galling, and yet none of the lubricant will squeeze out and contaminate
the system.
The way a tapered pipe fitting is measured is somewhat confusing. For
example, the commonly used 1/ 8-inch pipe fitting to which a 1;4-inch rigid
tube attaches does not measure 1/ 8 inch either inside or outside. Its outside Figure 5-85. An AN816 nipple has tapered
diameter and its threads are the same as those of a piece of standard iron pipe pipe threads on one end and fillings for an
that has an inside diameter of 1/ 8 inch. The hole into which a 1/ 8-inch NPT AN flare filling on the other end.
fitting screws has a diameter of about% inch.
AN
T~ AN -
3r
Yes
Feature -
Angle
Recess
AC
35°
No
~
z_
AC
"'
T
LI JJ/ Coarser
Blue
Threads
Color
Finer
Gray \ LI 1J
~I
or or \
\~
black yellow
-
396 AVIATION MAINTENANCE TECHNICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFRAME STRCCTURES
-
MS Flareless Fittings
There is a full line of flareless-type tube fittings available for use with the
crimped-on sleeve and nut. The inside of the fitting has a smooth counterbore
into which the end of the tube fits. The taper at the mouth of the fitting provides
the seal between the fitting and the sleeve, and the seal between the sleeve and
the tube is provided by the bite of the sleeve into the tube.
You must not overtorque flareless-type fittings. When assembling a fit-
ting of this type, be sure that the sleeve is properly preset on the tube, and the
tube inserted straight into the fitting. Screw the nut down finger-tight and
then tighten it with a wrench for one sixth of a turn, one hex, or at the very
most, one third of a turn, two hexes.
If the fitting leaks, rather than attempting to fix it by applying more
torque, disassemble the fitting and find out what the trouble is. It is usually a
damaged fitting or contamination between the sleeve and the fitting.
Quick-Disconnect Fittings
It is often necessary to actuate a hydraulic system without running the air- quick-disconnect fitting. A hydraulic line
craft engine. This is usually done with pressure supplied by a ground-power fitting that seals the line when the fitting is
unit also called a GPU, or hydraulic "mule." The inlet and outlet lines are disconnected. Quick-disconnect fi ttings are
used on the lines connected to the engine-
disconnected from the engine-driven pump and connected to the pump in driven hydraulic pump. They allow the
the mule. To prevent loss of fluid when making this change, the lines to the pump to be disconnected and an auxiliary
pump are fitted with quick-disconnect fittings such as the ones shown in hydraulic power system connected to
Figure 5-88. perform checks requiring hydraulic power
When the lines are disconnected the springs inside both halves of the while the aircraft is in the hangar.
fitting pull the poppet valves tightly into their seats and seal off the lines.
When the lines are connected, plungers in each fitting meet and force the
poppets off of their seats allowing fluid to flow freely through the fittings.
Fitting
Plunger Poppet
When fittings are disconnected, the springs hold poppet valves tightly on When fittings are connected, the plungers force poppets
their seats. off their seats and fluid flows freely through the fittings.
Rigid Lines
When manufacturing a replacement rigid fluid line, be sure that all of the
angles are correct, and inspect all of the bends to be sure that none of them are
collapsed, kinked, or wrinkled. Fit the line in place to ensure that the tube
aligns with the fittings at each end. The line should be straight with the fitting
and should apply a slight pressure against it.
l. No tube, regardless of how sho1t, should be installed unless there is at
least one bend in it. This bend provides for vibration, and for the
inevitable expansion and contraction that are caused by temperature
changes and by the line being pressurized.
2. Never attempt to pull a tube up to the fitting with the nut. This will place
a strain on the flare or the preset bite, and vibration can easily cause the
tube to fail.
3. Where a fluid line is brought through a bulkhead, if it is not carried
through with a bulkhead fitting, it must be supported with bonded cushion
clamps and centered in the hole in such a way that there is protection
against chafing.
4. All fluid lines should be run below electrical wire bundles so that there
is no possibility of fluid dripping onto the wire.
5. All fluid lines should be identified at each end, and at least once in each
compartment with color-coded tape to identify the type of fluid
it carries.
6. Support clamps should be placed no farther apart than:
V8 " tubing every 9 inches
V/ tubing every 12 inches
%" tubing every 16 inches
T~ese clamps should be placed as near the bend as possible so the tubing
will have a minimum amount of overhang.
I 12. Rigid tubing used in low-pressure hydraulic systems is usually made of aluminum
alloy. Page 390
113. Rigid tubing used for high-pressure hydraulic systems is usually made of aluminum
alloy or annealed . Page 390
114. A dent that is 10% of the diameter of a piece of aluminum alloy tubing (is or is not)
permissible if it is in the heel of a bend. Page 390
115. A scratch in a piece of aluminum alloy tubing is permissible if its depth is less than percent
of the tubing wall thickness, and it is not in the heel of a bend. Page 390
116. The flare cone angle used for aircraft flared tubing fittings has an angle of degrees. Page 390
117. Soft aluminum alloy tubing should be double flared if its diameter is inch or less. Page 390
118. A properly preset MS flareless fitting _ _ _ __ (is or is not) allowed to rotate on the tube. Page 391
119. The minimum bend radius for a piece of %-inch aluminum alloy tubing is _ __ __ __ inch/es.
Page 392
120. The maximum flattening allowed in the bend in a piece of rigid fluid line reduces the outside diameter of
the tube in the bend to percent of the original tube diameter. Page 392
121. A piece of flexible hose that has a ribbed outer covering is a ______ (low, medium, or high)-
pressure hose. Page 393
122. A piece of flexible hose that has a rough outer covering is a _ _ _ _ __ _ (low, medium, or high)-
pressure hose. Page 393
123. A piece of flexible hose that has a smooth outer covering is a _ __ _ __ (low, medium, or high)-
pressure hose. Page 394
124. A piece of flexible hose that has a smooth green outer covering is designed to carry
_ _ _ _ __ __ _ _ _ (mineral or phosphate ester)-base fluid. Page 394
125. The highest pressure that can be carried in a low-pressure flexible hose is normally considered to
be psi. Page 393
127. High-pressure flexible hose is used in hydraulic systems with pressures up to _ _ _ _ _ __ psi.
Page 394
128. A flexible hose with a stainless steel braid outer covering has a liner made of _ _ _ _ _ __
Page 394
129. When installing a tapered pipe thread in a casting, thread lubricant should be applied to the
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ (first or second) thread. Page 395
130. The nut of an MS flareless fitting should be screwed down finger tight on the fitting and then it should be
tightened with a wrench for or at the most of a turn. Page 397
13 1. When a fluid line is routed through a section of an aircraft structure parallel with an electrical wire bundle,
the fluid line should be (above or below) the wire bundle. Page 398
132. A run of 3/ 8-inch rigid fluid line should be supported with a cushioned clamp at least every _ _ _ __
inches. Page 398
133. The colored line that extends the length of a piece of flexible hose that is used to tell whether or not the
hose was twisted during installation is called alan line. Page 399
134. Flexible hose changes its dimens ions when it is pressurized. A piece of flexible hose should be between
_____ and percent longer than the distance between the fittings to which it attaches.
Page 399
135. The minimum recommended bend radius for a piece of Vrinch MIL-H-8788 hose is _ _ _ __ _
inches. Page 399
Pneumatic Systems
Pneumatic systems are fluid power systems that use a compressible fluid,
air. These systems are dependable and lightweight, and because the fluid is
air, there is no need for a return system.
Some aircraft have only a low-pressure pneumatic system to operate the
gyro instruments; others use compressed air as an emergency backup for
lowering the landing gear and operating the brakes in the event of a hydrau-
lic system failure. Still others have a complete pneumatic system that actu-
ates the landing gear retraction, nose wheel steering, passenger doors, and
propeller brakes. Each of these types of systems is discussed in this section.
Air
pump Air
outlet
~~~ Air
c: inlet
In
pressure
regulator
Suction
gage
Figure 5-92. A pneumatic Figure 5-93. A pneumatic gyroscopic
gyroscopic instrumem system instrument system using the pressure side
using the suction side of the ofa dry air pump
air pump
Desiccant Desiccant
1,700 psi
Compressor Compressor back pressure
left engine right engine valve
Check
valve
Pressure Pressure
sensing line sensing line
Filter
Check
valve
To
emergency
system
Passenger door
Landing gear
Check
valve Nosewheel steering
Propeller brakes
136. Oil from the discharge of a wet-type air pump is collected by alan and
returned to the engine. Page 402
137. The vanes of a dry-type air pump are made of . Page 402
138. The air pressure in a full pneumatic system is maintained in the correct range by the action of the
_ _ _ _ _ __ _ valve. Page 404
l39.lf the lubrication system for the high-pressure compressor fails, the _______ valve will relieve
the pump of all of its load. Page 404
140. Water is removed from the compressed air in a full pneumatic system by the
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ .Page406
141. The actuating components in a full pneumatic system may be serviced without discharging the air storage
bottles by closing the valve. Page 406
System A
The fluid for system A, shown in Figure 5-97, is held in a reservoir that is
pressurized by bleed air from engines 1 and 2. Fluid from the reservoir goes
to engine-driven pumps on engines 1 and 2. These pumps pressurize the fluid
to 3,000 psi, and this fluid flows through check valves into the system A
pressure manifold and accumulator. After actuating the components in
system A, the fluid returns to the reservoir through a filter.
System A provides power for the landing gear, nose wheel steering, nose
wheel brakes, trailing edge flaps, leading edge flaps and slats, ground
spoilers, outboard flight spoilers, ailerons, elevators, and lower rudder. See
Figure 4-34 on Page 286 for a picture of the control smfaces.
E~ch of the engine-driven pumps has a solenoid-operated depressuriza-
tion valve that allows the flight engineer to reduce the output pressure from
3,000 psi to approximately 0 psi . With the pump depressurized, fluid still
flows through its case for lubrication and cooling. When the pilot pulls the
fire-pull T handle, the pumps are automatically depressurized, and motor-
operated nuid shutoff valves shut off the flow of fluid between the pump and
the system.
Vent
Return SeNice
port
A_~-~
Standby
reservoir
From
hand pump
limiter
Outboard GIJ------------:.-L-tl_ap_s_ _ __
Alternate
flap motors Landing gear &
Elevator Inboard
nosewhee_l steering flight
spoilers
Standby System
The standby system is pressurized by a continuous-duty electric motor-driven
pump supplied with power from the Essential AC bus through switches for
either the alternate flap or the standby rudder. Pressure from the standby
system is used to operate the standby rudder and extend the leading edge
devices when system A pressure is lost.
Reservoir Servicing
The three reservoirs are serviced with a pressure unit or hand pump through
system B reservoir. As soon as system B reservoir is full, fluid will flow into
system A reservoir through the interconnect line, which is connected at the
2.5 gallon level. When the system A reservoir is full, the standby reservoir
will fill. Fluid quantity indicators are installed on the flight engineer's pan-
els for all three reservoirs.
142. Hydraulic pumps supplying pressure for large aircraft may be driven by five methods. These are:
a. d.
b. e. --------------------------
c.
Page 407
143. When a power transfer unit is used to pressurize one hydraulic system in an aircraft from another system,
fluid (is or is not) transferred between the systems. Page 407
144. The hydraulic pumps used in a Boeing 727 system A are _______________ (engine-driven or electric).
Page 408
145. The hydraulic pumps used in a Boeing 727 system B are _______________ (engine-driven or electric).
Page 410
147. The hydraulic pressure gages on a Boeing 727 flight engineer's panels read _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ _
(accumulator air or hydraulic fluid) pressure. Page 408
148. Boeing 727 system A components may be actuated without the engine running by using system B pumps
and opening the valve. Page 410
149. Boeing 727 system A pump output pressure can be dropped to zero pressure by the fli ght engineer
opening the solenoid-operated valve. Page 408
I50. All three hydraulic reservoirs in a Boeing 727 are serviced through the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ reservoi r.
Page 410
Continued
151. No systematic troubleshooting can be done without the use of a/an _________ diagram of the
system. Page 411
152. The two basic sections of a hydraulic system are the _ ______ and the _ ______ sections.
Page 412
153. There are three subdivisions of the power section of a hydraulic system. These are _ _ _ _ __
_ __ _ _ _ _ ,and .Page412
154. If only one system fails to operate as it should, and there is pressure in the system, the trouble is in the
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (actuation or power) system. Page 412
155.lf there is no pressure indicated on the system pressure gage, yet there is fluid flowing back into the
reservoir, the problem is probably in the (pump or pressure
control valves). Page 412
156.lf the system pressure drops when some unit is actuated, a probable cause could be a restriction in the line
between the (pump and the pressure regulator or selector
valve and actuator). Page 412
157. A higher than normal system pressure is most likely to be caused by a malfunctioning
_ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ (unloading valve or relief valve). Page 412
158. A heavy chattering or banging in a hydraulic system is often caused by an insufficient air preload in the
________________ .Page412
159. Hydraulic pump chattering and overheating is usually caused by air in the pump _______ (inlet
or discharge) line. Page 413
-
414 A VIATIO:" MAINTENANCE T ECHNICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFR AME STRUCTURES
-
160. Spongy actuation of a hydraulic system is usually caused by _ _ _ _ _ in the system. Page 413
161. When there are several relief valves in a hydraulic or pneumatic system, always begin adj usting with the
valve that should be set to the (highest or lowest) pressure first. Page 413
162. Rapid fluctuation of the pointer o n a hydraulic pressure gage is usually an indication of _ _ _ _ __
in the pressure gage line. Page 413
Continued
Rubber
_ _ __ shock cord
Figure 6-2. A wheel-replacement ski Figure 6-3. Retractable skis allow the airplane to he operated
from either dry runways or ice and snow without changing the
landing gear.
The tail l1'heellanding gear is used for airplanes that primarily operate Retractable landing gear minimizes parasite drag and is used on airplanes
from unpa1•etl areas. where speed is a primlll)' consideration.
Tricycle landing gear is popular because of its good ground handling Figure 6-4. Modern landing gear configurations
characteri.~tics.
Figure 6-6 shows the inside of an oleo shock absorber. The strut is made of
two chambers that are separated by an orifice and a tapered metering pin
which moves in and out of the orifice. The outer cylinder is attached to the
aircraft structure, and the wheel assembly attaches to the piston.
When the aircraft takes off, the combined weight of the wheel and
the air pressure inside the strut force the piston out to the limit allowed by
the piston extension stop. Almost all the oil in the strut flows down into the
hollow piston.
When the aircraft touches down on landing, the oil is forced into the
upper chamber through the orifice, into the snubber tube, and out into the
inner cylinder through the Dapper valve, which is a one-way check valve.
The small end of the metering pin is in the orifice at the beginning of the
strut compression, and its tapered shape steadily decreases the area of the
orifice as the strut collapses. The energy in the landing impact is absorbed
by the oil as it is forced through the decreasing s ize orifice and by the air
which compresses as the oil is forced into the upper chamber.
The momentum of the aircraft at touchdown compresses the strut to more
than is required to support the aircraft weight, and when maximum compres-
Figure 6-5. Nose landing gear assembly
sion is reached, the aircraft tries to rebound, or bounce. Fluid tries to flow back
into the piston, but the flapper valve closes and the fluid must flow through
the small holes in the snubber tube. This restriction of fluid flow prevents the
rapid extension of the strut that would cause the airplane to bounce.
torque links. The hinged link between the After the initial landing impact has been absorbed by the transfer of oil
piston and cylinder of an oleo-type land ing between the compartments, the taxi shocks are absorbed by the cushion sup-
gear shock absorber. The torque links plied by the compressed air.
all ow the piston to move freely in and out The combination of the snubber tube and the snubber knob on the top of
of the landing gear cy linder, but prevent it
the metering pin controls the rate of strut extension after takeoff. The com-
rotating. The torque links can be adjusted
to achieve and maintain the correct whee l bined forces of the compressed air in the top of the strut and the weight of
al ignment. the wheel, tire, and brake would cause the piston to extend very rapidly, and
Torq ue li nks are called scissors and if the rate of extension were not controlled, damage would most likely re-
nutcrackers. sult. The small holes in the snubber tube slow the extension by controlling
w
Filler plug
and air valve
. ..... .. ........
·:~ - Upper bearing
0 and piston 0
extension stop
0 0
Outside cylinder _ ,.
Piston -----~1
0
Strut is compressed,
hydraulic fluid fills strut
to filler plug level.
Tapered
metering pin
0
Strut is extended to limit
allowed by the piston
extension stop.
Figure 6-6. Diagram of an oleo shock absorber
Bleeder
hose
Figure 6-7. Use w1 exerciser jack to move the pislon in and out of the shock strut when
servicing it withfluid.
Bungee
shock
cord
Nonshock-Absorbing Landing Gears
Not all airplanes use shock absorbers. The popular single-engine series of
Figure 6-8. This landing gear, typical of
Cessna airplanes uses a steel leaf or a tubular steel spring to accept the energy
that used on many early Piper airplanes,
so.flened the landing impact and taxi of the landing impact and return it to the aircraft. In a properly conducted
shocks with rings of rubber bands encased landing, energy is returned in such a way that it does not cause any rebound.
in a loose-weave coflo n braid. See Figure 6-4 on Page 423.
426 AVI ATIO:\ M A INT ENANCE T EC HNICI AN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFR A ME STRUCT URES
Another type of landing gear that does not use a shock absorber was used on b ungec s hock cord. A cushioning material
many of the early light airplanes. Elastic shock cord, called bungee cord, that used with the non-shock absorbing landing
gears installed on o lder aircraft.
is made up of many small strands of rubber encased in a loose-weave cotton
Bungee cord is made up o f many small
braid, stretches with the landing impact and returns the energy to the airframe. rubber bands encased in a loose-woven
cotton braid.
Wheel Alignment
It is important for the wheels of an airplane to be in proper alignment with the camber (wheel alignment). T he amount
airframe. Two alignment checks are important: toe-in or toe-out and camber. the wheels of an aircraft are tilted, or
inc lined. from the vertical. If the top of the
wheel tilts outward, the camber is positive.
Toe-In or Toe-Out If the top of the wheel tilts inward. the
A wheel is toed in when lines perpendicular to the axles of a main landing gear camber is negative.
cross ahead of the aircraft. The front of the tires are closer together than the
rear, and when the aircraft is rolled forward, the wheels try to move together. toe-in. A condition of landing gear
Toe-out is the opposite condition; the front of the tires are farther apart alignment in which the front of the tires
than the rear, and when the aircraft rolls forward, the wheels try to move are closer together than the rear. When the
aircraft rolls forward. the wheels try to
farther apart. move closer together.
To check for wheel alignment, put two aluminum plates, about 18 inches
square, with grease between them under each main wheel and rock the aircraft
toe-out. A condition of landing gear
to relax the landing gear. Place a straightedge against the tires as seen in Figure
alignment in wh ich the front of the tires
6-9, and hold a carpenter's square against the straightedge so it touches the tire are fa rther apart than the rear. When the
just below the axle nut. Measure the distance between the square and the front aircraf t rolls forward, the wheels try to
and rear of the wheel rim. The wheel alignment should be within the tolerance move farther apart.
specified in the aircraft maintenance manual.
Carpenters
square
Aluminum plates
- Shock
strut
cylinder
Straightedge
or removed
from here
adjust toe in
or out
Carpenters
square
Shock
strut
piston
Shimmy Dampers
Nose wheels may shimmy at certain speeds. Shimmy dampers like the one in
Figure 6-16 may be installed between the piston and the cylinder of the nose
wheel oleo strut to prevent this.
The simple shimmy damper in Figure 6-16 has two compartments
joined through a small bleed hole, or orifice. As the nose wheel fork rotates,
hydraulic fluid is forced from one compartment into the other through the
orifice. This restricted flow of fluid has no effect on normal nose wheel
steering but opposes rapid movement of the piston and prevents shimmying.
Large aircraft typically combine shimmy clamping and nose wheel
steering. Hydraulic fluid under pressure is directed into one or the other of two
Figure 6-15. Nose 1vheel centering cam steering cylinders mounted on the nose wheel strut as shown in Figure 6-17.
Figure 6-16. A shimmy damper installed between the nose wheel cylinder and piston shimmy damper . A small hydraulic shock
absorbs the shimmying vibrations by the tramfer of hydraulic fluid from one side of the absorber installed between the nosewheel
piston to the other through the bleed hole. fork and the nosewheel cy linder attached
to the aircraft structure.
A control wheel operated by the pilot directs pressure to one side of the nose
s himmy. Abnor mal, and often violent.
wheel steering pistons, and fluid from the opposite side of the pistons is vented
vib ration of the nose wheel of an airplane.
back into the reservoir through a pressure relief valve that holds a constant Shimmying is usually caused by looseness
pressure on the system to snub shimmying. An accumulator in the line to the of the nose wheel suppo rt mechanism. but
relief valve holds pressure on the system when the steering control valve is in may also be caused by tire imbalance.
its neutral position.
cen tering cam. A cam in the nose-gear
shock strut that causes the piston to center
when the strut fully extends.
When the aircraft takes off and the str ut
extends, the whee l is straightened in its
fore-and-aft posit ion so it can be retracted
into the wheel well.
I. A spring steel landing gear _ _ __ ____ (does or does not) absorb shock. Page 426
2. An air-oil oleo shock strut absorbs the energy from the initial landing impact with the _ _ __ _ _
(air or oil). Page 424
3. The opposition to the landing impact is gradually increased in an oleo shock strut by a tapered
_ _ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ decreasing the size of the orifice. Page 424
4. An air-oil oleo shock strut absorbs taxi shocks with the _ _ _ _ _ _ (air or oil). Page 424
5. A spring-oil shock strut absorbs taxi shocks with the _ __ _ __ _ (spring or oil). Page 424
6. Rebound is minimized with an oleo shock strut by restricting the flow of oil by the closing of the
_ __ _ _ _ _ valve. Page 424
7. Two places in which you can find the specification number for the proper fluid to use to service an oleo
shock strut are:
a. -----------------------------
b. _ __ _ _ __ __ _ _ ____
Page 426
8. An oleo shock strut can be charged with high-pressure compressed air or with _______________
Page 426
9. The conect amount of air in an oleo shock strut is measured by the ________________ of the strut.
Page 426
10. If the main wheels of an airplane are closer together at the front than at the rear, the landing gear is toed
_ _ _ _ _ (in or out). Page 427
11. If the top of the main wheel of an airplane tilts outward , the wheel has a ______________ (positive or
negative) camber. Page 428
12. The wheels of an airplane equipped with a spring stee11anding gear are aligned by adding shims between
the and the . Page 428
14. When a large transport category airplane is not being steered on the ground, the nose gear steering cylin-
ders act as . Page 431
15. An airplane with a castering nose wheel is steered by differential use of the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 430
16. A retractable nose wheel is prevented fro m being retracted when it is not straight ahead by alan
_ _ _ _ __ _ _ ___ in the nose gear oleo strut. Page 430
Up ( ) } \ Down
~=== To system
return manifold
Orifice
check valve
tl
~
Orifice
check valve
Left
Main-gear
sequence valve
! ~
M•lo-goa<
sequence valve
Right
-
~
main-gear
~
main-gear
actuating actuating
cylinder cylinder
Left gear Right gear
uplock uplock
- I Clo"~
~ t = Up rr==1.,._.---lJr--d
Left gear Right gear
down lock down lock
Nose-gear lv~
i
~
downlock Nose-gear
actuator
Nose-gear
uplock
- r---
Gear down and locked
Selector In GEAR-UP position
Gear doors are open
Figure 6-20. Schematic diagram of a rypical hydraulic system for a retractable landing gear ll'ith hydraulically acruated wheel-well doors
18. A hydraulic system that has the reservoir, pump, and valves in a single easy-to-service unit is called alan
_________________ system. Page 433
19. The mechanically operated valve that prevents the landing gear actuator from lowering the main gear
before the wheel well doors are open is called a/an valve. Page 436
20. Emergency actuation of the landing gear of some small airplanes consists of opening the free-fall valve
between the landing gear and the and allowing the gear to free
fall from the wheel wells. Page 436
21. Two gases that may be used for the emergency backup system for a hydraulically actuated landing gear
are compressed and . Page 436
22. When a landing gear is extended by the emergency system, compressed air or nitrogen is directed into the
actuating cylinder through alan valve. Page 436
438 A VlATION MAINT ENANCE T ECHNICIAN S ERIES Volume 1 : A I RFRA ME STR UC"rURES
Aircraft Brakes energizing brake. A brake that uses the
momentum of the aircraft to increase its
In the study of aircraft brakes we first consider different types of brake effectiveness by wedging the shoe against
actuating units and then the various methods of providing hydraulic pressure the brake drum.
to them. Energi7i ng brakes are also called servo
brakes. A single-servo brake is energizing
on ly when moving in the forward
Brake Actuating Units
direction, and a duo-servo brake is
Aircraft brake systems slow the airplane down by changing kinetic energy cncrgi7ing when the ai rcraft is moving
from the motion of the aircraft into heat energy generated by the friction either forward or backward.
between the linings and the brake drum or disk.
Two basic types of brakes are in use, energizing and nonenergizing.
sing le-ser vo brake. A brake that uses the
Energizing brakes use the friction developed between the rotating and sta-
momentum of the aircraft rolling forward
tionary parts to produce a wedging action that increases the braking force to help apply the brakes by wedging the
and reduces the pilot effort needed to obtain the desired braking action. Non- brake shoe against the brake drum.
energizing brakes do not use this wedging action.
Energizing Brakes
Drum-type brakes, simi lar to those used on automobi les, are a form of dual- fading of b rakes. The decrease in the
servo brake. Movement of the aircraft either forward or backward causes the amount of braking action that occurs with
some types of brakes that arc applied for a
brake linings to wedge against the rotating drum when the brakes are applied.
long period of time.
Energizing brakes used on some of the smaller aircraft have a single- True fadi ng occurs with overheated
servo action. Only forward motion of the aircraft helps apply the brakes. drum-type brakes. As the drum is heated, it
Energizing brakes have their shoes and linings mounted on a torque plate expands in a bell-mouthed fashion. This
in such a way that they are free to move out against the rotating drum. When decreases the amount o f drum in contact
with the brake shoes and decreases the
the brakes are applied, two pistons in the brake cylinder move out and push
braking action.
the linings against a cylindrical cast-iron drum that rotates with the wheel. A condi tion similar to brake fading
Friction attempts to rotate the linings, but they are held in place by the cylinder occurs when there is an internal leak in the
assembly. Rotation of the brake drum wedges the linings tightly against it. brake master cylinder. The brakes are
When the hydraulic pressure is released, the retracting spring pulls the linings applied. but as the pedal is held down,
back from the drum and releases the brakes. fluid leaks past the piston , and the brakes
slowly release.
One of the limitations of this type of brake is fading. When the brake is
used, the friction heats the drum and causes the open end to expand in a bell-
mouthed fashion. The drum expands away from the linings and the friction
area decreases.
Nonenergizing Brakes
Nonenergizi ng brakes are the most common type ofbrake on modern aircraft. nonener gizing brake. A brake that docs
These brakes are actuated by hydraulic pressure, and the amount of braking not usc the momentum of the aircraft to
increase the friction.
action depends upon the amount of pressure applied. Expander tube, single-
disk, and multiple-disk brakes are all nonenergizing brakes.
~~
---o(--Torque bar
' ~" Return spring
'~ Return spring shield
Torque Brake ' ube heat shield
Adjuster bolt Torque flange Frame
~-
bar bolt
Nozzle l 0 -o @)
~=-,-~ ~ • •
~- _ • ______ ·o ·- - - - -
Adjuster
Brake
frame bolt Expander tube
Disc
()>0
0 (j)· p;,,,
0 ~+-Cylinder head
Bra ke disk
Wheel
Key
Disc
Pressure plate
lining puck
Backing plate
lining puck
or wear
indicator pin
Adjusting
pin grip
Brake disk
Inboard
wheel half
Outboard
wheel half
Figure 6-25. Cle1•eland wheel showing the brake disk that bolts to the inner ll'heel half
Rivets (8)
Pistons Pressure Torque plate
plate
Pressure plate
Anchor bolts (2) lining
Figure 6-26. Cleveland brake assembly. The disk that bolts to the wheel turns between the two sets of linings that are riveted to
the pressure plate and the backplate. The entire brake a~·sembly rides on the two anchor bolts which slide back and forth in
bushings in the torque plate.
Housing assembly
""--
I'""-- ,
'
1
""-- '
'
I
I'
I
Backplate -
Figure 6-27. A dual-disk brake works on the same principle as the single-disk brake, but has more disk area and more lining area.
Carrier assembly
_ Pressure plate
Drilled passages
for System A
Figure 6-31. Housing of the brake installed on a McDonnell-Douglas DC-9 showing the
hydraulic ports and passages in System A. Identical cylinders, pons, and passages for
System Bare not shown.
~
-..... __
~-
....
Figure 6-32. Carbon disk brake assembly used on a Fokker /00 twin jet transport.
Parking
brake on
Parking
brake
valve
Figure 6-33. The diaphragm-type master cylinder may be used to supply hydraulic fluid
under pressure to the expander tube brakes of small aircraft.
d ragging brakes. Brakes that do not fully
release when the brake pedal is released.
The brakes are partially applied all the Larger aircraft require more fluid for their brakes. This fluid must be vented
ti me, which causes excessive lining wear to the atmosphere when the brakes are not applied. The vent for the brake
and heat. system allows the Ouid to expand when it is heated without causing the brakes
to drag.
compensator port. A small hole between The many types of vented master cylinders all have the same basic com-
a hydrau lic brake master cylinder and the ponents. The master cylinder in Figure 6-35 is typical of those used in mod-
reservoir. When the brakes are re leased, ern light aircraft.
this port is uncovered and the pressure on
Each wheel cylinder is served by its own master cylinder, which is
the fl uid in the line to the brake master
cylinder is the same as the atmospheric
mounted on a pivot below the rudder pedals as in Figure 6-34. The pilot
pressure. moves the entire rudder pedal forward for normal rudder actuation, but to
When the brake is applied, the master- actuate the brakes, the pilot applies pressure with his or her toes to lower the
cylinder piston covers the compensator plunger into the cylinder.
port and allows pressure in the line to the The body of the master cylinder in Figure 6-35 serves as the reservoir
brake to build up and apply the brakes.
for the fluid, and it is vented to the atmosphere. When the pedal is not de-
When the brake is released , the piston
uncovers the compensator port. If any flu id pressed, the return spring forces the piston up so that the compensator sleeve
has been lost from the brake, the reservo ir holds the compensator port open to vent the fluid in the brake line and the
will refil l the master cylinder. wheel cylinder to the atmosphere.
Figure 6-34. individual brake master cylinders are installed below the rudder pedals. The
brakes are applied by depressing the top of the pedal with the roe.
Depressing the top of the rudder pedal pushes the piston away from the
compensator sleeve, and a special 0-ring and washer seals fluid in the line to
the brake. The amount of pressu re applied to the brakes is proportional to the
amount of force the pilot applies to the brake pedal. W hen the pedal is
released, the compensator sleeve contacts the piston and opens the compen-
sator port. This vents the brake line into the reservoir.
The parking brake for this type of master cylinder is a simple spri ng-
released ratchet mechanism that holds the piston down in the cylinder. To
apply the parking brake, depress the brake pedal and pull the parking brake
handle. This locks the piston down. To release the brake, depress the brake Compensator
~-···-~sleeve
pedal more than was done for the initial appl ication and the ratchet wi ll release.
Reservoir
Compensator
t3fJt9:'+-----!·-t- port
~--t+- Compensator
sleeve
Brake pedal Is released and return Brake pedal is depressed, piston rod
spring has pushed piston rod to the pushes piston away from the
top. Compensator sleeve holds the compensator sleeve, and the 0-ring
piston away from the seal and wheel seals piston to the piston rod.
cylinder is vented to the reservoir. Complete master cylinder assembly
Power Brakes
Large aircraft brakes require more fluid and higher pressures than can be
supplied by independent master cylinders, and brakes for these aircraft are
actuated by pressure supplied from the main hydraulic power system of the
aircraft. Power brake control valves operated by the pilot meter this pressure
to give the pilot control of the braking action.
System Operation
To operate power brakes, the pilot depresses the brake pedal, which actuates
the power brake control valve. Hydraulic fluid under pressure from the main
hydraulic system is metered to the brake wheel cylinders proportionate to
the amount of force the pilot applies to the brake pedal. The brake control
valve is more of a regulator than a selector valve, because it must allow the
pilot to hold the brakes partially applied without the pressure building up in
the brake lines.
452 A YIAT ION M A INTENANCE TECII:\'ICIA N SERIES Volume 1: AIRFR A ME STRUC" f U RE.S
The brakes of these aircraft require a large volume of fluid, and its pressure
must be considerably lower than that supplied by the main hydraulic system.
The pressure supplied to the brake assembly by the brake control valve is
lowered, and the volume increased, by deboosters installed near the wheels.
Since the brakes are in an area where damage can easily occur, hydraulic
fuses are installed to prevent the loss of fluid in the event a hydraulic line is
broken. There must also be an emergency brake system that can supply air or
hydraulic pressure to the brake assemblies if the main hydraulic system
should fail.
Figure 6-37 is a simplified schematic of a typical power brake system
used in large jet aircraft. The brakes get their fluid from the main hydraulic
system, and a check valve and an accumulator hold the pressure for the brakes
in the event of a failure in the hydraulic system. The pilot and the copilot
operate the power brake control valves through the appropriate linkages.
To hydraulic To hydraulic
system system
pressure return
manifold manifold
Emergency
brake system
Air/oil
transfer
tube
Ground
Airborne
L#1=R
B
Figure 6-40. Anfl.skid control box with the airplane in the air. Figure 6-41. Antiskid control box with the airplane on the
The antiskid valve is held open so no pressure can be applied to ground. The wheels have built up a speed of20 mph or more and
the brake regardless of the position of the brake pedals. the antiskid valve is open, allowing full pressure to be applied to
the brakes.
As soon as weight is on the landing gear, the squat switch changes position squat switch. An electrical switch
and opens the ground to the locked-wheel arming circuit. When the wheel actuated by the landing gear scissors on
the o leo strut. When no weig ht is on the
speed builds up to about 20 miles per hour, the wheel-speed sensors produce
land ing -gear, the oleo piston is extended
enough vol tage to cause the locked-wheel detector to send a signal to the and the switch is in one po sition. but when
antiskid valve allowing full pressure to go to the brake. weight is on the gear. the o leo strut
When the airplane is on the ground with all wheels turning at more than compresses and the switch changes
20 mph, skid control is provided by the skid detectors and the modulator its position.
circuits. Any time a wheel decelerates at a rate higher than the programmed Squat switches are used in antiskid
brake systems. landing gear safety circu its,
maximum, a signal is sent to the amplifier and the n to the control valve to
and cabin p ressurin tio n systems.
dump the brake pressure. At the same time, the skid detector sends a signal
to the modulator which, by measuring the width of the skid detector signal ,
automatically establishes the amount of c urrent that will continue to flow
through the valve after the wheel has recovered from the skid. When the
am plifier receives its signal from the modulator, it maintains this current,
which is just enough to prevent the con_trol valve from dumping all the pres-
sure, but maintains a pressure slightly less than that which caused the skid.
I
Ground 1
Airborne
B
Squat p
7 switch
~R
B
Antiskid control box
Figure 6-42. Antiskid control box with the airplane on the ground. All wheels are fumin g
at more than 20 mph. The skid detector is sensing the rate of change of wheel speed and
sending the appropriate signal to the modulator. The signal from the modulator is
amplified and sent to the antiskid control valve, which applies or releases the brakes to
keep the tire in the slip area but prevents a skid from developing.
System Tests
Antiskid braking systems include methods of checking system integrity
before the brakes are needed. If the antiskid system does not function as it
should, the pilot can disable it without affecting normal braking action.
Prelanding Check
With the airplane configured for landing and the landing gear down and
locked, the pilot can determine that the antiskid system is operating properly
by depressing the brake pedals. The brake indicator lights should remain off.
The squat switch keeps the locked-wheel arming circuit energized, and the
signal from the locked-wheel detectors causes the amplifier to send suffi-
cient current into the control valves to hold the brakes fully released.
Depressing the brake test switch with the pedals depressed should cause
the brake li ghts to turn on. This sends a signal through the wheel-speed sen-
sors simulating a wheel speed of greater than 20 mph. If the system is oper-
ating properly, this voltage will override the signal from the squat switch
and disabl e the locked-wheel arming circuit. This allows the locked-wheel
detector to remove the signal from the amplifier so the control valve can
restore normal action to the brakes. The brake indicator light should remain
on as long as the test switch is held depressed.
Maintenance Checks
If an antisk.id system has failed any of its tests, the source of the trouble is
relatively simple to isolate. It is generally in one of three components: the
wheel-speed sensor, the control box, or the control valve. Before blaming the
antiskid system, however, be sure that the brakes are operating normally.
There should be no warped disks or broken return springs, and there should
be no air in the brake lines or cylinders.
The components of the antisk.id system itself are quite complex and most
of them must be repaired only by the manufacturer or an FAA-certificated
repair station approved for the particular components.
Wheel-Speed Sensors
As in all systematic troubleshooting, first check the items that are easiest to
reach or are most likely to fail. Remove the wheel hubcap and, with the brakes
applied, flip the blade of the wheel-speed sensor to cause it to rotate in a
clockwise direction. This blade will turn about 180° or less when it is flipped,
but it is the rate, not the amount of movement, that is important. Watch the brake
disk stack as the blade is flipped; the stack should relax and then retighten.
If the brakes do not release, remove the connector from the back of the
sensor and check the resistance of the coil as the blade is rotated through a
full revolution. The resistance should be that specified in the maintenance
manual, and it should be smooth throughout the rotation of the blade. If the
resistance is within the acceptable limits, place the multimeter on its lowest
DC voltage scale and attach the leads to the pins, as indicated in the mainte-
nance manual. Flip the blade in the clockwise direction and the voltmeter
should indicate an upscale deflection. If a digital voltmeter is used, the
voltage indication should be positive. If the wheel-speed sensor checks out
electrically, check to be sure it is properly installed.
Cockpit
emergency brake
pressure gage
From right
power brake
Emergency control valve
brake
charging
Nitrogen
supply
bottle
Figure 6-45. Emergency brake system for a large jet tramport airplane
Brake Maintenance
The brakes of a modern aircraft take more abuse than almost any other
component. The tremendous amount of kinetic energy caused by the weight
and rolling speed of the aircraft must be transferred into the relatively small
mass of the brake in order to stop the aircraft. Jet aircraft, for th is reason, very
often use thrust reversers to slow the aircraft after land ing before the brakes
are applied. An aborted takeoff is an emergency procedure that transfers far aborted takeoff. A takeoff that is
terminated prematurely when it is
more heat into the brakes than they are designed to absorb, and the brakes, determined that some co ndition exisb that
wheels, and tires are usually ruined. makes takeoff or furth er night dangerous.
If a brake shows any indication of qverheating, or if it has been in volved
in an aborted takeoff, it should be removed from the aircraft, disassembled,
and carefully inspected.
Carefull y examine the housing for cracks or warping, and give it a hard-
ness test at the points specified in the brake maintenance manual. Housings
that have been overheated may have been softened and weakened to the
extent that they are no longer airworthy. Seals that have been exposed to
excessive heat must be replaced, as the heat destroys their abi lity to seal.
Disks in multiple-disk brakes often warp when they are overheated.
Check all of the disks for warpage using the method spec ified in the brake
maintenance manual.
Gravity Bleeding
Gravity bleeding, sometimes called top-down bleeding, is done by running
the fluid from the master cylinder down through the brake cylinders. Power
brakes .can be bled only by this method.
Attach a clear plastic tube to the bleeder plug at the wheel cylinder, and
immerse the end of the tube in a container of clean hydraulic fluid. Fill the
reservoir, and slowly depress the brake pedal with the bleeder valve open.
Watch the plastic tube as you continue to slowly pumpthe master cylinder.
Continue to pump the brakes until fluid runs through the tube with no bubbles.
You may have to fil I the reservoir a time or two in this process, as a large
amount of fluid will have to be pumped through the system before all of the
air is removed.
When the fluid runs clear of all traces of air, close the bleeder plug and
remove the tube. Fill and cap the reservoir, making sure that the reservoir vent
Figure 6-46. Gravity bleeding of brakes is open.
31. A dual-disk brake is similar to a single-disk except for the additional braking area furnished by the
additional di sk and area. Page 445
32. One of the main limitations of a thin-disk multiple-disk brake is the tendency of the disks to
___________ .Page446
33. The brake linings in a segmented-rotor brake are part of the _____________ (rotor or stator). Page 447
34. In a segmented-rotor brake, the disks are squeezed between the _____________________ and the
__________________ .Page447
35. Carbon-disk brakes are ______________ (heavier or lighter) than a metal-disk brake that has the same
stopping capability. Page 448
36. The fluid in the brake wheel cylinder is vented to the atmosphere through the __________________
port in the master cy linder. Page 450
37. lf the compensator port were plugged, expansion of the Ouid in the brake lines caused by heat would cause
the brakes to . Page 450
38. The brake system that uses the aircraft hydraulic system pressure to assist the p ilot in applying force to
the piston in the brake master cylinder is called alan brake. Page 452
39. A power brake control valve is a form of pressure ________________ . Page 452
40. For maximum braking effectiveness, the w heels of an airplane should be allowed to ___________ but
not allowed to . Page 455
41. When an airplane w heel locks up on a wet runway and the tire skids across the surface of the water, the
tire is said to be . . Page 455
43. When the antiskid system is operating normally, it _____________ (is or is not) possible to land with
the brakes applied. Page 456
46. A brake debooster valve _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (increases or decreases) the volume of fluid flowing to
the brake. Page 460
48. The emergency brake system of a jet transport airplane uses _ _ _ _ _ __ _ to actuate the brakes.
Page 462
49. Two causes of disk brakes chattering or squealing are the disks being _ _ _ _ _ _ _ or
_ _ _ _ _ _ .Page 464
50. Brake cylinder seals that have been overheated should be _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . Page 463
51. Warped brake disks will cause a brake to drag. This will cause the brakes to _ _ _ _ _ _ __
Page 464
52. A brake housing can be checked for hidden damage from overheating by giving it a _ _ _ _ _ _ __
test. Page 463
Fairing
Inboard Wheel Half
diSC The inboard wheel half is fitted with steel-reinforced keys that fit into slots in
Fairing ~~c.;........-w the periphery of the brake disk to rotate the disk with the wheel. In the center
retaining
screw of the wheel, there is a wheel-bearing boss into which is shrunk a polished
steel bearing cup, or outer bearing race. A tapered roller bearing rides between
Figure 6-49. Drop-center wheel with a this cup and a bearing race on the axle. A grease retainer covers the bearing
removable outer flange and prevents dirt or water reaching the bearing surfaces.
-- -@ - -@)----
- -·-L
Grease
retainer
~
@ ""'- - Brake
-_ drive key
· -- - ----- reinforcement
Wheel Maintenance
The abuse suffered by an aircraft wheel is directly related to the care given to
the tire mounted on it. Tire care is discussed later in this chapter.
Wheel Removal
Aircraft wheels are lightweight and subjected to extremely heavy loads in
hard landings. Some of the through bolts that hold the wheel halves together
rna y have been weakened, and may break in the process of wheel disassembly.
To preclude this possibility, always deflate the tire after the aircraft is on the
della tor cap. A cap for a tire, strut. or
jack and before loosening the axle nut. High-pressure tires should be deflated
accumulator air valve that, when screwed
by screwing a deflator cap on the valve and allowing the air to escape through onto the valve, depresses the valve stem
the hole in the cap. The high-pressure air in these tires can eject the valve core and allows the air to escape safely through
at a velocity high enough to cause personal injury. After all the air is out of a hole in the side of the cap.
the tire, remove the valve core.
Wheel Inspection
Clean the wheel with varsol or naphtha and scrub away all of the loosened
deposits with a soft bristle brush. Dry the wheel with a flow of compressed air.
Inspect the entire wheel for indication of corrosion where moisture was
trapped and held in contact with the metal. If you find any corrosion, you must
dress it out by removing as little metal as is possible. After cleaning out all of
the corrosion, treat the surface to prevent new corrosion from forming.
The rotor drive keys in the wheel are subjected to a great deal of stress,
and absolutely no looseness is allowed between the drive keys and the slots
in the rotor disks. Inspect the area around the slots with dye penetrant.
You can't inspect the bead seat area of the wheel with dye penetrant,
because when the tire is removed, any cracks in this area will close up so
tightly no penetrant can seep into them. When the tire is installed and inflated,
the stresses will enlarge the cracks.lnspect these areas with eddy current equip-
ment according to the instructions furnished by the wheel manufacturer.
Examine the fusible plugs carefully for any indication of softening of the
core material that would indicate the wheel had been overheated. If there is
any indication of deformation, replace all the plugs.
When aircraft wheels are manufactured, they are statically balanced.
Balance weights are attached which must never be removed. The final bal-
ancing is done with the tire installed, and the weights used for final balanc-
ing are installed around the outside of the wheel rim or around the wheel
bolt circle.
Figure 6-5 I. Types of damage That are cause for rejectio11 of a wheel bearing
Inspect the bearing cup that is shrunk into the wheel for any of the damages
mentioned in Figure 6-51. If it is damaged, it must be replaced. Put the wheel
half in an oven whose temperature can be carefully controlled. Heat it at the
temperature specified in the wheel maintenance manual, generally no higher
than 225°F for approximately 30 minutes. Remove the wheel from the oven
and then tap the cup from its hole with a fiber drift.
Tire Installation
The installation of the tire on the wheel, final balancing, and installation of
the wheel on the aircraft are discussed in the section, "Aircraft Tires and
Tubes," beginning on Page 473.
Wheel Installation
Prepare the axle for receiving the wheel by removing any dirt or dried grease,
inspecting it for any obvious damage, and checking the axle threads for their
condition. Place the cleaned and greased bearings in the wheel and install the
grease retainers. Slide the wheel on the axle and install the brake, following
the instructions in the aircraft maintenance manual in detail.
One of the most critical items in the installation or a wheel is the torque
on the axle nut. Some smaller aircraft only require that the axle nut be in-
stalled and tightened until a slight bearing drag is obvious when the wheel is
rotated. Then back the nut off to the nearest castellation and install the cotter
pin. The manufacturers of some of the larger aircraft specify two torque val-
ues, one to seat the bearing and the other for operational torque. First, while
rotating the wheel, tighten the axle nut to the higher value to seat the bearing,
then back the nut off and retighten it to the lower torque, then safety it.
55. Most of the wheels used on modern aircraft are of the _ _ __ _ ___ (single-piece or two-piece) type.
Page 468
56. Wheels on modern high-performance airplanes are prevented from exploding from heat generated in the
brakes by installed in the inboard wheel half. Page 469
57. The most highly stressed part or an aircraft wheel is the _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ . Page 469
58. The bead seat area of a wheel is strengthened against tensile loads by prestressing the surface with a
_ _ _ _ __ ____ stress. Page 469
60. The dye penetrant method of inspection (is or is not) an effective method of inspection
for the bead seat area of a wheel. Page 470
61. The bead seat area of a wheel should be inspected by the method. Page 470
Tire Construction
Figure 6-52 is a cross-sectional drawing of a typical aircraft tire showing
its major components. This section of the text discusses each of these
components.
The Bead
bead (tire component). The high-strength The bead gives the tire the needed strength and stiffness to ensure a firm
carbon-steel wire bund les that give an mounting on the wheel. The bead is made of bundles of high-strength carbon-
aircraft tire its strength and stiffness where
it mounts on the wheel.
steel wire with two or three bead bundles on each side of the tire. Rubber apex
strips streamline the round bead bundles to allow the fabric to fit smoothly
around them without any voids. The bead bundles are enclosed in layers of
rubberized fabric , called flippers, to insulate the carcass plies from the heat
absorbed in the bead wires.
The Carcass
carcass (tir e component). T he layers of The carcass, or cord body, is the body of the tire that is made up of layers of
rubberized fabric that make up the body rubberized fabric cutin strips with the threads running at an angle of about45°
of an aircraft tire.
to the length of the strip. These strips extend completely across the tire, around
the bead, and partially up the side. Each ply is put on in such a way that the
threads cross at an angle of about 90° to that of the adjacent plies. This type
of construction is known as a bias ply tire. Radial tires, as us~d on most
automobiles, have the threads in each layer of rubberized fabric running
straight across the tire from one bead to the other.
The cords of the ply fabric were originally all cotton, then nylon became
the most popular material. And now aramid fibers , which are stronger than
nylon, polyester, or fiberglass, and even stronger, pound for pound, than steel,
are us€d in some premium-quality tires.
The ply rating of a tire is not the actual number of plies of fabric used in
the tire construction, but it indicates the number of plies of cotton fabric
needed to produce the same strength as the actual plies.
Chafing strips, or chafers, are strips of rubberi zed fabric that wrap around
the edges of the carcass plies and enclose the entire bead area. The chafing
strips provide a smooth chafe-resisting surface between the tire and the bead
seat area of the wheel.
474 A V I ATI ON M A I NTEN ANCE TECIINICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AI RFRA:vtE STRUCT CRES
The undertread is a layer of specially compounded rubber between the plies
and the tread rubber that provides good adhesion between the tread and the
carcass. Direct! yon top of the undertread are one or more plies of strong fabric
that strengthen the tread and oppose centrifugal forces that try to pull the tread
from the carcass during high-speed rotation. This tread reinforcement is not
part of the ply rating, but it is used as a guide for retreaders to show when all ply r ating. The rating of an ai rcraft tire
of the tread rubber has been removed. that indicates its relative strength. The ply
The inner liner of the carcass is a thin coating of rubber over the inside rati ng does not indicate the actual number
o f plies of fabric in the tire; rather it
plies. For tubeless tires, this inner liner is made of a special rubber compound
ind icates the number of plies of cotton
that is less permeable than the other rubber used in the tire. It seals the tire and fabric needed to p roduce the same strength
minimizes the amount of air that can seep out, so the tire can act as an air as the actual plies.
container. For tube-type tires, the inner liner is specially smooth to prevent the
tube from chafing against the inside of the tire.
The Tread
The tread is the thick rubber around the periphery of the tire that serves as its
wearing surface. The tread is made of specially compounded rubber and has
a series of grooves molded into its surface to give the optimum traction with
the runway surface.
A number of tread designs have been used on aircraft tires, but since the
vast majority of aircraft operate from paved runways, the most popular tread
is the rib tread, in which a series of straight grooves encircle the periphery of
the tire as shown in Figure 6-52.
Chafing
strips
Bead wi res
Tire Inspection
Modern aircraft tires so seldom give problems that they do not get the
attention that they deserve. Tire inspection is simple, but it is extremely
important.
Inflation
Heat is the greatest enemy of aircraft tires. Aircraft tires are designed to flex
more than automobile tires, and the heat generated as the sidewalls flex can
cause damage that is not likely to be detected until it causes the tire to fail.
The weight of the aircraft is supported by the air in the tires, and when the
air pre~sure is correct, the tire flexes only within its design limits. But if the
tire is operated with too low an inflation pressure, the sidewalls will flex
enough to generate excessive heat.
If the tire is operated in an overinflated condition, the tread will not contact
the runway as it should and the tire will have less resistance to skidding.
The proper inflation pressure for a tire is specified in the airframe service
manual, and is the pressure of the tire when it is supporting the weight of the
aircraft. Use this pressure rather than the inflation pressure specified in the tire
manufacturer's manual. The same tire used on different airplanes will have
different specified inflation pressures.
Tread Condition
Notice the touchdown area of the runway of any modern airport and you will
see that it is practically black. This is rubber left by the tires as they speed up
from zero to the touchdown speed. The tread is worn away long before the
carcass plies are dead of old age, and it is common practice to retread air-
craft tires.
The tires should be operated with proper inflation pressure and removed
for retreading while there is at least 1( 12 inch of tread at its shallowest point.
If the tire is allowed to wear beyond this, there will not be enough tread for
safe operation on a wet runway. A normally worn tread is shown in Figure
6-54A on the next page. When it is removed at this time it can safely be
retreaded.
When a tire has been worn unti l the tread is completely gone over the
carcass plies, scrap the tire. It is no longer safe to operate, and it is worn too
much to be retreaded.
When the tire has been operated in an overinflated condition, the center
of the tread will wear more than the tread on the shoulders of the tire. You can
retread a tread worn to the extent of the one shown in Figure 6-54C.
Underinflation will cause the tread to wear away from the shoulders
before it wears in the center. T his is shown in Figure 6-54D. If the carcass of
this tire has not been damaged, you can retread it.
Uneven tread wear is normally caused by the landing gear being out of
alignment. At the first indication of this type of wear, check the alignment and
correct it according to the instructions in the aircraft maintenance manual.
Sidewall Condition
The sidewall rubber protects the carcass plies from damage, either from
mechanical abrasion or from the action of chemicals or the sun. Weather
checking or small snags or cuts in the sidewall rubber that do not expose the
cords do not require removal of the tire, but if the ply cords are exposed, the
cords have probably been weakened, and tire mu st be replaced.
The liner of a tubeless tire contains the air, but some of it seeps through
the body plies, and so the sidewalls of these tires are vented to allow this air
to escape. As much as 5% of the inflation pressure of the tire is allowed to
diffuse through these vents in a 24-hour period. Sometimes these vents, which
arc located near the wheel rim, become clogged and do not adequately relieve
this air. When they are obstructed, the pressure can build up between the plies,
causing ply separation which will ruin the tire.
Tire Maintenance
The most important preventive maintenance for aircraft tires is keeping them
properly inflated and free of grease and oil. If the aircraft is to remain out of
service for an extended period of time, take the weight off the tires if possible,
and if not, move the aircraft enough to rotate the tires periodically to minimize
nylon flat-spotting that develops in all nylon tires.
Inspection
When the tire is off the wheel, you can carefully evaluate it to determine if it
can be retreaded, or if it must be scrapped.
Replace any tire that has been involved in an aborted takeoff or excess ive
braking, or has been exposed to enough heat to melt the center of a fusible plug
in the wheel. Even if the damage may not be obvious, the heat has probably
caused enough damage to make the tire unsafe for further flight.
Replace any tire that has been used in a dual installation where its mating
tire has failed, even if there is no obvious damage. The extra load placed on
the tire that did not fail can cause enough stresses to weaken it and make it
susceptible to future failure.
Spread the beads apart to examine the inside of the tire. Use an even force
to spread them to avoid kinking the bead bundles, as a kinked bead is cause
for rejecting the tire. Examine the inside of the tire for any indication of
8 Excessively worn tread. Worn down to the plies and too far gone for safe operation or retreading.
C Tire operated while overinflated. Center of tread worn more than on shoulders .
D Tire operated while underinflated. Shoulders of tread are worn more than in center.
Retreading
r etread. The replacement of the tread Repairing aircraft tires is a special operation that requires a high degree of
rubber on an aircraft tire. skill, experience, and equipment and should only be undertaken by an FAA-
certificated repair station approved for this special work.
Advisory Circular 43.13-lB, Acceptable Methods, Techniques, and Prac-
tices- Aircraft Tnspection and Repair lists a number of items that definitely
render a tire unfit for retreading, and much time and expense can be saved
by carefully inspecting the tire before sending it to a repair station for retread-
ing. These damages render a tire irreparable:
• Breaks caused by flexing. Flexing damage is often the visible evidence of
other damage that may not be visible.
• Any injury to the bead of a tubeless tire that would prevent the tire from
sealing to the wheel
• Evidence of separation of the plies or around the bead wires
• Kinked or broken beads
• Weather cracks or radial cracks in the sidewall that extend into the cord
body
• Eviq_ence of blisters or heat damage
• Cracked, deteriorated, or damaged inner liner of tubeless tires
Storage
A ircraft tires and tubes are susceptibl e to damage from heat, sunlight, and ozone. A n unstable form of oxygen
ozone. They should be stored in an area that is not in the direct sunlight nor produced when an electric spark passes
in the vici nity of fluorescent lights or such electric machinery as motors, throug h the air. Ozone is harmfu l to ru bber
products.
generators, and battery chargers. A II these devices convert oxygen into ozone,
which is extremely harmful to rubber. T he temperature in the storage area
should be maintained between 32°F and 80°F (0°C and 27°C).
The storage area should be free from chemical fumes, and petroleum
products such as oil , grease, and hydraulic fluid must not be allowed to come
in contact with stored rubber products.
The tires shou ld be stored vertically when possible in tire racks, with the
tires supported on a nat surface which is at least three or four inches wide. If
it is necessary to store them hmizontally, do not stack them more than three
to five tires hi gh, depending on their sjze. When tubeless tires are stacked
horizontally, the tires on the bottom of the stack may be distorted so much that
a special bead-seating tool is needed to force the beads to seat on the wheel.
Mounting
The wheels installed on most modern airplanes are of the two-piece, split type
which makes tire mounting and demounting far eas ier than it is with a single-
piece drop-center wheel. Wheels are highly stressed components and, like all
critical maintenance, mounting tires req ui res that all of the ai rcraft
manufacturer's instructions be followed in detail , especially those regarding
lu brication, bolt torque, and balancing.
Balancing
Aircraft wheels are balanced when they are manufactured, and tires arc
marked with a red dot to identify their light point. The tire is assembled on the
wheel with its light point opposite the valve or other mark identifying the
heavy point of the wheel. This approximately balances the wheel and tire, but
a balancing stand is needed to get the degree of balance that will prevent the
wheel from vibrating.
Place the wheel on a balancing stand and identify its light point. Then
mark two spots 45° from this light point and place balance weights on these
points that will bring the wheel into balance.
Three types of weights are used on aircraft wheels; one type is installed
on brackets held under the head of the wheel through bolts, another type
mounts on steel straps and is held onto the wheel rim with cotter pins, and the
other is in the form of a lead strip attached to the inside of the wheel rim with
its adhesive backing. Be sure that only the type of weight that is approved for
the wheel is used.
62. An aircraft tire is des igned to flex, or deflect, _ _ _ _ __ (more or less) than an automobile or truck
tire. Page 473
64. A four-ply rating tire _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (does or does not) necessarily have four plies of fabric.
Page 475
65. The bundles of hi gh-strength steel wires that are molded into a tire are called the _ __ _ __
Page 474
66. The threads in the plies of a tire cross the threads in adjacent plies at an angle of approximately
_ __ _ _ degrees. Page 474
67. The inner liner of a tubeless tire is _ _ ______ (smoother or rougher) than that used in a tube-
type tire. Page 476
68. The tread design used on most modern aircraft tires is the _ __ ___ tread. Page 475
69 . Nose wheel tires used on jet airplanes with engines mounted on the aft fuse lage have a
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ or mo lded into their outer sidewall. Page 476
70. Small holes in the sidewall of a tubeless tire are called _ _ _ _ __ holes. Page 476
-
7 1. T he correct tire inflation pressure to use is that which is recommended in the _ _ _ _ __ __
(aircraft or tire) manufacturer's service manual. Page 476
72. The tire infl ation pressure specified by the aircraft manufacturer is the pressure in the tire when the tire
_ _ _ _ _ (is or is not) supporting the weight of the aircraft. Page 476
73. The inflation pressure of a tire should not be measured until the tire has been able to cool down for
_ _ _ _ _ to hours after fli ght. Page 477
Continued
74. The most accurate type of pressure gage to use for measuring tire inflation pressure is a _ _ _ _ __
-type gage. Page 477
75. The air pressure inside a tire changes with the temperature. The pressure will increase approximately 1%
for each °F rise in temperature. Page 477
76. Inflation pressure will increase by approximately _ _ _ __ -% when the weight of the aircraft is on the
tire. Page 477
77. The inflation pressure of newly mounted nylon tires will decrease within the first day or so in service. This
decrease is caused by the tire . Page 477
78. Tires should be removed for retreading when the tread groove wears to a depth of _____ inch at the
shallowest point. Page 477
79. A tire with the tread worn more in the middle than on the shoulders has been operated
_ _ _ _ _ _ __ __ (underinflated or overinflated). Page 477
80. A tire with the tread worn more on the shoulders than in the middle has been operated
_ __ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (underinflated or overinflated). Page 477
81. Some air is allowed to seep through the inner lining of a tubeless tire and escape through vents in the
sidewall rubber. As much as % of the inflation pressure is allowed to seep out in a 24-hour
period. Page 478
82. A burned area on a tire tread that indicates the tire has been hydroplaning _ _ _ _ _ (is or is not) cause
for removing the tire. Page 478
83. A tire should be removed from service if a cut extends across more than _ ____ of the width of a
tread rib. Page 478
84. A shop tool that may be used to break a tire bead away from the wheel is alan _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
Page 470
85. A tire that has been involved in an aborted takeoff _ _ _ _ __ _ (is or is not) safe for continued use.
Page 478
86. A tire in a dual installation whose mate has failed should be _ _ __ _ _ _ _ . Page 478
486 AVI ATION MAINTENANCE TECHNICIAN SERIES Volume 1: AIRFRAME STRUCTU RES
87. A kinked bead in a tire _ _ _ _ _ (is or is not) a cause for rejecting the tire. Page 480
88. Exposed ply cords in the sidewall of an aircraft tire _ _ __ _ (is or is not) cause for rejection of the
tire. Page 480
89. The FAA _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ (does or does not) specify the number of times an aircraft tire can be
retreaded. Page 481
91. The red dot on an aircraft tire identifies the _ _ _ _ _ _ (light or heavy) point of the tire. Page 483
92. The yellow mark on an aircraft tube identifies the _ _ __ __ (light or heavy) point of the tube.
Page 483
93. The valve of an aircraft tube should stick out on the side of the tire that _ _ _ _ _ _ (does or does not)
have the serial number. Page 483
94. The only lubricant approved for use between a tube and a tire is _ _ _ _ __ _ _ _ . Page 483
95. When a retreaded tire is installed on an airpl ane with a retractable landing gear, a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __
test should be performed on the airplane. Page 485
aborted takeoff. A takeoff that is terminated prematurely when adverse yaw. A condition of flight at the beginning of a turn
it is determined that some condition exists that makes take- in which the nose of an airplane momentarily yaws in the
off or further flight dangerous. opposite direction from the direction in which the turn is
absolute pressure regulator. A valve used in a pneumatic to be made.
system at the pump inlet to regulate the compressor inlet aeroelastic tailoring. The design of an aerodynamic surface
air pressure to prevent excessive speed variation and/or whose strength and stiffness are matched to the aerody-
overspeeding of the compressor. namic loads that will be imposed upon it.
accumulator. A hydraulic component that consists of two aging. A change in the characteristics of a material with time.
compartments separated by a movable component such Certain aluminum alloys do not have their full strength
as a piston, diaphragm, or bladder. One compartment is when they arc first removed from the quench bath after
filled with compressed air or nitrogen, and the other is they have been heat-treated, but they gain this strength
filled with hydraulic fluid and is connected into the sys- after a few days by the natural process of aging.
tem pressure manifold. airfoil. Any surface designed to obtain a useful reaction, or
An accumulator allows an incompressible fluid to be lift, from air passing over it.
stored under pressure by the force produced by a com-
pressible fluid. Its primary purposes are to act as a shock Alclad. A registered trade name for clad aluminum alloy.
absorber in the system, and to provide a source of addi- Alodine. The registered trade name for a popular conversion
tional hydraulic power when heavy demands are placed coating chemical used to produce a hard, airtight, oxide
on the system. film on aluminum alloy for conosion protection.
accumulator air preload. Compressed air or nitrogen in one amphibian. An airplane with landing gear that allows it to
side of an accumulator. The air preload is usually about operate from both water and land surfaces.
one third of the system hydraulic pressure. When lluid is angle of attack (a). The acute angle formed between the chord
pumped into the oil side of the accumulator, the air is line of an airfoil and the direction of the air that strikes
further compressed, and the air pressure and the fluid pres- the airfoil.
sure become the same.
If an air preload pressure is too low, there will be angle of incidence. The acute angle formed between the chord
almost no time between the regulator reaching its kick-in line of an airfoil and the longitudinal axis of the aircraft
and kick-out pressures, and the system wi11 cycle far more on which it is mounted.
frequently than it should. annual rings. The rings that appear in the end of a log cut
The amount of air preload is found by reducing the from a tree. The number of annual rings per inch gives an
hydraulic pressure to zero and observing the reading on indication of the strength of the wood. The more rings
the accumulator air gage. If there is no air gage, slowly there are and the closer they are together, the stronger
bleed the hydraulic pressure off the system while watch- the wood.
ing the hydraulic pressure gage. The pressure will drop The pattern of alternating light and dark rings is
slowly, until a point is reached at which it drops suddenly. caused by the seasonal variations in the growth rate of
This point is the air preload pressure. the tree. A tree grows quickly in the spring and produces
advancing blade. The blade on a helicopter rotor whose tip is the light-colored, less dense rings. The slower growth
moving in the same direction the helicopter is moving. during the summer, or latter part of the growing season,
produces the dark-colored, denser rings.
GLOSSARY- 1
anodizing. The electrolytic process in which a hard, airtight, automatic adjuster. A subsystem in an aircraft disk brake
oxide film is deposited on aluminum alloy for corrosion that compensates for disk or lining wear. Each time the
protection. brakes are applied, the automatic adjuster is reset for zero
antidrag wire. A structural wire inside a Pratt truss airplane clearance, and when the brakes are released, the clear-
wing between the spars. Antidrag wires run from the ance between the disks or the disk and lining is returned
rear spar inboard, to the front spar at the next bay out- to a preset value.
board. Antidrag wires oppose the forces that try to pull A malfunctioning automatic adjuster in a multiple-
the wing forward. disk brake can cause sluggish and jerky operation.
anti-icer system. A system that prevents the formation of ice autorotation. Descent of a helicopter without the use of
on an aircraft structure. engine power. An aerodynamic force causes the rotors to
rotate.
antiservo tab. A tab installed on the trailing edge of a stabila-
tor to make it less sensitive. The tab automatically moves aviation snips. Compound-action hand shears used for cut-
in the same direction as the stabilator to produce an aero- ting sheet metal. Aviation snips come in sets of three.
dynamic force that tries to bring the surface back to a One pair cuts to the left, one pair cuts to the right, and the
streamline position. This tab is also called an anti- third pair of snips cuts straight.
balance tab.
backhand welding. Welding in which the torch is pointed
antiskid brake system. An electrohydraulic system in an away from the direction the weld is progressing.
airplane's power brake system that senses the decelera-
tion rate of every main landing gear wheel. If any wheel backplate (brake component). A floating plate on which
decelerates too rapidly, indicating an impending skid, pres- the wheel cylinder and the brake shoes attach on an
sure to that brake is released and the wheel stops deceler- energizing-type brake.
ating. Pressure is then reapplied at a slightly lower value. backup ring. A flat leather or Teflon ring installed in the
antitear strip. Strips of aircraft fabric laid under the reinforc- groove in which an 0-ring orT-seal is placed. The backup
ing tape before the fabric is stitched to an aircraft wing. ring is on the side of the seal away from the pressure, and
it prevents the pressure extruding the seal between the
arbor press. A press with either a mechanically or hydrauli- piston and the cylinder wall.
cally operated ram used in a maintenance shop for a vari-
ety of pressing functions. balance cable. A cable in the aileron system of an airplane
that connects to one side of each aileron. When the con-
area. The number of square units in a surface. trol wheel is rotated, a cable from the cockpit pulls one
aspect ratio. The ratio of the length, or span, of an airplane aileron down and relaxes the cable going to the other ai-
wing to its width, or chord. For a nonrectangular wing, leron. The balance cable pulls the other aileron up.
the aspect ratio is found by dividing the square of the balance panel. A flat panel hinged to the leading edge of some
span of the wing by its area. Aspect Ratio = span 2 + area ailerons that produces a force which assists the pilot in
asymmetrical airfoil. An airfoil section that is not the same holding the ailerons deflected. The balance panel divides
on both sides of the chord line. a chamber ahead of the aileron in such a way that when
asymmetrical lift. A condition of uneven lift produqed by the the aileron is deflected downward, for example, air tlow-
rotor when a helicopter is in forward flight. Asymmetri- ing over its top surface produces a low pressure that acts
cal lift is caused by the difference between the airspeed on the balance panel and causes it to apply an upward
of the advancing blade and that of the retreating blade. force to the aileron leading edge.
autoclave. A pressure vessel inside of which air can be heated balance tab. An adjustable tab mounted on the trailing edge
to a high temperature and pressure raised to a high value. of a control surface to produce a force that aids the pilot
Autoclaves are used in the composite manufacturing in moving the surface. The tab is automatically actuated
industry to apply heat and pressure for curing resins. in such a way it moves in the direction opposite to the
direction the control surface on which it is mounted moves.
autogiro. A heavier-than-air rotor-wing aircraft sustained in
the air by rotors turned by aerodynamic forces rather than balanced actuator. A linear hydraulic or pneumatic actuator
by engine power. When the name Autogiro is spelled with that has the same area on each side of the piston.
a capital A, it refers to a specific series of machines built banana oil. Nitrocellulose dissolved in amyl acetate, so named
by Juan de Ia Cierva or his successors. because it smells like bananas.
GLOSSARY- 3
buttock line. A line used to locate a position to the right or check (wood defect). Longitudinal cracks that extend, in gen-
left of the center line of an aircraft structure. eral, across a log's annual rings.
Butyl. The trade name for a synthetic rubber product made by check valve. A hydraulic or pneumatic system component that
the polymerization of isobutylene. allows full !low of tluid in one direction but blocks all
Butyl withstands such potent chemicals as phosphate flow in the opposite direction.
ester-base (Skydrol) hydraulic fluids. chevron seal. A form of one-way seal used in some fluid-
power actuators. A chevron seal is made of a resilient
calender (fabric treatment). To pass fabric through a series material whose cross section is in the shape of the letter
of heated rollers to give it a smooth shiny surface. V. The pressure being sealed must be applied to the open
camber (wheel alignment). The amount the wheels of an air- side of the V.
craft are tilted, or inclined, from the vertical. If the top of circle. A closed plane figure with every point an equal dis-
the wheel tilts outward, the camber is positive. Ifthe top tance from the center. A circle has the greatest area for its
of the wheel tilts inward, the camber is negative. circumference of any enclosed shape.
canard. A horizontal control surface mounted ahead of the clad aluminum. A sheet of aluminum alloy that has a coating
wing to provide longitudinal stability and control. of pure aluminum rolled on one or both of its surfaces for
cantilever wing. A wing that is supported by its internal struc- corrosion protection.
ture and requires no external supports. The wing spars Cleco fastener. A patented spring-type fastener used to hold
arc built in such a way that they carry all the bending and metal sheets in position until they can be permanently
torsional loads. riveted together.
cap strip. The main top and bottom members of a wing rib. close-quarter iron. A small hand-held iron with an accurately
The cap strips give the rib its aerodynamic shape. calibrated thermostat. This iron is used for heat-shrink-
carburizing flame. An oxyacetylene flame produced by an ing polyester fabrics in areas that would be difficult to
excess of acetylene. This flame is identified by a feather work with a large iron.
around the inner cone. A carburizing flame is also called closed angle. An angle formed in sheet metal that has been
a reducing flame. bent through more than 90°.
carcass (tire component). The layers of rubberized fabric that closed assembly time. The time elapsing between the assem-
make up the body of an aircraft tire. bly of glued joints and the application of pressure.
case pressure. A low pressure that is maintained inside the closed-center hydraulic system. A hydraulic system in which
case of a hydraulic pump. If a seal becomes damaged, the selector valves are installed in parallel with each other.
hydraulic fluid will be forced out of the pump rather than When no unit is actuated, fluid circulates from the pump
allowing air to be drawn into the pump. back to the reservoir without flowing through any of the
cavitation. A condition that exists in a hydraulic pump when selector valves.
there is not enough pressure in the reservoir to force fluid closed-center selector valve. A type of flow-control valve
to the inlet of the pump. The pump picks up air instead used to direct pressurized fluid into one side of an actua-
of tluid. tor, and at the same time, direct the return fluid from the
center of gravity. The location on an aircraft about which the other side of the actuator to the fluid reservoir.
force of gravity is concentrated. Closed-center selector valves are connected in paral-
center of lift. The location on the chord line of an airfoil at lel between the pressure manifold and the return manifold.
which all the lift forces produced by the airfoil are con- coaxial. Rotating about the same axis. Coaxial rotors of a he-
sidered to be concentrated. licopter are mounted on concentric shafts in such a way
center of pressure. The point on the chord line of an airfoil that they turn in opposite directions to cancel torque.
where all of the aerodynamic forces are considered to be coefficient of drag. A dimensionless number used in the for-
concentrated. mula for determining induced drag as it relates to the angle
chatter. A type ofrapid vibration of a hydraulic pump caused of attack.
by the pump taking in some air along with the hydraulic coefficient of lift. A dimensionless number relating to the angle
fluid. of attack used in the formula for aerodynamic lift.
compensator port (brake system component). A small hole constant (mathematical). A value used in a mathematical
between a hydraulic brake master cylinder and the reser- computation that is the same every time it is used.
voir. When the brakes are released, this port is uncov- For example, the relationship between the length of
ered and the fluid in the master cylinder is vented to the the circumference of a circle and the length of its diam-
reservoir. eter is a constant. 3.1416. This constant is called by the
When the brake is applied. the master-cylinder pis- Greek name of pi (n).
ton covers the compensator port and allows pressure in constant-displacement pump. A fluid pump that moves a
the line to the brake to build up and apply the brakes. specific volume of fluid each time it rotates: the faster the
When the brake is released, the piston uncovers the com- pump turns, the more fluid it moves.
pensator port. If any fluid has been lost from the brake. Some form of pressure regulator or relief valve must
the reservoir will refill the master cylinder. be used with a constant-displacement pump when it is
A restricted compensator port will cause the brakes driven by an aircraft engine.
to drag or cause them to be slow to release. controllability. The characteristic of an aircraft that allows it
composite. Something made up of different materials com- to change its flight attitude in response to the pilot's move-
bined in such a way that the characteristics of the result- ment of the cockpit controls.
ing material are different from those of any of the com- control stick. The type of control device used in some air-
ponents. planes. A vertical stick in the cockpit controls the aile-
compound curve. A curve formed in more than one plane. rons by side-to-side movement and the elevators by fore-
The surface of a sphere is a compound curve. and-aft movement.
compressibility effect. The sudden increase in the total drag control yoke. The movable column on which an airplane con-
of an airfoil in transonic flight caused by formation of trol wheel is mounted. The yoke may be moved in or out
shock waves on the surface. to actuate the elevators, and the control wheel may be
compression failure. A type of structural failure in wood rotated to actuate the ailerons.
caused by the application of too great a compressive load. converging duct. A duct, or passage, whose cross-sectional
A compression failure shows up as a faint line running at area decreases in the direction of fluid flow.
right angles to the grain of the wood. convex surface. A surface that is curved outward. The outer
compression strut. A heavy structural member, often in the edges arc lower than the center.
form of a steel tube, used to hold the spars of a Pratt truss Coriolis effect. The change in rotor blade velocity to com-
airplane wing apart. A compression strut opposes the com- pensate for a change in the distance between the center of
pressive loads between the spars arising from the tensile mass of the rotor blade and the axis rotation of the blade
loads produced by the drag and antidrag wires. as the blades flap in flight.
compression wood. A defect in wood that causes it to have a cornice brake. A large shop tool used to make straight bends
high specific gravity and the appearance of an excessive across a sheet of metal. Cornice brakes are often called
growth of summerwood. In most species, there is little leaf brakes.
difference between the color of the springwood and
summerwood. corrugated metal. Sheets of metal that have been made more
Any material containing compression wood is un- rigid by forming a series of parallel ridges or waves in its
suited for aircraft structural use and must be rejected. surface.
concave surface. A surface that is curved inward. The outer cotter pin. A split metal pin used to safety a castellated or
edges are higher than the center. slotted nut on a bolt. The pin is passed through the hole in
the shank of the bolt and the slots in the nut, and the ends
of the pin are spread to prevent it backing out of the hole.
GLOSSARY- 5
countersinking. Preparation of a rivet hole for a flush rivet deciduous. A type of tree that sheds its foliage at the end of the
by beveling the edges of the holes with a cutter of the growing season. Hardwoods come from deciduous trees.
correct angle. deflator cap. A cap for a tire, strut, or accumulator air valve
Coverite surface thermometer. A small surface-type bime- that, when screwed onto the valve, depresses the valve
ta11ic thermometer that calibrates the temperature of an stem and allows the air to escape safely through a hole in
iron used to heat-shrink polyester fabrics. the side of the cap.
crazing. A form of stress-caused damage that occurs in a trans- deicer system. A system that removes ice after it has formed
parent thermoplastic material. Crazing appears as a se- on an aircraft.
ries of tiny, hair-like cracks just below the surface of the delamination. The separation of the layers of a laminated
plastic. material.
critical Mach number. The flight Mach number at which there delta airplane. An airplane with a triangular-shaped wing.
is the first indication of supersonic airflow over any part This wing has an extreme amount of sweepback on its
of the aircraft structure. leading edge, and a trailing edge that is almost perpen-
cross coat. A double coat of aircraft finishing material in which dicular to the longitudinal axis of the airplane.
the second coat is sprayed at right angles to the first coat, denier. A measure of the fineness of the yarns in a fabric.
before the solvents have evaporated from the first coat.
density altitude. The altitude in standard air at which the den-
cross~ flow valve. An automatic flow-control valve installed sity is the same as that of the existing air.
between the gear-up and gear-down lines of the landing
gear of some large airplanes. density ratio (a). The ratio of the density of the air at a given
When the landing gear is released from its uplocks, altitude to the density of the air at sea level under stan-
its weight causes it to fall faster than the hydraulic sys- dard conditions.
tem can supply fluid to the gear-down side of the actua- desiccant (air conditioning component). A drying agent used
tion cylinder. The cross-flow valve opens and directs fluid in an air conditioning system to remove water from the
from the gear-up side into the gear-down side. This al- refrigerant. A desiccant is made of silica-gel or some simi-
lows the gear to move down with a smooth motion. lar material.
Cuno filter. The registered trade name for a particular style differential aileron travel. Aileron movement in which the
of edge-type fluid filter. upward-moving aileron deflects a greater distance than
Cuno filters arc made up of a stack of thin metal disks the one moving downward. The up aileron produces para-
that are separated by thin scraper blades. Contaminants site drag to counteract the induced drag caused by the
collect on the edge of the disks, and they are periodically down aileron.
scraped out and allowed to collect in the bottom of the Differential aileron travel is used to counteract ad-
filter case for future removal. verse yaw.
cusp. A pointed end. dihedral. The positive angle formed between the lateral axis
of an airplane and a line that passes through the center of
Dacron. The registered trade name for a cloth woven from the wing or horizontal stabilizer. Dihedral increases the
polyester fibers. lateral stability of an airplane.
damped oscillation. Oscillation whose amplitude decreases dirigible. A large, cigar-shaped, rigid, lighter-than-air flying
with time. machine. Dirigibles are made of a rigid truss structure
debooster valve. A valve in a power brake system between covered with fabric. Gas bags inside the structure contain
the power brake control valve and the wheel cylinder. the lifting gas. which is either helium or hydrogen.
This valve lowers the pressure of the fluid going to the disc area (helicopter specification). The total area swept by
brake and increases its volume. the blades of a helicopter main rotor.
A debooster valve increases the smoothness of brake divergent oscillation. Oscillation whose amplitude increases
application and aids in rapid release of the brakes. with time.
decay. Decomposition. The breakdown of the structure of diverging duct. A duct, or passage, whose cross-sectional area
wood fibers. Wood that shows any indication of decay increases in the direction of fluid flow.
must be rejected for use in aircraft structure.
GLOSSARY -7
FAA FSDO. Federal Aviation Administration Flight Standards fitting. An attachment device that is used to connect compo-
District Office. An FAA field office serving an assigned nents to an aircraft structure.
geographical area staffed with Flight Standards person- flap (aircraft control). A secondary control on an airplane
nel who serve the aviation industry and the general pub- wing that changes its camber to increase both its lift and
lic on matters relating to certification and operation of air its drag,
carrier and general aviation aircraft.
flap (helicopter rotor blade movement). Up-and-down
fading of brakes. The decrease in the amount of braking ac- movement of the tip of a helicopter rotor blade.
tion that occurs with some types of brakes that are ap-
plied for a long period of time. flap overload valve. A valve in the flap system of an airplane
True fading occurs with overheated drum-type that prevents the flaps being lowered at an airspeed which
brake~. As the drum is heated, it expands in a bell-mouthed
could cause structural damage. If the pilot tries to extend
fashion. This decreases the amount of drum in contact the flaps when the airspeed is too high, the opposition
with the brake shoes and decreases the braking action. caused by the airtluw will open the overload valve and
A condition similar to brake fading occurs when there return the fluid to the reservoir.
is an internal leak in the brake master cylinder. The brakes flat pattern layout. The pattern for a sheet metal part that has
are applied, but as the pedal is held down, fluid leaks past the material used for each flat surface, and for all of the
the piston, and the brakes slowly release. bends, marked out with bend-tangent hnes drawn between
fairlead. A plastic or wooden guide used to prevent a steel the flats and bend allowances.
control cable rubbing against an aircraft structure. fluid. A form of material whose molecules are able to flow
feather (helicopter rotor blade movement). Rotation of a past one another without destroying the material. Gases
helicopter rotor blade about its pitch-change axis. and liquids arc both fluids.
ferrous metal. Any metal that contains iron and has magnetic fluid power. The transmission of force by the movement of
characteristics. a fluid. The most familiar examples of fluid power sys-
tems arc hydraulic and pneumatic systems.
fiber stop nut. A form of self-locking nut that has a fiber
insert crimped into a recess above the threads. The hole flutter. Rapid and uncontrolled oscillation of a flight control
in the insert is slightly smaller than the minor diameter of surface on an aircraft that is caused by a dynamically un-
the threads. When the nut is screwed down over the bolt balanced condition.
threads, the opposition caused by the fiber insert produces fly-by-wire. A method of control used by some modem air-
a force that prevents vibration loosening the nut. craft in which control movement or pressures exerted by
file. A hand-held cutting tool used to remove a small amount the pilot are directed into a digital computer where they
of metal with each stroke. are input into a program tailored to the flight. characteris-
tics of the aircraft. The computer output signal is sent to
fill threads. Threads in a piece of fabric that run across the actuators at the control surfaces to move them the opti-
width of the fabric, interweaving with the warp threads. mum amount for the desired maneuver.
Fill threads are often called woof. or weft, threads.
flying boat. An airplane whose fuselage is built in the form
fillet. A fairing used to give shape but not strength to an ob- of a boat huH to a11ow it to land and takeoff from water,
ject. A fillet produces a smooth junction wheFe two sur- In the past, flying boats were a popular form of large
faces meet. airplane.
finishing tape. Another name for surface tape. See surface tape. foot-pound. A measure of work accomplished when a force
fishmouth splice. A type of splice used in a welded tubular of I pound moves an object a distance of I foot.
structure in which the end of the tube whose inside diam- force. Energy brought to bear on an object that tends to cause
eter is the same as the outside diameter of the tube being motion or to change motion.
spliced is cut in the shape of a V, or a fishmouth, and is
slipped over the smaller tube and welded, A fishmouth forehand welding. Welding in which the torch is pointed in
splice has more weld area than a butt splice and allows the direction the weld is progressing.
the stresses from one tube to transfer into the other tube form drag. Parasite drag caused by the fmm of the object
gradually, passing through the air.
GLOSSARY- 9
hydraulic motor. A hydraulic actuator that converts fluid jackscrew. A hardened steel rod with strong threads cut into
pressure into rotary motion. it. A jackscrew is rotated by hand or with a motor to ap-
Hydraulic motors have an advantage in aircraft in- ply a force or to lift an object.
stallations over electric motors, because they can operate joggle. A small offset near the edge of a piece of sheet metal.
in a stalled condition without the danger of a fire. It allows one sheet of metal to overlap another sheet while
hydraulic power pack. A small, self-contained hydraulic sys- maintaining a flush surface.
tem that consists of a reservoir, pump, selector valves, jointer. A woodworking power tool used to smooth the edges
and relief valves. The power pack is removable from the of a piece of wood.
aircraft as a unit to facilitate maintenance and service.
hydraulics. The system of fluid power which transmits force K-factor. A factor used in sheet metal work to determine the
through an incompressible fluid. setback for other than a 90° bend.
hydroplaning. A condition that exists when a high-speed air- Setback= K ·(bend radius+ metal thickness).
plane is landed on a water-covered runway. When the For bends of less than 90° the value of K is less than I;
brakes are applied, the wheels lock up and the tires skid for bends greater than 90° the value of K is greater than I.
on the surface of the water in much the same way a water Kevlar. A patented synthetic aramid fiber noted for its flex-
ski rides on the surface. Hydroplaning develops enough ibility and light weight. It is to a great extent replacing
heat in a tire to ruin it. fiberglass as a reinforcing fabric for composite construc-
hypersonic speed. Speed of greater than Mach 5 (5 times the tion.
speed of sound). kick-in pressure. The pressure at which an unloading valve
causes a hydraulic pump to direct its fluid into the system
ICAO. The International Civil Aeronautical Organization. manifold.
icebox rivet. A solid rivet made of 2017 or 2024 aluminum kick-out pressure. The pressure at which an unloading valve
alloy. These rivets are too hard to drive in the condition shuts off the flow of fluid into the system pressure mani-
they are received from the factory, and must be heat- fold and directs it back to the reservoir under a much re-
treated to soften them. They are heated in a furnace and duced pressure.
then quenched in cold water. Immediately after quench- kilogram. One thousand grams.
ing they are soft, but within a few hours at room tempera-
ture they become quite hard. The hardening can be de- kinetic energy. Energy that exists because of motion.
layed for several days by storing them in a subfreezing knot (wood defect). A hard, usually round section of a tree
icebox and holding them at this low temperature until they branch embedded in a board. The grain ofthe knot is per-
are to be used. pendicular to the grain of the board.
inch-pound. A measure of work accomplished when a force Knots decrease the strength of the board and should
of 1 pound moves an object a distance of 1 inch. be avoided where strength is needed.
induced drag. Aerodynamic drag produced by an airfoil when knot (measure of speed). A speed measurement that is equal
it is producing lift. Induced drag is affected by the same to one nautical mile per hour. One knot is equal to 1.15
factors that affect induced lift. statute mile per hour.
induction time. The time allowed an epoxy or polyurethane Koroseallacing. A plastic lacing material available in round
material between its initial mixing and its application. This or rectangular cross sections and used for holding wire
time allows the materials to begin their cure. bundles and tubing together. It holds tension on knots in-
definitely and is impervious to petroleum products.
ingot. A large block of metal that was molded as it was poured
from the furnace. Ingots are further processed into sheets, kraft paper. A tough brown wrapping paper like that used
bars, tubes, or structural beams. for paper bags.
interference drag. Parasite drag caused by air flowing over lacquer. A finishing material made of a film base, solvents,
one portion of the airframe intetfering with the smooth plasticizers, and thinners. The film base fonns a tough
flow of air over another portion. film over the surface when it dries. The solvents dissolve
the 111m base so it can be applied as a liquid. The plasti-
GLOSSARY - 11
mist coat. A very light coat of zinc chromate primer. It is so nap of the fabric. The ends of the fibers in a fabric. The first
thin that the metal is still visible, but the primer makes coat of dope on cotton or linen fabric raises the nap, and
pencil marks easy to see. the fiber ends slick up. These ends must be carefully re-
moisture separator. A component in a high-pressure pneu- moved by sanding to get a smooth finish.
matic system that removes most of the water vapor from naphtha. A volatile and flammable hydrocarbon liquid used
the compressed air. chiefly as a solvent or as a cleaning fluid.
When the compressed air is used, its pressure drops, neutral axis (neutral plane). A line through a piece of mate-
and this pressure drop causes a drop in temperature. If rial that is bent. The material in the outside of the bend is
any moisture were allowed to remain in the air, it would stretched and that on the inside of the bend is shrunk. The
freeze and block the system. material along the neutral plane is neither shrunk nor
mold 1ine. A line used in the development of a flat pattern for stretched.
a formed piece of sheet metal. The mold line is an exten- neutral flame. An oxyacetylene t1ame produced when the ratio
sion of the flat side of a part beyond the radius. The mold of oxygen and acetylene is chemically correct and there
line dimension of a part is the dimension made to the in- is no excess of oxygen or carbon. A neutral flame has a
tersection of mold lines and is the dimension the part rounded inner cone and no feather around it.
would have if its corners had no radius.
Nomex. A patented nylon material used to make the honey-
mold point. The intersection oftwo mold Jines of a part. Mold comb core for certain types of sandwich materials.
line dimensions are made between mold points.
nonenergizing brake. A brake that docs not use the momen-
moment. A force that causes or tries to cause an object to tum of the aircraft to increase the friction.
rotate. The value of a moment is the product of the weight
of an object (or the force). multiplied by the distance be- normal shock wave. A shock wave that forms ahead of a
tween the center of gravity of the object (or the point of blunt object moving through the air at the speed of sound.
application of the force) and the fulcrum about which the The shock wave is normal (perpendicular) to the air ap-
object rotates. proaching the object.
Air passing through a normal shock wave is slowed
Monel. An alloy of nickel, copper, and aluminum or silicon. to a ~ubsonic speed and its static pressure is increased.
monocoque. A single-shell type of aircraft structure in which normalizing. A process of strain-relieving steel that has been
all of the flight loads arc carried in the outside skin of the welded and left in a strained condition. The steel is heated
structure. to a specified temperature, usually red hot, and allowed
MSDS. Material Safety Data Sheets. MSDS are required by to cool in still air to room temperature.
the Federal Government to be available in workplaces to nose-gear centering cam. A cam in the nose-gear shock strut
inform workers of the dangers that may exist from con- that causes the piston to center when the strut fully ex-
tact with certain materials. tends. When the aircraft takes off and the strut extends,
multiple-disk brakes. Aircraft brakes in which one set of disks the wheel is straightened in its fore-and-aft position so it
is keyed to the axle and remains stationary. Between each can be retracted into the wheel well.
stationary disk there is a rotating disk that is keyed to the
inside of the wheel. When the brakes arc applied, the sta- oblique shock wave. A shock wave that forms on a sharp-
tionary disks are forced together, clamping the rotating pointed object moving through the air at a speed greater
disks between them. The friction between the disks slows than the speed of sound. Air passing through an oblique
the aircraft. shock wave is slowed down, but not to a subsonic speed,
and its static pressure is increased.
nailing strip. A method of applying pressure to the glue in a oleo shock absorber. A shock absorber used on aircraft land-
scarf joint repair in a plywood skin. A strip of thin ply- ing gear. The initial landing impact is absorbed by oil trans-
wood is nailed over the glued scarf joint with the nails ferring from one compartment in the shock strut into an-
extending into a supporting structure beneath the skin. other compartment through a metering orifice. The shocks
The strip is installed over vinyl sheeting to prevent it stick- of taxiing are taken up by a cushion of compressed air.
ing to the skin. When the glue is thoroughly dry, the nail-
ing strip is broken away and the nails removed. open angle. An angle in which sheet metal is bent less than
goo.
GLOSSARY- 13
ply rating. The rating of an aircraft tire that indicates its rela- precipitation heat treatment. A method of increasing the
tive strength. The ply rating does not indicate the actual strength of heat-treated aluminum alloy. After the alumi-
number of plies of fabric in the tire; rather it indicates the num alloy has been solution-heat-treated by heating and
number of plies of cotton fabric needed to produce the quenching, it is returned to the oven and heated to a tem-
same strength as the actual plies. perature lower than that used for the initial heat treatment.
plywood. A wood product made by gluing several pieces of It is held at this temperature for a specified period of time
thin wood veneertogether. The grain ofthe wood in each and then removed from the oven and allowed to cool slowly.
layer runs at 90° or 45° to the grain of the layer next to it. prepreg. Preimpregnated fabric. A type of composite mate-
pneumatics. The system of fluid power which transmits force rial in which the reinforcing Ebers are encapsulated in an
by the use of a compressible fluid. uncured resin. Prcpreg materials must be kept refriger-
ated to prevent them from curing before they are used.
polyester fibers. A synthetic fiber made by the polymeriza-
tion process in which tiny molecules are united to form a pressure. Force per unit area. Hydraulic and pneumatic pres-
long chain of molecules. sure are normally given in units of pounds per square
Polyester fibers are woven into fabrics that are known inch (psi).
by their trade names of Dacron, Fortrel, and Kodel. Poly- pressure manifold (hydraulic system component). The por-
ester film and sheet are known as Mylar and Celenar. tion of a fluid power system from which the selector valves
polyester resin. A thermosetting resin used as a matrix for receive their pressurized fluid.
much of the fiberglass used in composite construction. pressure plate (brake component). A strong, heavy plate
polyurethane enamel. A hard, chemically resistant finish used used in a multiple-disk brake. The pressure plate receives
on aircraft. Polyurethane enamel is resistant to damage the force from the brake cylinders and transmits this force
from all types of hydraulic fluid. to the disks.
polyvinyl chloride. A thermoplastic resin used in the manu- pressure vessel. The strengthened portion of an aircraft struc-
facture of transparent tubing for electrical insulation and ture that is sealed and pressurized in flight.
iluid lines which are subject to low pressures. primer (finishing system component). A component in a fin-
potential energy. Energy possessed in an object because of its ishing system that provides a good bond between the sur-
position, chemical composition, shape, or configuration. face and the material used for the topcoats.
pot life. The length of time a resin will remain workable after profile drag. Aerodynamic drag produced by skin friction.
the catalyst has been added. If a catalyzed material is not Pro111e drag is a form of parasite drag.
used within its usable pot life, it must be discarded and a pump control valve. A control valve in a hydraulic system
new batch mixed. that allows the pilot to manually direct the output of the
power. The time rate of doing work. Power is force multi- hydraulic pump back to the reservoir when no unit is be-
plied by distance (work), divided by time. ing actuated.
power brakes. Aircraft brakes that use the main hydraulic Pureclad. A registered trade name for clad aluminum alloy.
system to supply fluid for the brake actuation. pusher powerplant. A powerplant whose propeller is mounted
Aircraft that require a large amount of flui<J for their at the rear of the airplane and pushes, rather than pulls,
brake actuation normally use power brakes, and the vol- the airplane through the air.
ume of fluid sent to the brakes is increased by the use of
deboosters. quartersawed wood. Wood sawed from a tree in such a way
power control valve. A hand-operated hydraulic pump un- that the annual rings cross the plank at an angle greater
loading valve. than 45°.
When the valve is open, fluid flows from the pump quick-disconnect fitting. A hydraulic line fitting that seals
to the reservoir with little opposition. To actuate a unit, the line when the fitting is disconnected. Quick-discon-
turn the selector valve, and manually close the power con- nect fittings are used on the lines connected to the en-
trol valve. Pressurized fluid flows to the unit, and when it gine-driven hydraulic pump. They allow the pump to be
is completely actuated, the power control valve automati- disconnected and an auxiliary hydraulic power system
cally opens. connected to perform checks requiring hydraulic power
while the aircraft is in the hangar.
relative wind. The direction the wind strikes an airfoil. roll (aircraft maneuver). Rotation of an aircraft about its lon-
gitudinal axis.
relief hole. A hole drilled at the point at which two bend lines
meet in a piece of sheet metaL This hole spreads the stresses rosette weld. A method of securing one metal tube inside an-
caused by the bends and prevents the metal cracking. other by welding. Small holes are drilled in the outer tube
and the inner tube is welded to it around the circumfer-
relief valve. A pressure-control valve that relieves any pres- ence of the holes.
sure over the amount for which it is set. They are dam-
age-preventing units used in both hydraulic and pneumatic rotary actuator. A Ouid power actuator whose output i~ rota-
systems. tional. A hydraulic motor is a rotary actuator.
In an aircraft hydraulic system, pr~ssure relief valves roving. A lightly twisted roll or strand of fibers.
prevent damaging high pressures that could be caused by ruddervators. The two movable surfaces on a V-tail empen-
a malfunctioning pressure regulator, or by thermal ex- nage. When these two surfaces arc moved together with
pansion of tluid trapped in portions of the system. the in-and-out movement of the control yoke, they act as
repair. A maintenance procedure in which a damaged com- elevators, and when they are moved differentially with
ponent is restored to its original condition, or at least to a the rudder pedals, they act as the rudder.
condition that allows it to fulfill its design function.
restrictor. A fluid power system component that controls the saddle gusset. A piece of plywood glued to an aircralt struc-
rate of actuator movement by restricting the flow of fluid tural member. The saddle gusset has a cutout to hold a
into or out of the actuator. backing block or strip tightly against the skin to allow a
nailing strip to be used to apply pressure to a glued joint
retarder (finishing system component). Dope thinner that in the skin.
contains certain additives that slow its rate of evapora-
tion enough to prevent the dope blushing.
GLOSSARY- 15
sailplane. A high-performance glider. servo. An electrical or hydraulic actuator connected into a
sandwich material. A type of composite structural material flight control system. A small force on the cockpit con-
in which a core material is bonded between face sheets of trol is amplified by the servo and provides a large force to
metal or resin-impregnated fabric. move the control surface.
satin-weave fabric. Fabric in which the warp threads pass servo tab. A small movable tab built into the trailing edge of
under one fill thread and over several others. Satin-weave a primary control surface of an airplane. The cockpit con-
fabrics are used when the lay-up must be made over com- trols move the tab in such a direction that it produces an
plex shapes. aerodynamic force moving the surface on which it is
mounted.
scarf joint. A joint in a wood structure in which the ends to be
joined are cut in a long taper, normally about 12:1, and setback. The distance the jaws of a brake must be set back
fastened together by gluing. A glued scarf joint makes a from the mold line to form a bend. Setback for a 90° bend
strong splice because the joint is made along the side of is equal to the inside radius of the bend plus the thickness
the wood fibers rather than along their ends. of the metal being bent. For a bend other than 90", a
K-factor must be used. See also K-factor.
scissors. A name commonly used for torque links. See torque
links. shake (wood defect). Longitudinal cracks in a piece of wood,
usually between two annual rings.
segmented-rotor brake. A heavy-duty, multiple-disk brake
used on large, high-speed aircraft. shear section. A necked-down section of the drive shaft of a
Stators that arc surfaced with a material that retains constant-displacement engine-driven fluid pump. If the
its friction characteristics at high temperatures are keyed pump should seize, the shear section will break and pre-
to the axle. Rotors which are keyed into the wheels mesh vent the pump from being destroyed or the engine from
with the stators. The rotors are made in segments to al- being damaged.
low for cooling and for their large amounts of expansion. Some pumps use a shear pin rather than a shear
section.
selector valve. A flow control valve used in hydraulic sys-
tems that directs pressurized fluid into one side of an ac- shear strength. The strength of a riveted joint in a sheet metal
tuator, and at the same time directs return fluid from the structure in which the rivets shear before the metal tears
other side of the actuator back to the reservoir. at the rivet holes.
There are two basic types of selector valves: open- shelf life. The length of time a product is good when it re-
center valves and closed-center valves. The four-port mains in its original unopened container.
closed-center valve is the most frequently used type. shimmy. Abnormal, and often violent, vibration of the nose
See closed-center selector valve and open-center se- wheel of an airplane. Shimmying is usually caused by
lector valve. looseness of the nose wheel support mechanism or an
selvage edge. The woven edge of fabric used to prevent the unbalanced wheel.
material unraveling during normal handling. The selvage shimmy damper. A small hydraulic shock absorber installed
edge, which runs the length of the fabric parallel to the between the nose wheel fork and the nose wheel cylinder
warp threads, is usually removed from materials used in attached to the aircraft structure.
composite construction.
shock wave. A pressure wave formed in the air by a flight
semimonocoque structure. A form of aircraft stressed skin vehicle moving at a speed greater than the speed of sound.
structure. Most of the strength of a semimonocoque struc- As the vehicle passes through the air, it produces sound
ture is in the skin, but the skin is supported on a substruc- waves that spread out in all directions. But since the ve-
ture of formers and stringers that give the skin its shape hicle is flying faster than these waves are moving, they
and increase its rigidity. build up and form a pressure wave at the front and rear of
sequence valve. A valve in a hydraulic system that requires a the vehicle.
certain action to be completed before another action can As the air passes through a shock wave it slows down,
begin. its static pressure increases, and its total energy decreases.
Sequence valves are used to assure that the hydrauli- shop head. The head of a rivet which is formed when the
cally actuated wheel-well doors are completely open be- shank is upset.
fore pressure is directed to the landing gear to lower it.
GLOSSARY- 17
spike knot. A knot that runs through the depth of a beam per- stabilator. A tlight control on the empennage of an airplane
pendicular to the annual rings. Spike knots appear most that acts as both a stabilizer and an elevator. The entire
frequently in quartersawed wood. horizontal tail surface pivots and is moved as a unit.
spin. A flight maneuver in which an airplane descends in a stability. The characteristic of an aircraft that causes it tore-
corkscrew fashion. One wing is stalled and the other is turn to its original flight condition after it has been dis-
producing lift. turbed.
spirit level. A curved glass tube partially filled with a liquid. stabilons. Small wing-like horizontal surfaces mounted on the
but with a bubble in it. When the device in which the aft fuselage to improve longitudinal stability of airplanes
tube is mounted is level, the bubble will be in the center that have an exceptionally wide center of gravity range.
of the tube. stall. A flight condition in which an angle of attack is reached
splayed patch (wood structure repair). A type of patch made at which the air ceases to flow smoothly over the upper
in an aircraft plywood structure in which the edges of the surface of an airfoil. The air becomes turbulent and lift
patch are tapered for approximately five times the thick- is lost.
ness of the plywood. A splayed patch is not recommended stall strip. A small triangular metal strip installed along the
for usc on plywood less than 1/10 inch thick. leading edge of an airplane wing near the wing root. Stall
split (wood defect). A longitudinal crack in a piece of wood strips cause the root section of the wing to stall before the
caused by externally induced stress. portion of the wing ahead of the ailerons.
spoilers. Flight controls that are raised up from the upper sur- standpipe. A pipe sticking up in a tank or reservoir that al-
face of a wing to destroy, or spoil, lift. Flight spoilers are lows part of the tank to be used as a reserve, or standby,
used in conjunction with the ailerons to decrease lift and source of fluid.
increase drag on the descending wing. Ground spoilers static. Still. not moving.
are used to produce a great amount of drag to slow the
airplane on its landing roll. static air pressure. Pressure of the ambient air surrounding
the aircraft. Static pressure does not take into consider-
spongy brakes. Hydraulic brakes whose pedal has a spongy ation any air movement.
feel because of air trapped in the fluid.
static stability. The characteristic of an aircraft that causes it
spontaneous combustion. Self-ignition of a material caused to return to straight and level flight after it has been dis-
by heat produced in the material as it combines with oxy- turbed from that condition.
gen from the air.
Stoddard solvent. A petroleum product. similar to naphtha.
springwood. The portion of an annual ring in a piece of wood used as a solvent and a cleaning fluid.
formed principally during the first part of the growing
season, the spring of the year. Springwood is softer, more STOL. Short takeoff and landing.
porous, and lighter than the summerwood. stop drilling. A method of stopping the growth of a crack in a
square. A four-sided plane figure whose sides are all the same piece of metal or transparent plastic by drilling a small
length. whose opposite sides are parallel. and whose angles hole at the end of the crack.
are all right angles. The stresses are spread out all around the circumfer-
ence of the hole rather than concentrated at the end of
squat switch. An electrical switch actuated by the landing the crack.
gear scissors on the oleo strut. When no weight is on the
landing gear, the oleo piston is extended and the switch is straight polarity welding. DC-electric arc welding in which
in one position, but when weight is on the gear, the oleo the electrode is negative with respect to the work.
strut compresses and the switch changes its position. strain. A deformation or physical change in a material caused
Squat switches are used in antiskid brake systems, by a stress.
landing gear safety circuits, and cabin pressurization sys- stress. A force set up within an object that tries to prevent an
tems. outside force from changing its shape.
SRM. Structural Repair Manual.
supersonic flight. Flight at an airspeed in which all air flow- tack rag. A clean, lintless rag, slightly damp with thinner. A
ing over the aircraft is moving at a speed greater than the tack rag is used to wipe a surface to prepare it to receive a
speed of sound. coat of finishing material.
surface tape. Strips of aircraft fabric that are doped over all tack weld. A method of holding parts together before they are
seams and places where the fabric is stitched to the air- permanently welded. The parts are assembled, and small
craft structure. Surface tape is also doped over the wing spots of weld are placed at strategic locations to hold them
leading edges where abrasive wear occurs. in position.
The edges of surface tape are pinked, or notched, to tacky. Slightly sticky to the touch.
keep them from raveling before the dope is applied. tailets. Small vertical surfaces mounted uriderside of the hori-
swashplate. The component in a helicopter control system that zontal stabilizer of some airplanes to increase the direc-
consists basically of two bearing races with ball bearings tional stability.
between them. The lower, or nonrotating, race is tilted by tang. A tapered shank sticking out from the blade of a knife
the cyclic control, and the upper, or rotating, race has arms or a file. The handle of a knife or file is mounted on the
which connect to the control horns on the rotor blades. tang.
Movement of the cyclic pitch control is transmitted
to the rotor blades through the swashplate. Movement of Teflon. The registered trade name for a fluorocarbon resin
the collective pitch control raises or lowers the entire used to make hydraulic and pneumatic seals, hoses, and
swashplate assembly to change the pitch of all of the backup rings.
blades at the same time. thermal dimpling. See hot dimpling.
symmetrical airfoil. An airfoil that has the same shape on thermal relief valve. A relief valve in a hydraulic system that
both sides of its chord line, or center line. relieves pressure that builds up in an isolated part of the
symmetry check. A check of an airframe to determine that system because of heat. Thermal relief valves are set at a
the wings and tail are symmetrical about the longitudinal higher pressure than the system pressure relief valve.
axis. thermoplastic resin. A type of plastic material that becomes
soft when heated and hardens when cooled.
GLOSSARY- 19
thermosetting resin. A type of plastic material that. when trammel bar. A wood or metal bar on which trammel points
once hardened by heat. cannot be softened by being heated are mounted to compare distances.
again. trammel points. A set of sharp-pointed pins that protrude from
thixotropic agents. Materials, such as microballoons, added the sides of a trammel bar.
to a resin to give it body and increase its workability. translational lift. The additional lift produced by a helicopter
TIG welding. Tungsten inert gas welding is a form of electric rotor as the helicopter changes from hovering to forward
arc welding in which the electrode is a nonconsumable t1ight.
tungsten wire. TIG welding is now called GTA (Gas Tung· transonic flight. Flight at an airspeed in which some air flow-
sten Arc) Welding. ing over the aircraft is moving at a speed below the speed
toe-in. A condition of landing gear alignment in which the of sound, and other air is moving at a speed greater than
front of the tires are closer together than the rear. When the speed of sound.
the aircraft rolls forward, the wheels try to move closer transverse pitch. See gage.
together.
triangle. A three-sided. closed plane figure. The sum of the
toe-out. A condition of landing gear alignment in which the three angles in a triangle is always equal to 180°.
front of the tires are farther apart than the rear. When the
aircraft rolls forward, the wheels try to move farther apart. trim tab. A small control tab mounted on the trailing edge of
a movable control surface. The tab may be adjusted to
torque. A force that produces or tries to produce rotation. provide an aerodynamic force to hold the surface on which
torque links. The hinged link between the piston and cylin- it is mounted deflected in order to trim the airplane for
der of an oleo-type landing gear shock absorber. The hands-off night at a specified airspeed.
torque links allow the piston to move freely in and out of true airspeed (TAS). Airspeed shown on the airspeed indica-
the landing gear cylinder, but prevent it rotating. The tor (indicated airspeed) corrected for position error and
torque links can be adjusted to achieve and maintain the nonstandard air temperature and pressure.
correct wheel alignment. Torque links are also called scis-
sors and nutcrackers. trunnion. Projections from the cylinder of a retractable land-
torque tube. A tube in an aircraft control system that trans- ing gear strut about which the strut pivots retract.
mits a torsional force from the operating control to the truss-type structure. A type of structure made up of longitu-
control surface. dinal beams and cross braces. Compression loads between
torsion rod. A device in a spring tab to which the control the main beams are carried by rigid cross braces. Tension
horn is attached. For normal operation, the torsion rod loads are carried by stays, or wires, that go from one main
acts as a fixed attachment point, but when the control sur- beam to the other and cross between the cross braces.
face loads are high, the torsion rod twists and allows the turbine. A rotary device actuated by impulse or reaction of a
control horn to deflect the spring tab. fluid flowing through vanes or blades that are arranged
total air pressure. The pressure a column of moving air will around a central shaft.
have if it is stopped. turnbuckle. A component in an aircraft control system used
tractor powerplant. An airplane powerplant in which the to adjust cable tension. A turnbuckle consists of a brass
propeller is mounted in the front, and its thruSt pulls the tubular barrel with right-hand threads in one end and left-
airplane rather than pushes it. hand in the other end. Control cable terminals screw into
the two ends of the barrel. and turning the barrel pulls the
trammel (verb). To square up the Pratt truss used in an air- terminals together, shortening the cable.
plane wing. Trammel points are set on the trammel bar so
they measure the distance between the center of the front twist drill. A metal cutting tool turned in a drill press or hand-
spar, at the inboard compression strut, and the center of held drill motor. A twist drill has a straight shank and
the rear spar at the next compression strut outboard. The spiraled !lutes. The cutting edge is ground on the end of
drag and antidrag wires arc adjusted until the distance the spiraled flutes.
between the center of the rear spar at the inboard com- twist stripe. A stripe of paint on flexible hose that runs the
pression strut and the center of the front spar at the next length of the hose. If this stripe spirals around the hose
outboard compression strut is exactly the same as that after it is installed, it indicates the hose was twisted when
between the first points measured. it was installed. Twist stripes are also called lay lines.
GLOSSARY- 21
web of a spar. The part of a spar between the caps. yaw. Rotation of an aircraft about its vertical axis.
weft threads. See fill threads. yaw damper. An automatic flight control system that coun-
wing fences. Vertical vanes that extend chordwise across the teracts the rolling and yawing produced by Dutch roll.
upper surface of an airplane wing to prevent spanwise See Dutch roll.
airflow. A yaw damper senses yaw with a rate gyro and moves
the rudder an amount proportional to the rate of yaw, but
wing heavy. An out-of-trim flight condition in which an air- in the opposite direction.
plane flies hands off, with one wing low.
yield strength. The amount of stress needed to permanently
woof threads. See fill threads. deform a material.
work. The product of force times distance.
Zeppelin. The name of large rigid lighter-than-air ships built
by the Zeppelin Company in Germany prior to and dur·
ing World War I.
Index- 1
bidirectional fabric ........................ 238 bucking bar ................... 68, 101, 122 collective pitch control .......... 53, 304
bladder-type accumulator ............. 373 bulb angle ..................................... 133 collodion ...................................... 234
blade area ....................................... 45 bulkhead .......................................... 66 combination set ............................... 86
blade tracking flag ....................... 313 bungee shock cord ............... 426, 427 compensator port ................ 336, 450
bleeder ................................. 248, 250 bungee spring ................................ 280 composite ..................................... 175
bleeding dope ................................ 193 burr .................................................. 94 composite structure ....................... 234
blimp ................................................. 6 Butyl ............................................. 345 compound curve ........................... Ill
blush .................................... 193, 221 butyrate dope ...................... 193, 219 compressed gas safety .................. 144
boosted brakes .............................. 452 compressibility ............................... 37
boron ............................................. 235
c compressibility factor ..................... 31
C-clamps ....................................... 119
boundary layer ......................... 19, 20 compressible flow ........................... 37
cable tension ............... 296, 297, 300
boundary layer control .................... 19 compressible fluid .......................... 39
camber .......................................... 428
box brake ....................................... 97 compression ............................ 67, 68
canard ........................................... 273
brake bleeding ..................... 464-465 compression failure ..................... 177
cantilever wings ............................ 292
brake master compression riveting ..................... 121
cylinder. ......... 335, 336, 449, 451 cape chisel ...................................... 93
concave curve ...................... 112, 113
brake shuttle valve ........................ 462 case pressure ................................. 353
coning angle ................................. 305
brake system Ceconite ...................... 186, 205-207
conservation of energy,
auto ........................................... 463 center of gravity ..................... 27, 273 law of.. ...................................... 328
dual power ................................ 462 center of pressure ............................ 12 constant-displacement
emergency ................................ 462 center punch ................... 88, 89, 119 pump ...................... 338, 351, 352
brake(s) centering cam ....................... 430, 431 control cable
adjuster, automatic ................... 442 ceramic ........................................ 235 extra-tlexible ............................ 282
bleeding ............................ 464-465 flexible ..................................... 282
Cessna clip ................................... 199
boosted ..................................... 452 nonflexible ............................... 282
box .............................................. 97 Chadwick-Helmuth
balancer/analyzer ............ 313, 314 tension ............................. 295-297
carbon disk ....................... 448-449 tension regulator ....................... 295
Cleveland .......................... 443-444 check valve .......................... 337, 359
control surface balancing .............. 294
cornice ........................................ 97 Cherry rivet
debooster ......................... 460, 461 friction-lock ................................ 81 control surface travel .................... 297
dual-disk ................................... 445 mechanical-lock ......................... 82 control wheel ................................ 301
energ!Zlng ................................. 4 39 chevron seal .................................. 383 control yoke ......................... 271, 295
expander tube .................. 335, 440 chip chaser ................................... I 03 controllability ............................... 277
fading ....................................... 439 converging duct.. ...................... 37, 38
master chisel ............................................... 93
cylinder ..... 335, 336, 449, 451 chisel, cape ..................................... 93 conversion coating ........................ 214
multiple-disk ................... 441, 446 clad ah1minum ................................ 73 convex curve ........................ 112, 113
nonenergizing ........................... 439 Clark-Y airfoil ................................ 12 Corio lis effect ........................ 52, 310
power ........................................ 452 Cleco fastener .... 102, 103, 120, 131 cornice brake ................ _................ 97
pressure plate ........................... 444 corrosion ............................. 128, 212
Cleveland brake .................... 443-444
segmented-rotor ....................... 446
close-quarter iron .......................... 206 corrosion detecting ......... .......... 214
segmented-rotor
multiple-disk ........................ 447 closed-center hydraulic system ..... 370 corrosion-resistant steel . ............ 74
single-disk ................................ 441 closed-center cotton, Grade-A .......... 185, 192, 219
single-servo .............................. 439 selector valve ................... 361, 363 countersinking ..................... 120, 121
speed ........................................ 277 coefficient of drag ........................... 14 countersinking tool ......................... 94
thin-disk multiple-disk ............. 446 coefficient of lift ...................... 14, 17 crazing ................................. 257, 260
brazing ................................ 151, 152 coin dimpling ....................... 120, 121 critical angle of attack .................... 17
Brinell number ............................... 75 collective pitch ............ . 53, 303-304 crosstlow valve ............................. 366
Index- 3
neutral ...................................... 145 freewheeling unit .......................... 312 helium gas ................................ 6, 156
oxidizing .................................. 145 Frise aileron ........................... 30, 270 Hi-Shear rivet .......................... 83, 84
reducing .................................... 145 fungicidal dope ............................. 194 hole finder .................................... I 03
soft ............................................ 146
fungus .......................................... 182 honeycomb ................. 242, 246, 247
flap overload valve ............... 364-365
honeycomb ribbon direction ......... 242
flaps ...................................... 274-276 G
hook rule ......................................... 87
Fowler ............................. 275, 288 gamma-ray ................................... 246
Kruger ...................................... 276 horizontal stabilizer ........ 27, 54, 306
gas welding ................................... 138
leading edge ............................. 275 horsepower .................................... 326
gasket ............................................ 383
plain .......................................... 274 hose
slotted ................................ 20, 275 GAW-1 low-speed airfoil ................ 13 high-pressure ............................ 394
split .................................. 274, 275 GAW-2 low-speed airfoil ................ 13 low-pressure ............................. 393
triple-slotted ............. 20, 275, 288 gear-type pump .................... 352, 353 Teflon ....................................... 394
flare fittings ................................... 396 gcrotor pump ....................... 354, 355 hot -bond repair .................... 248, 249
flared-tube fitting .......................... 390 glue hot dimpling .................................. 121
flareless tube fitting ............ 391, 397 plastic resin .............................. 178 hot wire cutter ............................... 242
tlat chisel ....................................... 93 resorcinol .................................. 178 hover ceiling ................................... 50
flat pattern layout.. ....................... 109 glues and gluing ................... 178-179 hybrid fabric ................................. 239
flexible line installation ........... . 399 gluing procedures ........................ 179 hydraulic
flight GMAW (gas metal accumulator ...................... 373-375
hypersonic ................................. 39 arc welding) ............................. 156 actuator ............................. 378-382
spoilers ... 30, 270, 277, 286, 287 Grade-A fabric ............................. 186 filter .................................. 376-377
subsonic .................. ................... 39 graphite .............. 235, 237, 241, 252 flow control valve ..................... 359
supersonic .................................. 39 gravity bleeding ........................... 464 tluid .................................. 343-345
transonic .............................. 39, 40 mineral-base ........................ 344
greige ..................... .. ................ 186 phosphate ester .................... 344
tloat repair .................................... 135 ground effect .................... 19, 49, 50 Skydrol ........................ 344-345
tlow equalizer valve .............. 365-366 ground power unit (GPU) ............. 407 vegetable-base ..................... 343
tluid ............................................... 323 ground spoilers .......... 277, 286, 287 fuse ......................... 332, 367, 368
line installation ................. 398-399 hand pump ................................ 350
lines, flexible .................. 389, 393 GrummanX-29 ............. 41, 237, 243
motor.............. .. .................... 381
lines, rigid ................................ 389 GTAW (gas tungsten
power pack ............. 340, 341, 433
power .............................. 323, 332 arc welding) ............ 156-158, 160
pressure control valve .............. 369
fluid power systems ..................... 323 GTAW electrodes .......................... 159 reservoirs ......................... 347-348
flush patch ............................ 131-133 GTAW torches ............................. 159 nonpressurized ..................... 347
flush riveting, NACA .................... 125 gyroscopic precession ..... 51, 53, 309 pressurized ........................... 348
seal identification ..................... 385
flush rivets .................................... 120 H seal installation ......................... 386
fly-by-light .................................. 285 hacksaw ........................................ 91 selector valve.......... .. .... 360-361
fly-by-wire ................................... 285 hardwood ..................................... 175 hydraulic system
flying boat.......... .. ...................... 421 heat treatment closed-center ............................ 370
llying wing ..................................... 27 precipitation ............................... 71 open-center .... .......................... 340
force .............................................. 326 solution ....................................... 71 troubleshooting ................ 411-413
form drag ........................................ 17 helicopter hydraulics ..................................... 323
former ............................................. 66 blade track ................................ 315 hydroplaning ................................. 455
forming block ............................... 112 clutch ........................................ 312 hypersonic flight ............................. 39
rotor blade tracking .......... 313-314
forward-swept wing ....................... 40
rotor, fully articulated ........ 53, 310
Fowler flaps ......................... 275, 288 transmiSSIOn ............................. 312
free-turbine engine .............. 311, 312 vibrations .... ............................. 313
Index- 5
paint pressure pot ................. 225, 227 potential energy .............. 8, 328, 331 Q
paint spray pattern ............... 228, 229 power ................................... 326, 327 quick-disconnect fittings .............. 397
paint stripping .............................. 212 power brake control valve .... 453, 454
parasite drag ..................... 10, 17, 30 power brakes ................................. 4 52
R
rack-and-pinion actuator ............... 381
parent metal .................................. 151 power control valve ............. 338, 339
radiograpic inspection .................. 246
parting tilm ................................... 248 power pack retraction system ....... 433
radius dimpling ............................. 120
Parts Manufacturer Approval ........ 259 power transfer unit (PTU) ............. 407
ram air turbine ............................. 408
Pascal's law ................................... 329 precession ....................................... 51
rectification .................................. 158
Perspex ......................................... 255 precipitation heat treatment ............ 71
registration numbers ............. 229-231
pilot hole ....................................... 119 preimpregnated material ...... 241, 244
reinforced shell structure ................ 66
pin knot clusters ............................ 177 prepreg ................................. 241, 249
reinforcing tape .. 191, 192, 196, 197
pin punch ................................ 88, 89 pressure ............................... 326, 327
altitude .......................................... 8 rejuvenation .................................. 222
pinholes ........................................ 221
dynamic ...................................... 13 rejuvenator .................. 192, 220, 222
pinked-edge finishing tape ............ 202
manifold .......................... 339, 340 relative wind ..................... 11, 31, 48
pinked-edge tape ........................... 200
reducer valve ............................ 371 relaxed static stability ..................... 27
pipe fittings ................................... 395 relief valve ................................ 338
relief holes ................................... 11 1
piston pump ......................... 354, 355 vessel repair ............................. 135
vessels ...................................... 135 relief valve ........................... 339, 369
piston-type accumulator ............... 374
pressure bleeding .......................... 465 repair
pitch .................................... 271, 287
approval .................................... 136
plain tlaps ..................................... 274 prick punch .................... 88, 89, 119
dented longeron ........................ 164
plain-weave fabric ........................ 238 priority valve ................................ 364 float .......................................... 135
plastic media blasting .......... 213, 214 profile drag .................................... 17 hot-bond .......................... 248, 249
plastic resin glue ........................... 178 propeller protractor ....................... 298 plywood .................................... 182
plastics ......................................... 234 pulleys .................................. 282, 283 pressure vessels ........................ 135
acetate ...................................... 255 room-temperature cure ............. 246
pump control valve ...................... 338
acrylic ............................... 255-262 seaplane hull ............................. 135
pumps wood wing rib .......................... 181
Plexiglas ...................................... 255 constant- wood wing spar ........................ 180
plug-type selector valve ................ 361 displacement ...... 338, 351, 352
resins
plywood ........................................ 176 "dry" ......................................... 402
polyester ................................... 240
repair ........................................ 182 gear-type .......................... 352, 353
thermoplastic ............................ 240
structure inspection .................. 182 gerotor ............................. 354, 355
thermosetting ............................ 240
piston ............................... 354, 355
PMB (plastic media resorcinol glue .............................. 178
Stratopower ...................... 355-357
blasting) ........................... 213, 214
vane-type .................................. 352 respiratory safety ......................... 226
pneumatic systems ................ 401-406 variable- resultant lift .................................... 48
pneumatic(s) ................................. 323 displacement ....... 352, 354-357 retarder ............... 192, 194, 220, 221
deicer system ............................ 402 "wet" ........................................ 402
gyro power system ................... 403 retractable landing gear ...... 421, 423
punch
system retreating blade ............... 46, 51, 306
center .......................... 88, 89, 119
high-pressure ....................... 404 pin ...................................... 88, 89 retreating blade stall ................ 48, 49
low-pressure ......................... 402 prick ........................... 88, 89, 119 return manifold .................... 339, 340
Poly-Fiber .................... 186, 202-203 transfer ............ .................. 88, 89 rib stitching .......................... 196, 198
polyester resin ...................... 235, 240 Purcclad ......................................... 73 ribstitch spacing ............................ 197
polyethylene sheeting .................. 223 push-pull rod ................................ 284 rigid line installation ..................... 398
polyurethane enamel... 213, 217, 218 rigid rotor ...................................... 311
polyvinyl chloride ......................... 345 rigid tube bending ......................... 392
positive static stability .................... 26 ringworms ..................................... 222
Index- 7
standpipe ....................................... 340 T torque ..................................... 46, 307
static stability .................... 25, 26, 27 T joint ........................................... 148 torque link ..................................... 424
STC (Supplemental T-seal ............................................ 385 torque tube .................................... 284
Type Certificates) ............ 187, 201 tabs torsion ...................................... 67, 68
steel, corrosion-resistant ................. 74 antiservo .......................... 279, 280 torsion rod ..................................... 280
steel, stainless ................................ 74 balance ..................................... 278 toxicity safety ............................... 226
steering cylinder ........................... 430 servo ......................................... 279
trammel ......................................... 191
spring ........................................ 279
Stoddard solvent ........................... 344 trammel bar .......................... 190, 191
trim ........................................... 278
strain ............................................... 67 trammel points .......... .. .................. 191
tachometer .................................... 311
Stratopower pump ................. 355-357 transfer punch .......................... 88, 89
tack coat ........................................ 218
stratosphere ....................................... 7 translational lift ............................... 50
tack weld ....................................... 149
stress ............................................... 67 transonic flight ......................... 39, 40
tail rotor ................................. 47, 308
stress riser ..................................... 470 transonic range ................................ 12
tail-rotor thrust ......................... 47, 54
stressed-skin replacement ............. 136 transverse flow effect. ..................... 51
tail wheel landing gear ......... 423, 429
stressed-skin structure .................. 234 transverse pitch ............................. 116
tang ................................................. 92
stringer ............................................ 66 tricycle landing gear ..................... 423
team riveting ................................. 125
stringer repair ........................ 133-134 trim tabs ........................................ 278
teetering hinge .............................. 310
structural repair manual ....... 245, 247 triple-slotted t1aps .................. 20, 275
Teflon ................. 345, 384, 385, 394
structure tropopause ......................................... 7
Teflon hose ................................... 394
composite ................................. 234 troposphere ....................................... 7
monocoque ........................ 65, 234 tensiometer .......................... 296, 297
tension ............................................. 67 trunnion ......................................... 425
reinforced shell ........................... 66
semirnonocoque ......................... 65 thermal relief valve ....................... 369 truss structure .................................. 65
stressed-skin ............................. 234 thermoplastic resin ........................ 240 tubeless tires ................................. 482
Styrofoam ..................................... 242 thermosetting resin ....................... 240 tubing
subsonic airfoil ............................... 12 cutter ........................................ 390
thin-disk multiple-disk brake ........ 446
double flare .............................. 390
subsonic flight ................................ 39 throatless shears ....................... 89, 90 single flare ................................ 390
summerwood ................................ 176 thrust .......................................... 9, 47 turbine ........................................... 323
supercritical airfoil .......................... 12 tire(s) ..................................... 473-485 turboshaft engines ......................... 311
Superflite ..................... 186, 204-205 bead ................................. 474, 478
turnbuckle ............................ 298, 300
supersonic airflow ............ .............. 41 carcass ...................................... 474
inflation .................................... 476 turnbuckle safetying ..................... 299
supersonic flight ............................ 39
installation ................................ 472 twin floats ..................................... 421
Supplemental Type
mounting .................................. 481 twist drill ......................... 94, 95, 119
Certificates ...................... 187, 20 I
retreading ................................. 480 Type Certificate Data
surface patch, stressed skin ... 129-131 sidewall ........................... 476, 478 Sheets ..................... 290, 292, 297
surface tape ........................ 192, 200 storage ...................................... 481
surface tape, bias-cut .................... 192 tread ................................. 475, 477 u
swashplate ..................................... 304 tubeless ..................................... 482 ultraviolet-blocking dope ..... 201, 219
sweep back ......................... 27, 31, 40 tubes ................................ 473-485 underslung rotor. ................... ......... 53
tube-type .................................. 483
symmetry check ........................... 294 unidirectional fabric ............. ........ 238
titanium ........................................... 74
synthetic enamel ... ............ .... 217 unloading valve ................... 339, 370
toe-in ............................................. 427
synthetic hydrocarbon-base urethane foam ............................... 242
hydraulic fluid .......................... 344 toe-out ........................................... 427
utility tinish ................................... 219
system pressure regulator ............. 339 toluol ............................................. 213
Index- 9